]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/gnus.texi
Fix/update some gnus manual links to external resources
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @include gnus-overrides.texi
4
5 @setfilename ../../info/gnus
6 @settitle Gnus Manual
7 @syncodeindex fn cp
8 @syncodeindex vr cp
9 @syncodeindex pg cp
10
11 @documentencoding UTF-8
12
13 @copying
14 Copyright @copyright{} 1995--2013 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15
16 @quotation
17 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
18 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
19 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
20 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual'',
21 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
22 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
23
24 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
25 modify this GNU manual.''
26 @end quotation
27 @end copying
28
29 @iftex
30 @iflatex
31 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
32 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
33 \usepackage{pagestyle}
34 \usepackage{epsfig}
35 \usepackage{pixidx}
36 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
37
38 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
39 \else
40 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
41 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
42 \pdfcompresslevel=9
43 \fi
44
45 \makeindex
46 \begin{document}
47
48 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
49 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.13}
50 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
51 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
52
53 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
54
55 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
56 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
57 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
58 \else
59 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
60 \fi
61 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
62 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
63
64 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
65 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
66
67 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
68 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
70 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
71 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
74 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
76 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
77 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
78 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
80 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
81 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
82 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
84 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
91
92 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
94 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
95 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
96 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
97 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
98 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
99 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
100 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
101 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
104 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
105
106 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
108 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
109 }
110
111 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
112
113 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
114 {\mbox{}}
115 }
116
117 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
118 \gnusdimen 0pt
119
120 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
121 \gnuscleardoublepage
122 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
123 \chapter{#2}
124 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
125 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
126 \thispagestyle{empty}
127 \hspace*{-2cm}
128 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
129 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
130 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
131 \end{picture}
132 \clearpage
133 }
134
135 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
136 \begin{figure}
137 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
138 #3
139 \end{picture}
140 \caption{#1}
141 \end{figure}
142 }
143
144 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
145 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
149 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
157 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
161
162 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
163 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
164 \section{#1}
165 }
166
167 \newenvironment{codelist}%
168 {\begin{list}{}{
169 }
170 }{\end{list}}
171
172 \newenvironment{asislist}%
173 {\begin{list}{}{
174 }
175 }{\end{list}}
176
177 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
178 {\begin{list}{}{
179 \labelwidth=0cm
180 }
181 }{\end{list}}
182
183 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
184 {\begin{list}{}{
185 }
186 }{\end{list}}
187
188 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
189 {\begin{list}{}{
190 }
191 }{\end{list}}
192
193 \newenvironment{samplist}%
194 {\begin{list}{}{
195 }
196 }{\end{list}}
197
198 \newenvironment{varlist}%
199 {\begin{list}{}{
200 }
201 }{\end{list}}
202
203 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
204 {\begin{list}{}{
205 }
206 }{\end{list}}
207
208 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
209 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
210 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
211
212 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
213 {
214 {
215 \ifodd\count0
216 {
217 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
218 }
219 \else
220 {
221 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
222 }
223 }
224 \fi
225 }
226 }
227 {
228 \ifodd\count0
229 \mbox{} \hfill
230 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
231 \else
232 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
233 \hfill \mbox{}
234 \fi
235 }
236
237 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
238 {
239 {
240 \ifodd\count0
241 {
242 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
243 }
244 \else
245 {
246 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
247 }
248 \fi
249 }
250 }
251 {
252 \ifodd\count0
253 \mbox{} \hfill
254 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
255 \else
256 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
257 \hfill \mbox{}
258 \fi
259 }
260
261 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
262 {
263 {
264 \ifodd\count0
265 {
266 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
267 }
268 \else
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
271 }
272 \fi
273 }
274 }
275 {
276 \ifodd\count0
277 \mbox{} \hfill
278 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
279 \else
280 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
281 \hfill \mbox{}
282 \fi
283 }
284
285 \pagenumbering{roman}
286 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
287
288 @end iflatex
289 @end iftex
290
291 @iftex
292 @iflatex
293
294 \begin{titlepage}
295 {
296
297 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
298 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
299 \parindent=0cm
300 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
301
302 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
303 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
304 \vfill
305 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
306 \vfill
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
309 \newpage
310 }
311
312 \mbox{}
313 \vfill
314
315 \thispagestyle{empty}
316
317 @c @insertcopying
318 \newpage
319 \end{titlepage}
320 @end iflatex
321 @end iftex
322
323 @dircategory Emacs network features
324 @direntry
325 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
326 @end direntry
327 @iftex
328 @finalout
329 @end iftex
330
331
332 @titlepage
333 @ifset WEBHACKDEVEL
334 @title Gnus Manual (DEVELOPMENT VERSION)
335 @end ifset
336 @ifclear WEBHACKDEVEL
337 @title Gnus Manual
338 @end ifclear
339
340 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
341 @page
342 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
343 @insertcopying
344 @end titlepage
345
346 @summarycontents
347 @contents
348
349 @node Top
350 @top The Gnus Newsreader
351
352 @ifinfo
353
354 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
355 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
356 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
357 luck.
358
359 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
360 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
361
362 @ifnottex
363 @insertcopying
364 @end ifnottex
365
366 @end ifinfo
367
368 @iftex
369
370 @iflatex
371 \tableofcontents
372 \gnuscleardoublepage
373 @end iflatex
374
375 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379 being accused of plagiarism:
380
381 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384 can even read news with it!
385
386 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391 the program.
392
393 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
394 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.13
395
396 @heading Other related manuals
397 @itemize
398 @item Message manual: Composing messages
399 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
401 @item EasyPG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
402 @item SASL: @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
403 @end itemize
404
405 @end iftex
406
407 @menu
408 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
409 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
410 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
411 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
412 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
413 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
414 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
415 * Searching:: Mail and News search engines.
416 * Various:: General purpose settings.
417 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
418 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
419 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
420 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
421 * Key Index:: Key Index.
422
423 @c Doesn't work right in html.
424 @c FIXME Do this in a more standard way.
425 @ifinfo
426 Other related manuals
427
428 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
429 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
430 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
431 * EasyPG:(epa). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
432 * SASL:(sasl). @acronym{SASL} authentication in Emacs.
433 @end ifinfo
434
435 @detailmenu
436 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
437
438 Starting Gnus
439
440 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
441 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
442 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
443 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
444 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
445 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
446 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
447 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
448 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
449 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
450
451 New Groups
452
453 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
454 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
455 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
456
457 Group Buffer
458
459 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
460 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
461 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
462 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
463 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
464 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
465 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
466 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
467 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
468 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
469 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
470 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
471 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
472 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
473 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
474 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
475 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
476 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
477
478 Group Buffer Format
479
480 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
481 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
482 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
483
484 Group Topics
485
486 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
487 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
488 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
489 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
490 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
491
492 Misc Group Stuff
493
494 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
495 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
496 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
497 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
498 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
499
500 Summary Buffer
501
502 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
503 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
504 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
505 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
506 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
507 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
508 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
509 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
510 * Threading:: How threads are made.
511 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
512 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
513 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
514 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
515 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
516 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
517 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
518 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
519 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
520 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
521 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
522 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
523 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
524 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
525 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
526 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
527 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
528 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
529 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
530 or reselecting the current group.
531 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
532 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
533 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
534 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
535
536 Summary Buffer Format
537
538 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
539 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
540 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
541 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
542
543 Choosing Articles
544
545 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
546 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
547
548 Reply, Followup and Post
549
550 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
551 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
552 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
553 * Canceling and Superseding::
554
555 Marking Articles
556
557 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
558 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
559 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
560 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
561 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
562 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
563
564 Threading
565
566 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
567 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
568
569 Customizing Threading
570
571 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
572 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
573 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
574 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
575
576 Decoding Articles
577
578 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
579 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
580 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
581 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
582 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
583 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
584
585 Decoding Variables
586
587 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
588 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
589 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
590
591 Article Treatment
592
593 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
594 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
595 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
596 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
597 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
598 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
599 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
600 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
601 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys, Gravatars
602 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
603 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
604
605 Alternative Approaches
606
607 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
608 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
609
610 Various Summary Stuff
611
612 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
613 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
614 * Summary Generation Commands::
615 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
616
617 Article Buffer
618
619 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
620 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
621 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
622 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
623 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
624
625 Composing Messages
626
627 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
628 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
629 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
630 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
631 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
632 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
633 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
634 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
635 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
636
637 Select Methods
638
639 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
640 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
641 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
642 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
643 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
644 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
645 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
646 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
647 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
648
649 Server Buffer
650
651 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
652 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
653 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
654 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
655 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
656 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
657 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
658
659 Getting News
660
661 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
662 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
663
664 @acronym{NNTP}
665
666 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
667 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
668 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
669
670 Getting Mail
671
672 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
673 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
674 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
675 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
676 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
677 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
678 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
679 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
680 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
681 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
682 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
683 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
684 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
685
686 Mail Sources
687
688 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
689 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
690 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
691
692 Choosing a Mail Back End
693
694 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
695 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
696 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
697 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
698 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
699 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
700 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
701
702 Browsing the Web
703
704 * Archiving Mail::
705 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
706 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
707 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
708
709 Other Sources
710
711 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
712 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
713 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
714 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
715 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
716
717 Document Groups
718
719 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
720
721 Combined Groups
722
723 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
724
725 Email Based Diary
726
727 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
728 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
729 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
730
731 The NNDiary Back End
732
733 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
734 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
735 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
736
737 The Gnus Diary Library
738
739 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
740 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
741 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
742 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
743
744 Gnus Unplugged
745
746 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
747 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
748 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
749 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
750 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
751 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
752 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
753 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
754 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
755 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
756 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
757 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
758 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
759 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
760
761 Agent Categories
762
763 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
764 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
765 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
766
767 Agent Commands
768
769 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
770 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
771 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
772
773 Scoring
774
775 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
776 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
777 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
778 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
779 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
780 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
781 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
782 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
783 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
784 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
785 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
786 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
787 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
788 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
789 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
790 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
791
792 Advanced Scoring
793
794 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
795 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
796 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
797
798 Searching
799
800 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
801 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
802
803 nnir
804
805 * What is nnir?:: What does nnir do.
806 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
807 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up nnir.
808
809 Setting up nnir
810
811 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
812
813 Various
814
815 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
816 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
817 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
818 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
819 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
820 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
821 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
822 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
823 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
824 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
825 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
826 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
827 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
828 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
829 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
830 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
831 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
832 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
833 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
834
835 Formatting Variables
836
837 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
838 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
839 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
840 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
841 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
842 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
843 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
844 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
845
846 Image Enhancements
847
848 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
849 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
850 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
851 meant to be shown.
852 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
853 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
854 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
855
856 Thwarting Email Spam
857
858 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
859 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
860 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
861 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
862
863 Spam Package
864
865 * Spam Package Introduction::
866 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
867 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
868 * Spam and Ham Processors::
869 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
870 * Spam Back Ends::
871 * Extending the Spam package::
872 * Spam Statistics Package::
873
874 Spam Statistics Package
875
876 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
877 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
878 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
879
880 Appendices
881
882 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
883 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
884 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
885 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
886 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
887 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
888 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
889 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
890 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
891
892 History
893
894 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
895 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
896 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
897 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
898 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
899 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
900 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
901 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
902
903 New Features
904
905 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
906 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
907 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
908 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
909 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
910 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
911 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13
912 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
913
914 Customization
915
916 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
917 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
918 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
919 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
920
921 Gnus Reference Guide
922
923 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
924 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
925 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
926 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
927 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
928 * Group Info:: The group info format.
929 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
930 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
931 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
932
933 Back End Interface
934
935 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
936 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
937 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
938 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
939 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
940 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
941
942 Various File Formats
943
944 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
945 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
946
947 Emacs for Heathens
948
949 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
950 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
951
952 @end detailmenu
953 @end menu
954
955 @node Starting Up
956 @chapter Starting Gnus
957 @cindex starting up
958
959 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
960 Heathens} first.
961
962 @kindex M-x gnus
963 @findex gnus
964 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
965 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
966 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
967 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
968 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
969 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
970
971 @findex gnus-other-frame
972 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
973 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
974 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
975
976 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
977 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
978 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
979
980 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
981 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
982
983 @menu
984 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
985 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
986 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
987 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
988 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
989 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
990 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
991 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
992 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
993 @end menu
994
995
996 @node Finding the News
997 @section Finding the News
998 @cindex finding news
999
1000 First of all, you should know that there is a special buffer called
1001 @code{*Server*} that lists all the servers Gnus knows about. You can
1002 press @kbd{^} from the Group buffer to see it. In the Server buffer,
1003 you can press @kbd{RET} on a defined server to see all the groups it
1004 serves (subscribed or not!). You can also add or delete servers, edit
1005 a foreign server's definition, agentize or de-agentize a server, and
1006 do many other neat things. @xref{Server Buffer}.
1007 @xref{Foreign Groups}. @xref{Agent Basics}.
1008
1009 @vindex gnus-select-method
1010 @c @head
1011 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1012 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1013 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1014 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1015 secondary or foreign groups.
1016
1017 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1018 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1019
1020 @lisp
1021 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1022 @end lisp
1023
1024 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1025
1026 @lisp
1027 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1028 @end lisp
1029
1030 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1031 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1032 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1033 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1034
1035 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1036 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1037 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1038 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1039 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1040 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1041 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1042 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1043 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1044
1045 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1046 @kindex B (Group)
1047 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1048 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1049 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1050 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1051 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1052 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1053
1054 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1055 @c @head
1056 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1057 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1058 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1059 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1060 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1061 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1062 groups are.
1063
1064 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1065 you would typically set this variable to
1066
1067 @lisp
1068 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1069 @end lisp
1070
1071
1072
1073 @node The Server is Down
1074 @section The Server is Down
1075 @cindex server errors
1076
1077 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1078 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1079 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1080
1081 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1082 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1083 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1084 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1085 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1086 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1087 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1088
1089 @findex gnus-no-server
1090 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1091 @c @head
1092 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1093 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1094 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1095 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1096 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1097 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1098 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1099
1100
1101 @node Slave Gnusae
1102 @section Slave Gnusae
1103 @cindex slave
1104
1105 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1106 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1107 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1108 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1109
1110 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1111 @file{.newsrc} file.
1112
1113 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1114 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1115 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1116 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1117 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1118 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1119 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1120
1121 @findex gnus-slave
1122 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1123 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1124 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1125 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1126 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1127 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1128 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1129 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1130
1131 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1132 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1133
1134 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1135 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1136 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1137 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1138 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1139
1140
1141
1142 @node New Groups
1143 @section New Groups
1144 @cindex new groups
1145 @cindex subscription
1146
1147 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1148 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1149 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1150 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1151 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1152 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1153 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1154 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1155 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1156
1157 @menu
1158 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1159 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1160 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1161 @end menu
1162
1163
1164 @node Checking New Groups
1165 @subsection Checking New Groups
1166
1167 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing
1168 the list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of
1169 subscribed and dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method.
1170 If @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will
1171 ask the server for new groups since the last time. This is both
1172 faster and cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list
1173 of killed groups (@pxref{Group Levels}) altogether, so you may set
1174 @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to @code{nil}, which will save time both
1175 at startup, at exit, and all over. Saves disk space, too. Why isn't
1176 this the default, then? Unfortunately, not all servers support this
1177 command.
1178
1179 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1180 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1181 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1182 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1183 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1184 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1185 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1186 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1187 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1188 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1189 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1190
1191 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1192 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1193 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1194 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1195 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1196 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1197
1198
1199 @node Subscription Methods
1200 @subsection Subscription Methods
1201
1202 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1203 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1204 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1205
1206 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1207 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1208
1209 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1210
1211 @table @code
1212
1213 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1214 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1215 Make all new groups zombies (@pxref{Group Levels}). This is the
1216 default. You can browse the zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either
1217 kill them all off properly (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them
1218 (with @kbd{u}).
1219
1220 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1221 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1222 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1223 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1224
1225 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1226 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1227 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1228
1229 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1230 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1231 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1232 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1233 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1234 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1235 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1236 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1237 up. Or something like that.
1238
1239 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1240 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1241 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1242 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1243 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1244
1245 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1246 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1247 Kill all new groups.
1248
1249 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1250 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1251 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1252 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1253 topic parameter that looks like
1254
1255 @example
1256 "nnml"
1257 @end example
1258
1259 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1260 that topic.
1261
1262 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1263 top-level topic.
1264
1265 @end table
1266
1267 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1268 A closely related variable is
1269 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1270 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1271 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1272 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1273 hierarchy or not.
1274
1275 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1276 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1277 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1278 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1279
1280
1281 @node Filtering New Groups
1282 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1283
1284 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1285 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1286 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1287
1288 @example
1289 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1290 @end example
1291
1292 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1293 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1294 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1295 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1296 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1297 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1298 subscribing these groups.
1299 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1300 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1301
1302 The ``options -n'' format is very simplistic. The syntax above is all
1303 that is supports: you can force-subscribe hierarchies, or you can
1304 deny hierarchies, and that's it.
1305
1306 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1307 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1308 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1309 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1310 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1311 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1312 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1313 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1314
1315 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1316 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1317 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1318 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1319 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1320 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1321 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1322 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1323 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, @code{nnimap}, and
1324 @code{nnmaildir}) subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this
1325 variable to @code{nil}.
1326
1327 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-categories
1328 As if that wasn't enough, @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-categories} also
1329 allows you to specify that new groups should be subscribed based on the
1330 category their select methods belong to. The default is @samp{(mail
1331 post-mail)}, meaning that all new groups from mail-like backends
1332 should be subscribed automatically.
1333
1334 New groups that match these variables are subscribed using
1335 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1336
1337
1338 @node Changing Servers
1339 @section Changing Servers
1340 @cindex changing servers
1341
1342 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1343 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1344 very flaky and you want to use another.
1345
1346 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1347 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1348
1349 @emph{Wrong!}
1350
1351 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1352 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1353 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1354 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1355 worthless.
1356
1357 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1358 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1359 You can use the @kbd{M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups}
1360 command to clear out all data that you have on your native groups.
1361 Use with caution.
1362
1363 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1364 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1365 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1366 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1367
1368 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1369 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1370 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1371 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1372 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1373 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1374 cache for all groups).
1375
1376
1377 @node Startup Files
1378 @section Startup Files
1379 @cindex startup files
1380 @cindex .newsrc
1381 @cindex .newsrc.el
1382 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1383
1384 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1385 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1386 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1387 read.
1388
1389 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1390 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1391 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1392 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1393 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1394 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1395 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1396
1397 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1398 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1399 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1400 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1401 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1402 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1403
1404 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1405 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1406 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1407 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1408 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1409 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1410 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1411 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1412 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1413 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1414 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1415 news reader.
1416
1417 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1418 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1419 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1420 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1421 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1422 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1423 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1424 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1425 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1426 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1427 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1428 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1429
1430 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1431 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1432 @vindex version-control
1433 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1434 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1435 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1436 If you want to keep multiple numbered backups of this file, set
1437 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1438 @code{version-control} variable.
1439
1440 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1441 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1442 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1443 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1444 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1445 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1446 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1447 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1448 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1449 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1450
1451 @lisp
1452 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1453 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1454
1455 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1456 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1457 @end lisp
1458
1459 @vindex gnus-init-file
1460 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1461 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1462 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1463 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1464 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1465 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1466 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1467 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1468 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1469 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1470 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1471 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1472 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1473
1474
1475 @node Auto Save
1476 @section Auto Save
1477 @cindex dribble file
1478 @cindex auto-save
1479
1480 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1481 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1482 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1483 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1484 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1485 this file.
1486
1487 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1488 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1489 saved.
1490
1491 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1492 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1493 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1494
1495 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1496 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1497 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1498 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1499 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1500 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1501
1502 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1503 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1504 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1505
1506
1507 @node The Active File
1508 @section The Active File
1509 @cindex active file
1510 @cindex ignored groups
1511
1512 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1513 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1514 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1515
1516 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1517 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1518 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1519 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1520 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1521 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1522 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1523
1524 @c This variable is
1525 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1526 @c if you set it to anything else.
1527
1528 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1529 @c @head
1530 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1531 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1532 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1533
1534 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1535 you actually subscribe to.
1536
1537 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1538 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1539 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1540 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1541
1542 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1543 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1544 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1545 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1546 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1547 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1548
1549 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1550 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1551 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1552 variable.
1553
1554 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1555 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1556 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1557 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1558 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1559 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1560
1561 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1562 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1563
1564 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1565 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1566
1567 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1568 secondary select methods.
1569
1570
1571 @node Startup Variables
1572 @section Startup Variables
1573
1574 @table @code
1575
1576 @item gnus-load-hook
1577 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1578 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1579 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1580 times you start Gnus.
1581
1582 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1583 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1584 A hook called as the first thing when Gnus is started.
1585
1586 @item gnus-startup-hook
1587 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1588 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1589
1590 @item gnus-started-hook
1591 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1592 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1593 successfully.
1594
1595 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1596 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1597 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1598 generating the group buffer.
1599
1600 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1601 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1602 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1603 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1604 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1605 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1606 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1607 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1608
1609 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1610 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1611 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1612 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1613 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1614 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1615
1616 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1617 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1618 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1619
1620 @item gnus-use-backend-marks
1621 @vindex gnus-use-backend-marks
1622 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will store article marks both in the
1623 @file{.newsrc.eld} file and in the backends. This will slow down
1624 group operation some.
1625
1626 @end table
1627
1628
1629 @node Group Buffer
1630 @chapter Group Buffer
1631 @cindex group buffer
1632
1633 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1634 @c
1635 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1636 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1637 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1638 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1639 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1640 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1641 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1642 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1643 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1644 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1645 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1646 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1647 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1648 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1649 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1650 @c human rights at 9...
1651
1652
1653 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1654 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1655 long as Gnus is active.
1656
1657 @iftex
1658 @iflatex
1659 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1660 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1661 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1662 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1663 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1664 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1665 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1666 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1667 }
1668 @end iflatex
1669 @end iftex
1670
1671 @menu
1672 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1673 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1674 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1675 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1676 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1677 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1678 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1679 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1680 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1681 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1682 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1683 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1684 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1685 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1686 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1687 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1688 * Non-ASCII Group Names:: Accessing groups of non-English names.
1689 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1690 @end menu
1691
1692
1693 @node Group Buffer Format
1694 @section Group Buffer Format
1695
1696 @menu
1697 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1698 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1699 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1700 @end menu
1701
1702 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1703 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1704 available in Emacs.
1705
1706 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1707 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1708 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1709 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1710 Emacs version.
1711
1712 @node Group Line Specification
1713 @subsection Group Line Specification
1714 @cindex group buffer format
1715
1716 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1717 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1718
1719 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1720
1721 @example
1722 25: news.announce.newusers
1723 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1724 @end example
1725
1726 Quite simple, huh?
1727
1728 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1729 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1730 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1731 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1732
1733 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1734 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1735 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1736 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1737 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C@.
1738 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1739
1740 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1741
1742 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1743 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1744 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1745 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1746 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1747
1748 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1749 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1750 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1751
1752 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1753
1754 @table @samp
1755
1756 @item M
1757 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1758
1759 @item S
1760 Whether the group is subscribed.
1761
1762 @item L
1763 Level of subscribedness.
1764
1765 @item N
1766 Number of unread articles.
1767
1768 @item I
1769 Number of dormant articles.
1770
1771 @item T
1772 Number of ticked articles.
1773
1774 @item R
1775 Number of read articles.
1776
1777 @item U
1778 Number of unseen articles.
1779
1780 @item t
1781 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1782 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1783
1784 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1785 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1786 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1787 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1788 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1789 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1790 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job.
1791
1792 The nnml backend (@pxref{Mail Spool}) has a feature called ``group
1793 compaction'' which circumvents this deficiency: the idea is to
1794 renumber all articles from 1, removing all gaps between numbers, hence
1795 getting a correct total count. Other backends may support this in the
1796 future. In order to keep your total article count relatively up to
1797 date, you might want to compact your groups (or even directly your
1798 server) from time to time. @xref{Misc Group Stuff}, @xref{Server Commands}.
1799
1800 @item y
1801 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1802
1803 @item i
1804 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1805
1806 @item g
1807 Full group name.
1808
1809 @item G
1810 Group name.
1811
1812 @item C
1813 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1814 comment element in the group parameters.
1815
1816 @item D
1817 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1818 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1819 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1820 command.
1821
1822 @item o
1823 @samp{m} if moderated.
1824
1825 @item O
1826 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1827
1828 @item s
1829 Select method.
1830
1831 @item B
1832 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1833
1834 @item n
1835 Select from where.
1836
1837 @item z
1838 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1839 used.
1840
1841 @item P
1842 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1843
1844 @item c
1845 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1846 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1847 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1848 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1849 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1850
1851 @item m
1852 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1853 @cindex %
1854 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1855 the group lately.
1856
1857 @item p
1858 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1859
1860 @item d
1861 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1862 Timestamp}).
1863
1864 @item F
1865 The disk space used by the articles fetched by both the cache and
1866 agent. The value is automatically scaled to bytes(B), kilobytes(K),
1867 megabytes(M), or gigabytes(G) to minimize the column width. A format
1868 of %7F is sufficient for a fixed-width column.
1869
1870 @item u
1871 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1872 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1873 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1874 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1875 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1876 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1877 specifier.
1878 @end table
1879
1880 @cindex *
1881 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1882 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1883 group, or a bogus native group.
1884
1885
1886 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1887 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1888 @cindex group mode line
1889
1890 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1891 The mode line can be changed by setting
1892 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1893 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1894
1895 @table @samp
1896 @item S
1897 The native news server.
1898 @item M
1899 The native select method.
1900 @end table
1901
1902
1903 @node Group Highlighting
1904 @subsection Group Highlighting
1905 @cindex highlighting
1906 @cindex group highlighting
1907
1908 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1909 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1910 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1911 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1912 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1913
1914 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1915 background is dark:
1916
1917 @lisp
1918 (cond (window-system
1919 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1920 (defface my-group-face-1
1921 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1922 (defface my-group-face-2
1923 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1924 "Second group face")
1925 (defface my-group-face-3
1926 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1927 (defface my-group-face-4
1928 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1929 (defface my-group-face-5
1930 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1931
1932 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1933 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1934 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1935 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1936 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1937 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1938 @end lisp
1939
1940 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1941
1942 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1943 include:
1944
1945 @table @code
1946 @item group
1947 The group name.
1948 @item unread
1949 The number of unread articles in the group.
1950 @item method
1951 The select method.
1952 @item mailp
1953 Whether the group is a mail group.
1954 @item level
1955 The level of the group.
1956 @item score
1957 The score of the group.
1958 @item ticked
1959 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1960 @item total
1961 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1962 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1963 @item topic
1964 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1965 topic being inserted.
1966 @end table
1967
1968 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
1969 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
1970 functions for snarfing info on the group.
1971
1972 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
1973 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
1974 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
1975 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
1976
1977
1978 @node Group Maneuvering
1979 @section Group Maneuvering
1980 @cindex group movement
1981
1982 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
1983 expected, hopefully.
1984
1985 @table @kbd
1986
1987 @item n
1988 @kindex n (Group)
1989 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
1990 Go to the next group that has unread articles
1991 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
1992
1993 @item p
1994 @itemx DEL
1995 @kindex DEL (Group)
1996 @kindex p (Group)
1997 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
1998 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
1999 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2000
2001 @item N
2002 @kindex N (Group)
2003 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2004 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2005
2006 @item P
2007 @kindex P (Group)
2008 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2009 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2010
2011 @item M-n
2012 @kindex M-n (Group)
2013 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2014 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2015 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2016
2017 @item M-p
2018 @kindex M-p (Group)
2019 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2020 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2021 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2022 @end table
2023
2024 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2025
2026 @table @kbd
2027
2028 @item j
2029 @kindex j (Group)
2030 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2031 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2032 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2033 like living groups.
2034
2035 @item ,
2036 @kindex , (Group)
2037 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2038 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2039 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2040
2041 @item .
2042 @kindex . (Group)
2043 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2044 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2045 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2046 @end table
2047
2048 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2049 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2050 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2051 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2052 is @code{t}.
2053
2054 @vindex gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit
2055 If @code{gnus-summary-next-group-on-exit} is @code{t}, when a summary is
2056 exited, the point in the group buffer is moved to the next unread group.
2057 Otherwise, the point is set to the group just exited. The default is
2058 @code{t}.
2059
2060 @node Selecting a Group
2061 @section Selecting a Group
2062 @cindex group selection
2063
2064 @table @kbd
2065
2066 @item SPACE
2067 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2068 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2069 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2070 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2071 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2072 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2073 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2074 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2075 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2076 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2077
2078 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2079 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2080 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2081
2082 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2083 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2084 ones.
2085
2086 @item RET
2087 @kindex RET (Group)
2088 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2089 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2090 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2091 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2092 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2093 entry.
2094
2095 @item M-RET
2096 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2097 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2098 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2099 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2100 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2101 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2102 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2103 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2104 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2105 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2106
2107 @item M-SPACE
2108 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2109 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2110 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2111 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2112 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2113
2114 @item C-M-RET
2115 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2116 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2117 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2118 doing any processing of its contents
2119 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2120 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2121 manner will have no permanent effects.
2122
2123 @end table
2124
2125 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2126 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2127 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2128 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2129 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2130 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2131 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2132 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2133 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2134 most recently will be fetched.
2135
2136 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2137 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2138 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2139 newsgroups.
2140
2141 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2142 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2143 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2144 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2145 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2146 are actually only the articles 1--10 and 29999900--30000000, Gnus doesn't
2147 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2148 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2149 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2150 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2151 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2152 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2153 get only the articles 29990001--30000000 (if the latest article number is
2154 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2155 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2156 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2157 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2158
2159 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2160 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2161 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2162 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2163 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2164 Which article this is controlled by the
2165 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2166 variable are:
2167
2168 @table @code
2169
2170 @item unread
2171 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2172
2173 @item first
2174 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2175
2176 @item unseen
2177 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2178
2179 @item unseen-or-unread
2180 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2181 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2182 unread article.
2183
2184 @item best
2185 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2186
2187 @end table
2188
2189 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2190 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2191
2192 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2193 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2194 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2195 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2196 selected.
2197
2198
2199 @node Subscription Commands
2200 @section Subscription Commands
2201 @cindex subscription
2202
2203 The following commands allow for managing your subscriptions in the
2204 Group buffer. If you want to subscribe to many groups, it's probably
2205 more convenient to go to the @ref{Server Buffer}, and choose the
2206 server there using @kbd{RET} or @kbd{SPC}. Then you'll have the
2207 commands listed in @ref{Browse Foreign Server} at hand.
2208
2209 @table @kbd
2210
2211 @item S t
2212 @itemx u
2213 @kindex S t (Group)
2214 @kindex u (Group)
2215 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2216 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2217 Toggle subscription to the current group
2218 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2219
2220 @item S s
2221 @itemx U
2222 @kindex S s (Group)
2223 @kindex U (Group)
2224 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2225 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2226 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2227 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2228
2229 @item S k
2230 @itemx C-k
2231 @kindex S k (Group)
2232 @kindex C-k (Group)
2233 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2234 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2235 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2236
2237 @item S y
2238 @itemx C-y
2239 @kindex S y (Group)
2240 @kindex C-y (Group)
2241 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2242 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2243
2244 @item C-x C-t
2245 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2246 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2247 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2248 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2249 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2250
2251 @item S w
2252 @itemx C-w
2253 @kindex S w (Group)
2254 @kindex C-w (Group)
2255 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2256 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2257
2258 @item S z
2259 @kindex S z (Group)
2260 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2261 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2262
2263 @item S C-k
2264 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2265 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2266 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2267 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2268 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2269 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2270 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2271 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2272 @file{.newsrc} file.
2273
2274 @end table
2275
2276 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2277
2278
2279 @node Group Data
2280 @section Group Data
2281
2282 @table @kbd
2283
2284 @item c
2285 @kindex c (Group)
2286 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2287 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2288 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2289 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2290 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2291 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2292 the group buffer.
2293
2294 @item C
2295 @kindex C (Group)
2296 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2297 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2298 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2299
2300 @item M-c
2301 @kindex M-c (Group)
2302 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2303 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2304 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2305
2306 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2307 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2308 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2309 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2310 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2311 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2312 caution.
2313
2314 @end table
2315
2316
2317 @node Group Levels
2318 @section Group Levels
2319 @cindex group level
2320 @cindex level
2321
2322 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2323 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2324 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2325 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2326 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2327
2328 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2329
2330 @table @kbd
2331
2332 @item S l
2333 @kindex S l (Group)
2334 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2335 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2336 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2337 prompted for a level.
2338 @end table
2339
2340 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2341 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2342 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2343 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2344 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2345 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2346 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2347 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2348 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2349 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2350 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2351 same, but zombie and killed groups store no information on what articles
2352 you have read, etc. This distinction between dead and living
2353 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2354 reasons of efficiency.
2355
2356 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2357 low levels (e.g., 1 or 2).
2358
2359 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2360 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2361 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2362 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2363 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2364 groups are hidden, in a way.
2365
2366 @cindex zombie groups
2367 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2368 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2369 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2370 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2371 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2372 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2373
2374 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2375 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2376 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2377 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2378 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2379 list of killed groups.)
2380
2381 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2382 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2383 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2384
2385 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2386 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2387 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2388 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2389 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2390 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2391 relevant valid ranges.
2392
2393 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2394 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2395 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2396 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2397 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2398 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2399 rest.
2400
2401 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2402 one with the best level.
2403
2404 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2405 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2406 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2407 by default.
2408 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function will
2409 be called and the result will be used as value.
2410
2411
2412 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2413 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2414 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2415 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2416 listed.
2417
2418 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2419 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2420 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2421 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2422
2423 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2424 Gnus will normally just activate (i.e., query the server about) groups
2425 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2426 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2427 to 5. The default is 6.
2428
2429
2430 @node Group Score
2431 @section Group Score
2432 @cindex group score
2433 @cindex group rank
2434 @cindex rank
2435
2436 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2437 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2438 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2439 reason?
2440
2441 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2442 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2443 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2444 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2445 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2446 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2447 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2448 least significant part.))
2449
2450 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2451 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2452 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2453 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2454 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2455 action after each summary exit, you can add
2456 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2457 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2458 slow things down somewhat.
2459
2460
2461 @node Marking Groups
2462 @section Marking Groups
2463 @cindex marking groups
2464
2465 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2466 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2467 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2468 bidding on those groups.
2469
2470 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2471 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2472 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2473
2474 @table @kbd
2475
2476 @item #
2477 @kindex # (Group)
2478 @itemx M m
2479 @kindex M m (Group)
2480 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2481 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2482
2483 @item M-#
2484 @kindex M-# (Group)
2485 @itemx M u
2486 @kindex M u (Group)
2487 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2488 Remove the mark from the current group
2489 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2490
2491 @item M U
2492 @kindex M U (Group)
2493 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2494 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2495
2496 @item M w
2497 @kindex M w (Group)
2498 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2499 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2500
2501 @item M b
2502 @kindex M b (Group)
2503 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2504 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2505
2506 @item M r
2507 @kindex M r (Group)
2508 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2509 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2510 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2511 @end table
2512
2513 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2514
2515 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2516 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2517 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2518 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2519 the command to be executed.
2520
2521
2522 @node Foreign Groups
2523 @section Foreign Groups
2524 @cindex foreign groups
2525
2526 If you recall how to subscribe to servers (@pxref{Finding the News})
2527 you will remember that @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} and
2528 @code{gnus-select-method} let you write a definition in Emacs Lisp of
2529 what servers you want to see when you start up. The alternate
2530 approach is to use foreign servers and groups. ``Foreign'' here means
2531 they are not coming from the select methods. All foreign server
2532 configuration and subscriptions are stored only in the
2533 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file.
2534
2535 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2536 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2537 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2538 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2539 consulted.
2540
2541 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2542 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2543 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2544
2545 @table @kbd
2546
2547 @item G m
2548 @kindex G m (Group)
2549 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2550 @cindex making groups
2551 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2552 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2553 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2554
2555 @item G M
2556 @kindex G M (Group)
2557 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2558 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2559 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2560
2561 @item G r
2562 @kindex G r (Group)
2563 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2564 @cindex renaming groups
2565 Rename the current group to something else
2566 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2567 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2568 on some back ends.
2569
2570 @item G c
2571 @kindex G c (Group)
2572 @cindex customizing
2573 @findex gnus-group-customize
2574 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2575
2576 @item G e
2577 @kindex G e (Group)
2578 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2579 @cindex renaming groups
2580 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2581 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2582
2583 @item G p
2584 @kindex G p (Group)
2585 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2586 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2587 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2588
2589 @item G E
2590 @kindex G E (Group)
2591 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2592 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2593 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2594
2595 @item G d
2596 @kindex G d (Group)
2597 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2598 @cindex nndir
2599 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2600 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2601
2602 @item G h
2603 @kindex G h (Group)
2604 @cindex help group
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2606 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2607
2608 @item G D
2609 @kindex G D (Group)
2610 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2611 @cindex nneething
2612 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2613 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2614 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2615
2616 @item G f
2617 @kindex G f (Group)
2618 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2619 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2620 @cindex nndoc
2621 Make a group based on some file or other
2622 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2623 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2624 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2625 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2626 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2627 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2628 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2629 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2630 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2631
2632 @item G u
2633 @kindex G u (Group)
2634 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2635 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2636 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2637 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2638
2639 @item G w
2640 @kindex G w (Group)
2641 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2642 @cindex Google
2643 @cindex nnweb
2644 @cindex gmane
2645 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2646 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2647 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2648 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2649 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2650 @xref{Web Searches}.
2651
2652 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2653 to a particular group by using a match string like
2654 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2655
2656 @item G R
2657 @kindex G R (Group)
2658 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2659 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2660 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL@.
2661 @xref{RSS}.
2662
2663 @item G DEL
2664 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2665 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2666 This function will delete the current group
2667 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2668 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2669 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2670 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2671 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2672
2673 @item G V
2674 @kindex G V (Group)
2675 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2676 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2677 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2678
2679 @item G v
2680 @kindex G v (Group)
2681 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2682 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2683 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2684 @end table
2685
2686 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2687 methods.
2688
2689 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2690 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2691 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2692 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2693 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2694 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2695 newsgroups.
2696
2697
2698 The following commands create ephemeral groups. They can be called not
2699 only from the Group buffer, but in any Gnus buffer.
2700
2701 @table @code
2702 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2703 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group
2704 @vindex gnus-gmane-group-download-format
2705 Read an ephemeral group on Gmane.org. The articles are downloaded via
2706 HTTP using the URL specified by @code{gnus-gmane-group-download-format}.
2707 Gnus will prompt you for a group name, the start article number and an
2708 the article range.
2709
2710 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2711 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group-url
2712 This command is similar to @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-gmane-group}, but
2713 the group name and the article number and range are constructed from a
2714 given @acronym{URL}. Supported @acronym{URL} formats include:
2715 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12300/focus=12399},
2716 @indicateurl{http://thread.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2717 @indicateurl{http://article.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/},
2718 @indicateurl{http://permalink.gmane.org/gmane.foo.bar/12345/}, and
2719 @indicateurl{http://news.gmane.org/group/gmane.foo.bar/thread=12345}.
2720
2721 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2722 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group
2723 Read an Emacs bug report in an ephemeral group. Gnus will prompt for a
2724 bug number. The default is the number at point. The @acronym{URL} is
2725 specified in @code{gnus-bug-group-download-format-alist}.
2726
2727 @item gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2728 @findex gnus-read-ephemeral-debian-bug-group
2729 Read a Debian bug report in an ephemeral group. Analog to
2730 @code{gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group}.
2731 @end table
2732
2733 Some of these command are also useful for article buttons, @xref{Article
2734 Buttons}.
2735
2736 Here is an example:
2737 @lisp
2738 (require 'gnus-art)
2739 (add-to-list
2740 'gnus-button-alist
2741 '("#\\([0-9]+\\)\\>" 1
2742 (string-match "\\<emacs\\>" (or gnus-newsgroup-name ""))
2743 gnus-read-ephemeral-emacs-bug-group 1))
2744 @end lisp
2745
2746
2747 @node Group Parameters
2748 @section Group Parameters
2749 @cindex group parameters
2750
2751 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2752
2753 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2754 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2755 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2756 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2757 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2758 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2759 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2760
2761 Here's an example group parameter list:
2762
2763 @example
2764 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2765 (auto-expire . t))
2766 @end example
2767
2768 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2769 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2770 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2771 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2772
2773 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2774 is an alist of regexps and values.
2775
2776 The following group parameters can be used:
2777
2778 @table @code
2779 @item to-address
2780 @cindex to-address
2781 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2782
2783 @example
2784 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2785 @end example
2786
2787 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2788 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2789 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2790 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2791 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2792
2793 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2794 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2795 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2796 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2797 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2798 list address instead.
2799
2800 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2801
2802 @item to-list
2803 @cindex to-list
2804 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2805
2806 @example
2807 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2808 @end example
2809
2810 It is totally ignored
2811 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2812 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2813
2814 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2815 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2816 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2817 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2818 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2819
2820 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2821 @cindex mail list groups
2822 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2823 entering summary buffer.
2824
2825 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2826
2827 @anchor{subscribed}
2828 @item subscribed
2829 @cindex subscribed
2830 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2831 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2832 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2833 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2834 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2835 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2836 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2837 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2838
2839 @lisp
2840 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2841 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2842 @end lisp
2843
2844 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2845 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2846
2847 @item visible
2848 @cindex visible
2849 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2850 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2851 of whether it has any unread articles.
2852
2853 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2854 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2855
2856 @item broken-reply-to
2857 @cindex broken-reply-to
2858 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2859 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2860 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2861 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2862 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2863 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2864
2865 @item to-group
2866 @cindex to-group
2867 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2868 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2869
2870 @item newsgroup
2871 @cindex newsgroup
2872 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2873 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2874 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2875 news group.
2876
2877 @item gcc-self
2878 @cindex gcc-self
2879 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2880 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2881 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2882 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2883 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2884 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2885 (@pxref{Archived Messages}), with the exception for messages to resend.
2886
2887 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2888 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2889 doesn't accept articles.
2890
2891 @item auto-expire
2892 @cindex auto-expire
2893 @cindex expiring mail
2894 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2895 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2896 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2897
2898 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2899
2900 @item total-expire
2901 @cindex total-expire
2902 @cindex expiring mail
2903 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2904 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2905 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2906 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2907 expiry.
2908
2909 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2910
2911 @item expiry-wait
2912 @cindex expiry-wait
2913 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2914 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2915 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2916 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2917 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2918 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2919 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2920
2921 @item expiry-target
2922 @cindex expiry-target
2923 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2924 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2925
2926 @item score-file
2927 @cindex score file group parameter
2928 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2929 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2930 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2931
2932 @item adapt-file
2933 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2934 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2935 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2936 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2937
2938 @item admin-address
2939 @cindex admin-address
2940 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2941 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2942 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2943 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2944
2945 @item display
2946 @cindex display
2947 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2948 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2949
2950 @table @code
2951 @item all
2952 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2953
2954 @item an integer
2955 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2956 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2957
2958 @item default
2959 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2960 ticked articles.
2961
2962 @item an array
2963 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2964
2965 Here are some examples:
2966
2967 @table @code
2968 @item [unread]
2969 Display only unread articles.
2970
2971 @item [not expire]
2972 Display everything except expirable articles.
2973
2974 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2975 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2976 responded to.
2977 @end table
2978
2979 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2980 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2981 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2982 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2983 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, and @code{unseen}.
2984
2985 @end table
2986
2987 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2988 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2989 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2990
2991 @item comment
2992 @cindex comment
2993 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2994 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2995 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2996
2997 @item charset
2998 @cindex charset
2999 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
3000 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
3001 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
3002
3003 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
3004
3005 @item ignored-charsets
3006 @cindex ignored-charset
3007 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
3008 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
3009 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
3010
3011 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
3012
3013 @item posting-style
3014 @cindex posting-style
3015 You can store additional posting style information for this group
3016 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
3017 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
3018 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
3019 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3020
3021 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3022 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3023 like this in the group parameters:
3024
3025 @example
3026 (posting-style
3027 (name "Funky Name")
3028 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
3029 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3030 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3031 @end example
3032
3033 If you're using topics to organize your group buffer
3034 (@pxref{Group Topics}), note that posting styles can also be set in
3035 the topics parameters. Posting styles in topic parameters apply to all
3036 groups in this topic. More precisely, the posting-style settings for a
3037 group result from the hierarchical merging of all posting-style
3038 entries in the parameters of this group and all the topics it belongs
3039 to.
3040
3041
3042 @item post-method
3043 @cindex post-method
3044 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3045 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3046
3047 @item mail-source
3048 @cindex mail-source
3049 If it is set, and the setting of @code{mail-sources} includes a
3050 @code{group} mail source (@pxref{Mail Sources}), the value is a
3051 mail source for this group.
3052
3053 @item banner
3054 @cindex banner
3055 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3056 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3057 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3058 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3059 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3060
3061 @item sieve
3062 @cindex sieve
3063 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3064 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3065 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3066 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3067
3068 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3069 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3070 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3071 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3072
3073 @example
3074 if address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com" @{
3075 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3076 @}
3077 @end example
3078
3079 To generate tests for multiple email-addresses use a group parameter
3080 like @code{(sieve address "sender" ("name@@one.org" else@@two.org"))}.
3081 When generating a sieve script (@pxref{Sieve Commands}) Sieve code
3082 like the following is generated:
3083
3084 @example
3085 if address "sender" ["name@@one.org", "else@@two.org"] @{
3086 fileinto "INBOX.list.sieve";
3087 @}
3088 @end example
3089
3090 See @pxref{Sieve Commands} for commands and variables that might be of
3091 interest in relation to the sieve parameter.
3092
3093 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3094 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3095
3096 @item (agent parameters)
3097 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of its parameters to
3098 control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3099 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3100 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3101 minimize the configuration effort.
3102
3103 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3104 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3105 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3106 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3107 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3108 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3109 @code{eval}ed there.
3110
3111 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer
3112 if and only if @var{variable} has been bound as a variable. Otherwise,
3113 only evaluating the form will take place. So, you may want to bind the
3114 variable in advance using @code{defvar} or other if the result of the
3115 form needs to be set to it.
3116
3117 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3118 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3119 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3120 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3121 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3122 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3123 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3124
3125 @lisp
3126 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3127 @end lisp
3128
3129 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3130 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3131 the subject fields of articles. E.g., if the news group
3132
3133 @example
3134 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3135 @end example
3136
3137 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3138 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3139 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3140 into the group parameters for the group.
3141
3142 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3143 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3144 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group. If
3145 @code{dummy-variable} has been bound (see above), it will be set to the
3146 (meaningless) result of the @code{(ding)} form.
3147
3148 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3149 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3150 following is added to a group parameter
3151
3152 @lisp
3153 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3154 (lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3155 @end lisp
3156
3157 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3158 expired.
3159
3160 @end table
3161
3162 @vindex gnus-parameters
3163 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3164 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3165 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3166 For example:
3167
3168 @lisp
3169 (setq gnus-parameters
3170 '(("mail\\..*"
3171 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3172 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3173 (gnus-summary-line-format
3174 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3175 (gcc-self . t)
3176 (display . all))
3177
3178 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3179 (to-group . "\\1"))
3180
3181 ("mail\\.me"
3182 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3183
3184 ("list\\..*"
3185 (total-expire . t)
3186 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3187 @end lisp
3188
3189 All clauses that matches the group name will be used, but the last
3190 setting ``wins''. So if you have two clauses that both match the
3191 group name, and both set, say @code{display}, the last setting will
3192 override the first.
3193
3194 Parameters that are strings will be subjected to regexp substitution,
3195 as the @code{to-group} example shows.
3196
3197 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3198 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3199 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3200 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3201 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3202 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3203 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3204 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3205 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3206 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3207 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3208 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3209
3210 You can define different sorting to different groups via
3211 @code{gnus-parameters}. Here is an example to sort an @acronym{NNTP}
3212 group by reverse date to see the latest news at the top and an
3213 @acronym{RSS} group by subject. In this example, the first group is the
3214 Debian daily news group @code{gmane.linux.debian.user.news} from
3215 news.gmane.org. The @acronym{RSS} group corresponds to the Debian
3216 weekly news RSS feed
3217 @url{http://packages.debian.org/unstable/newpkg_main.en.rdf},
3218 @xref{RSS}.
3219
3220 @lisp
3221 (setq
3222 gnus-parameters
3223 '(("nntp.*gmane\\.debian\\.user\\.news"
3224 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3225 (gnus-article-sort-functions '((not gnus-article-sort-by-date)))
3226 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3227 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
3228 ("nnrss.*debian"
3229 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3230 (gnus-article-sort-functions 'gnus-article-sort-by-subject)
3231 (gnus-use-adaptive-scoring nil)
3232 (gnus-use-scoring t)
3233 (gnus-score-find-score-files-function 'gnus-score-find-single)
3234 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%d %I%(%[ %s %]%)\n"))))
3235 @end lisp
3236
3237
3238 @node Listing Groups
3239 @section Listing Groups
3240 @cindex group listing
3241
3242 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3243
3244 @table @kbd
3245
3246 @item l
3247 @itemx A s
3248 @kindex A s (Group)
3249 @kindex l (Group)
3250 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3251 List all groups that have unread articles
3252 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3253 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3254 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3255 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3256 groups).
3257
3258 @item L
3259 @itemx A u
3260 @kindex A u (Group)
3261 @kindex L (Group)
3262 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3263 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3264 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3265 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3266 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3267 unsubscribed groups).
3268
3269 @item A l
3270 @kindex A l (Group)
3271 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3272 List all unread groups on a specific level
3273 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3274 with no unread articles.
3275
3276 @item A k
3277 @kindex A k (Group)
3278 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3279 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3280 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3281 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3282 from the server.
3283
3284 @item A z
3285 @kindex A z (Group)
3286 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3287 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3288
3289 @item A m
3290 @kindex A m (Group)
3291 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3292 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3293 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3294
3295 @item A M
3296 @kindex A M (Group)
3297 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3298 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3299
3300 @item A A
3301 @kindex A A (Group)
3302 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3303 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3304 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3305 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3306 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3307 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3308 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3309 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3310
3311 @item A a
3312 @kindex A a (Group)
3313 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3314 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3315 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3316
3317 @item A d
3318 @kindex A d (Group)
3319 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3320 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3321 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3322
3323 @item A c
3324 @kindex A c (Group)
3325 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3326 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3327
3328 @item A ?
3329 @kindex A ? (Group)
3330 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3331 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3332
3333 @item A !
3334 @kindex A ! (Group)
3335 @findex gnus-group-list-ticked
3336 List all groups with ticked articles (@code{gnus-group-list-ticked}).
3337
3338 @item A /
3339 @kindex A / (Group)
3340 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3341 Further limit groups within the current selection
3342 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}). If you've first limited to groups
3343 with dormant articles with @kbd{A ?}, you can then further limit with
3344 @kbd{A / c}, which will then limit to groups with cached articles,
3345 giving you the groups that have both dormant articles and cached
3346 articles.
3347
3348 @item A f
3349 @kindex A f (Group)
3350 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3351 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3352
3353 @item A p
3354 @kindex A p (Group)
3355 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3356 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3357
3358 @end table
3359
3360 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3361 @cindex visible group parameter
3362 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3363 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3364 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3365 get the same effect.
3366
3367 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3368 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3369 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3370 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3371 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3372
3373
3374 @node Sorting Groups
3375 @section Sorting Groups
3376 @cindex sorting groups
3377
3378 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3379 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3380 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3381 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3382 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3383 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3384 include:
3385
3386 @table @code
3387
3388 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3389 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3390 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3391
3392 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3393 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3394 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3395
3396 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3397 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3398 Sort by group level.
3399
3400 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3401 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3402 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3403
3404 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3405 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3406 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3407 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3408
3409 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3410 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3411 Sort by number of unread articles.
3412
3413 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3414 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3415 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3416
3417 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3418 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3419 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3420
3421
3422 @end table
3423
3424 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3425 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3426 the last one.
3427
3428
3429 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3430 some sorting criteria:
3431
3432 @table @kbd
3433 @item G S a
3434 @kindex G S a (Group)
3435 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3436 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3437 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3438
3439 @item G S u
3440 @kindex G S u (Group)
3441 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3442 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3443 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3444
3445 @item G S l
3446 @kindex G S l (Group)
3447 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3448 Sort the group buffer by group level
3449 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3450
3451 @item G S v
3452 @kindex G S v (Group)
3453 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3454 Sort the group buffer by group score
3455 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3456
3457 @item G S r
3458 @kindex G S r (Group)
3459 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3460 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3461 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3462
3463 @item G S m
3464 @kindex G S m (Group)
3465 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3466 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3467 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3468
3469 @item G S n
3470 @kindex G S n (Group)
3471 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3472 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3473 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3474
3475 @end table
3476
3477 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3478 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3479
3480 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3481 commands will sort in reverse order.
3482
3483 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3484
3485 @table @kbd
3486 @item G P a
3487 @kindex G P a (Group)
3488 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3489 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3490 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3491
3492 @item G P u
3493 @kindex G P u (Group)
3494 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3495 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3496 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3497
3498 @item G P l
3499 @kindex G P l (Group)
3500 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3501 Sort the groups by group level
3502 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3503
3504 @item G P v
3505 @kindex G P v (Group)
3506 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3507 Sort the groups by group score
3508 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3509
3510 @item G P r
3511 @kindex G P r (Group)
3512 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3513 Sort the groups by group rank
3514 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3515
3516 @item G P m
3517 @kindex G P m (Group)
3518 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3519 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3520 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3521
3522 @item G P n
3523 @kindex G P n (Group)
3524 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3525 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3526 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3527
3528 @item G P s
3529 @kindex G P s (Group)
3530 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3531 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3532
3533 @end table
3534
3535 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3536 move groups around.
3537
3538
3539 @node Group Maintenance
3540 @section Group Maintenance
3541 @cindex bogus groups
3542
3543 @table @kbd
3544 @item b
3545 @kindex b (Group)
3546 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3547 Find bogus groups and delete them
3548 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3549
3550 @item F
3551 @kindex F (Group)
3552 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3553 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3554 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3555 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3556 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3557 zombies.
3558
3559 @item C-c C-x
3560 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3561 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3562 @cindex expiring mail
3563 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3564 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3565 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3566 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3567
3568 @item C-c C-M-x
3569 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3570 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3571 @cindex expiring mail
3572 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3573 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3574
3575 @end table
3576
3577
3578 @node Browse Foreign Server
3579 @section Browse Foreign Server
3580 @cindex foreign servers
3581 @cindex browsing servers
3582
3583 @table @kbd
3584 @item B
3585 @kindex B (Group)
3586 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3587 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3588 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3589 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3590 @end table
3591
3592 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3593 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3594 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3595 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3596
3597 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3598
3599 @table @kbd
3600 @item n
3601 @kindex n (Browse)
3602 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3603 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3604
3605 @item p
3606 @kindex p (Browse)
3607 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3608 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3609
3610 @item SPACE
3611 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3612 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3613 Enter the current group and display the first article
3614 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3615
3616 @item RET
3617 @kindex RET (Browse)
3618 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3619 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3620
3621 @item u
3622 @kindex u (Browse)
3623 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3624 @vindex gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method
3625 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3626 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}). You
3627 can affect the way the new group is entered into the Group buffer
3628 using the variable @code{gnus-browse-subscribe-newsgroup-method}. See
3629 @pxref{Subscription Methods} for available options.
3630
3631 @item l
3632 @itemx q
3633 @kindex q (Browse)
3634 @kindex l (Browse)
3635 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3636 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3637
3638 @item d
3639 @kindex d (Browse)
3640 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3641 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3642
3643 @item ?
3644 @kindex ? (Browse)
3645 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3646 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3647 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3648 @end table
3649
3650
3651 @node Exiting Gnus
3652 @section Exiting Gnus
3653 @cindex exiting Gnus
3654
3655 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3656
3657 @table @kbd
3658 @item z
3659 @kindex z (Group)
3660 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3661 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3662 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3663 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3664
3665 @item q
3666 @kindex q (Group)
3667 @findex gnus-group-exit
3668 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3669 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3670
3671 @item Q
3672 @kindex Q (Group)
3673 @findex gnus-group-quit
3674 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3675 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3676 @end table
3677
3678 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3679 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3680 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3681 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3682 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3683 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3684 exiting Gnus.
3685
3686 Note:
3687
3688 @quotation
3689 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3690 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3691 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3692 plastic chair.
3693 @end quotation
3694
3695
3696 @node Group Topics
3697 @section Group Topics
3698 @cindex topics
3699
3700 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3701 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3702 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3703 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3704 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3705 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3706
3707 @iftex
3708 @iflatex
3709 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3710 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3711 }
3712 @end iflatex
3713 @end iftex
3714
3715 Here's an example:
3716
3717 @example
3718 Gnus
3719 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3720 3: comp.emacs
3721 2: alt.religion.emacs
3722 Naughty Emacs
3723 452: alt.sex.emacs
3724 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3725 Misc
3726 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3727 13: comp.sources.unix
3728 @end example
3729
3730 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3731 @kindex t (Group)
3732 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3733 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3734 is a toggling command.)
3735
3736 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3737 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3738 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3739 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3740 Hot and bothered?
3741
3742 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3743 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3744 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3745
3746 @lisp
3747 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3748 @end lisp
3749
3750 @menu
3751 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3752 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3753 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3754 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3755 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3756 @end menu
3757
3758
3759 @node Topic Commands
3760 @subsection Topic Commands
3761 @cindex topic commands
3762
3763 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3764 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3765 definitions slightly.
3766
3767 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3768 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3769 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3770 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3771 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3772 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3773
3774 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3775 the way you like.
3776
3777 @table @kbd
3778
3779 @item T n
3780 @kindex T n (Topic)
3781 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3782 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3783 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3784
3785 @item T TAB
3786 @itemx TAB
3787 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3788 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3789 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3790 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3791 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3792 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3793
3794 @item M-TAB
3795 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3796 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3797 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3798 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3799
3800 @end table
3801
3802 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3803 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3804 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3805 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3806
3807 @table @kbd
3808
3809 @item C-k
3810 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3811 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3812 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3813 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3814
3815 @item C-y
3816 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3817 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3818 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3819 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3820 before all groups.
3821
3822 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3823 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3824 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3825 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3826 paste. Like I said---E-Z.
3827
3828 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3829 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3830
3831 @end table
3832
3833 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3834 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3835 key.
3836
3837 @table @kbd
3838
3839 @item RET
3840 @kindex RET (Topic)
3841 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3842 @itemx SPACE
3843 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3844 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3845 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3846 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3847 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3848 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3849
3850 @end table
3851
3852 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3853
3854 @table @kbd
3855
3856 @item T m
3857 @kindex T m (Topic)
3858 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3859 Move the current group to some other topic
3860 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3861 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3862
3863 @item T j
3864 @kindex T j (Topic)
3865 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3866 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3867
3868 @item T c
3869 @kindex T c (Topic)
3870 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3871 Copy the current group to some other topic
3872 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3873 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3874
3875 @item T h
3876 @kindex T h (Topic)
3877 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3878 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3879 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3880
3881 @item T s
3882 @kindex T s (Topic)
3883 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3884 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3885 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3886
3887 @item T D
3888 @kindex T D (Topic)
3889 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3890 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3891 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3892 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3893 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3894 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3895 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3896 topic.
3897
3898 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3899 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3900
3901 @item T M
3902 @kindex T M (Topic)
3903 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3904 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3905 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3906
3907 @item T C
3908 @kindex T C (Topic)
3909 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3910 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3911 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3912
3913 @item T H
3914 @kindex T H (Topic)
3915 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3916 Toggle hiding empty topics
3917 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3918
3919 @item T #
3920 @kindex T # (Topic)
3921 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3922 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3923 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3924 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3925
3926 @item T M-#
3927 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3928 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3929 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3930 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3931 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3932
3933 @item C-c C-x
3934 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3935 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3936 @cindex expiring mail
3937 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3938 expiry process (if any)
3939 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3940
3941 @item T r
3942 @kindex T r (Topic)
3943 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3944 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3945
3946 @item T DEL
3947 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3948 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3949 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3950
3951 @item A T
3952 @kindex A T (Topic)
3953 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3954 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3955 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3956
3957 @item T M-n
3958 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3959 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3960 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3961
3962 @item T M-p
3963 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3964 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3965 Go to the previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3966
3967 @item G p
3968 @kindex G p (Topic)
3969 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3970 @cindex group parameters
3971 @cindex topic parameters
3972 @cindex parameters
3973 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3974 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3975
3976 @end table
3977
3978
3979 @node Topic Variables
3980 @subsection Topic Variables
3981 @cindex topic variables
3982
3983 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3984 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3985
3986 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3987 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3988 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3989 Valid elements are:
3990
3991 @table @samp
3992 @item i
3993 Indentation.
3994 @item n
3995 Topic name.
3996 @item v
3997 Visibility.
3998 @item l
3999 Level.
4000 @item g
4001 Number of groups in the topic.
4002 @item a
4003 Number of unread articles in the topic.
4004 @item A
4005 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
4006 @end table
4007
4008 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
4009 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
4010 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
4011 The default is 2.
4012
4013 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
4014 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
4015
4016 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
4017 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
4018 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
4019
4020
4021 @node Topic Sorting
4022 @subsection Topic Sorting
4023 @cindex topic sorting
4024
4025 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
4026 commands:
4027
4028
4029 @table @kbd
4030 @item T S a
4031 @kindex T S a (Topic)
4032 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
4033 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
4034 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
4035
4036 @item T S u
4037 @kindex T S u (Topic)
4038 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
4039 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
4040 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
4041
4042 @item T S l
4043 @kindex T S l (Topic)
4044 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
4045 Sort the current topic by group level
4046 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
4047
4048 @item T S v
4049 @kindex T S v (Topic)
4050 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
4051 Sort the current topic by group score
4052 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
4053
4054 @item T S r
4055 @kindex T S r (Topic)
4056 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
4057 Sort the current topic by group rank
4058 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
4059
4060 @item T S m
4061 @kindex T S m (Topic)
4062 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
4063 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
4064 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
4065
4066 @item T S e
4067 @kindex T S e (Topic)
4068 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
4069 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
4070 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
4071
4072 @item T S s
4073 @kindex T S s (Topic)
4074 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
4075 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
4076 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
4077 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
4078
4079 @end table
4080
4081 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
4082 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
4083 sorting.
4084
4085
4086 @node Topic Topology
4087 @subsection Topic Topology
4088 @cindex topic topology
4089 @cindex topology
4090
4091 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
4092
4093 @example
4094 @group
4095 Gnus
4096 Emacs -- I wuw it!
4097 3: comp.emacs
4098 2: alt.religion.emacs
4099 Naughty Emacs
4100 452: alt.sex.emacs
4101 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4102 Misc
4103 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4104 13: comp.sources.unix
4105 @end group
4106 @end example
4107
4108 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4109 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4110 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4111 follows:
4112
4113 @lisp
4114 (("Gnus" visible)
4115 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4116 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4117 (("Misc" visible)))
4118 @end lisp
4119
4120 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4121 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4122 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4123 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4124 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4125 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4126
4127 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4128 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4129 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4130
4131
4132 @node Topic Parameters
4133 @subsection Topic Parameters
4134 @cindex topic parameters
4135
4136 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4137 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4138 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4139 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4140 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4141
4142 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4143 parameters:
4144
4145 @table @code
4146 @item subscribe
4147 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4148 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4149 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4150 topic.
4151
4152 @item subscribe-level
4153 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4154 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4155 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4156
4157 @end table
4158
4159 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4160 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4161 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4162 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4163
4164 @example
4165 @group
4166 Gnus
4167 Emacs
4168 3: comp.emacs
4169 2: alt.religion.emacs
4170 452: alt.sex.emacs
4171 Relief
4172 452: alt.sex.emacs
4173 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4174 Misc
4175 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4176 13: comp.sources.unix
4177 452: alt.sex.emacs
4178 @end group
4179 @end example
4180
4181 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4182 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4183 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4184 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4185 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4186 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4187
4188 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4189 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4190 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4191 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4192 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4193
4194 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4195 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4196 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4197 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4198 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4199 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4200 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4201 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4202
4203
4204 @node Non-ASCII Group Names
4205 @section Accessing groups of non-English names
4206 @cindex non-ascii group names
4207
4208 There are some news servers that provide groups of which the names are
4209 expressed with their native languages in the world. For instance, in a
4210 certain news server there are some newsgroups of which the names are
4211 spelled in Chinese, where people are talking in Chinese. You can, of
4212 course, subscribe to such news groups using Gnus. Currently Gnus
4213 supports non-@acronym{ASCII} group names not only with the @code{nntp}
4214 back end but also with the @code{nnml} back end and the @code{nnrss}
4215 back end.
4216
4217 Every such group name is encoded by a certain charset in the server
4218 side (in an @acronym{NNTP} server its administrator determines the
4219 charset, but for groups in the other back ends it is determined by you).
4220 Gnus has to display the decoded ones for you in the group buffer and the
4221 article buffer, and needs to use the encoded ones when communicating
4222 with servers. However, Gnus doesn't know what charset is used for each
4223 non-@acronym{ASCII} group name. The following two variables are just
4224 the ones for telling Gnus what charset should be used for each group:
4225
4226 @table @code
4227 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4228 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4229 An alist of select methods and charsets. The default value is
4230 @code{nil}. The names of groups in the server specified by that select
4231 method are all supposed to use the corresponding charset. For example:
4232
4233 @lisp
4234 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4235 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4236 @end lisp
4237
4238 Charsets specified for groups with this variable are preferred to the
4239 ones specified for the same groups with the
4240 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} variable (see below).
4241
4242 A select method can be very long, like:
4243
4244 @lisp
4245 (nntp "gmane"
4246 (nntp-address "news.gmane.org")
4247 (nntp-end-of-line "\n")
4248 (nntp-open-connection-function
4249 nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
4250 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
4251 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
4252 ("-C" "-t" "-e" "none"))
4253 (nntp-via-address @dots{}))
4254 @end lisp
4255
4256 In that case, you can truncate it into @code{(nntp "gmane")} in this
4257 variable. That is, it is enough to contain only the back end name and
4258 the server name.
4259
4260 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4261 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4262 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4263 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names.
4264 @code{((".*" . utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported,
4265 otherwise the default is @code{nil}. For example:
4266
4267 @lisp
4268 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4269 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)
4270 (".*" . utf-8)))
4271 @end lisp
4272
4273 Note that this variable is ignored if the match is made with
4274 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist}.
4275 @end table
4276
4277 Those two variables are used also to determine the charset for encoding
4278 and decoding non-@acronym{ASCII} group names that are in the back ends
4279 other than @code{nntp}. It means that it is you who determine it. If
4280 you do nothing, the charset used for group names in those back ends will
4281 all be @code{utf-8} because of the last element of
4282 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4283
4284 There is one more important variable for non-@acronym{ASCII} group
4285 names:
4286
4287 @table @code
4288 @item nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4289 @vindex nnmail-pathname-coding-system
4290 The value of this variable should be a coding system or @code{nil}. The
4291 default is @code{nil} in Emacs, or is the aliasee of the coding system
4292 named @code{file-name} (a certain coding system of which an alias is
4293 @code{file-name}) in XEmacs.
4294
4295 The @code{nnml} back end, the @code{nnrss} back end, the agent, and
4296 the cache use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names in those files and
4297 directories. This variable overrides the value of
4298 @code{file-name-coding-system} which specifies the coding system used
4299 when encoding and decoding those file names and directory names.
4300
4301 In XEmacs (with the @code{mule} feature), @code{file-name-coding-system}
4302 is the only means to specify the coding system used to encode and decode
4303 file names. On the other hand, Emacs uses the value of
4304 @code{default-file-name-coding-system} if @code{file-name-coding-system}
4305 is @code{nil} or it is bound to the value of
4306 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} which is @code{nil}.
4307
4308 Normally the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system} in Emacs or
4309 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} in XEmacs is initialized according
4310 to the locale, so you will need to do nothing if the value is suitable
4311 to encode and decode non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4312
4313 The value of this variable (or @code{default-file-name-coding-system})
4314 does not necessarily need to be the same value that is determined by
4315 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} and
4316 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist}.
4317
4318 If @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable is
4319 initialized by default to @code{iso-latin-1} for example, although you
4320 want to subscribe to the groups spelled in Chinese, that is the most
4321 typical case where you have to customize
4322 @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}. The @code{utf-8} coding system is
4323 a good candidate for it. Otherwise, you may change the locale in your
4324 system so that @code{default-file-name-coding-system} or this variable
4325 may be initialized to an appropriate value.
4326 @end table
4327
4328 Note that when you copy or move articles from a non-@acronym{ASCII}
4329 group to another group, the charset used to encode and decode group
4330 names should be the same in both groups. Otherwise the Newsgroups
4331 header will be displayed incorrectly in the article buffer.
4332
4333
4334 @node Misc Group Stuff
4335 @section Misc Group Stuff
4336
4337 @menu
4338 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4339 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4340 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4341 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4342 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4343 @end menu
4344
4345 @table @kbd
4346
4347 @item v
4348 @kindex v (Group)
4349 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4350 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4351 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4352
4353 @lisp
4354 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4355 (lambda ()
4356 (interactive)
4357 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4358 @end lisp
4359
4360 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4361 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4362
4363 @item ^
4364 @kindex ^ (Group)
4365 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4366 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4367 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4368
4369 @item a
4370 @kindex a (Group)
4371 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4372 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4373 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4374 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4375 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4376 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4377 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4378
4379 @item m
4380 @kindex m (Group)
4381 @findex gnus-group-mail
4382 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4383 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4384 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4385 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4386
4387 @item i
4388 @kindex i (Group)
4389 @findex gnus-group-news
4390 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4391 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4392 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4393
4394 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4395 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4396 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4397 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4398 for this to work though.
4399
4400 @item G z
4401 @kindex G z (Group)
4402 @findex gnus-group-compact-group
4403
4404 Compact the group under point (@code{gnus-group-compact-group}).
4405 Currently implemented only in nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes
4406 gaps between article numbers, hence getting a correct total article
4407 count.
4408
4409 @end table
4410
4411 Variables for the group buffer:
4412
4413 @table @code
4414
4415 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4416 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4417 is called after the group buffer has been
4418 created.
4419
4420 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4421 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4422 is called after the group buffer is
4423 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4424 unnatural way.
4425
4426 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4427 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4428 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4429 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4430
4431 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4432 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4433 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4434 whether they are empty or not.
4435
4436 @end table
4437
4438 @node Scanning New Messages
4439 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4440 @cindex new messages
4441 @cindex scanning new news
4442
4443 @table @kbd
4444
4445 @item g
4446 @kindex g (Group)
4447 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4448 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4449 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4450 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4451 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4452 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4453 back end(s).
4454
4455 @item M-g
4456 @kindex M-g (Group)
4457 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4458 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4459 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4460 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4461 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4462 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4463 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4464
4465 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4466 @cindex activating groups
4467 @item C-c M-g
4468 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4469 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4470
4471 @item R
4472 @kindex R (Group)
4473 @cindex restarting
4474 @findex gnus-group-restart
4475 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4476 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4477 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4478
4479 @end table
4480
4481 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4482 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4483
4484 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4485 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4486 news.
4487
4488
4489 @node Group Information
4490 @subsection Group Information
4491 @cindex group information
4492 @cindex information on groups
4493
4494 @table @kbd
4495
4496
4497 @item H d
4498 @itemx C-c C-d
4499 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4500 @kindex H d (Group)
4501 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4502 @cindex describing groups
4503 @cindex group description
4504 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4505 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4506 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4507
4508 @item M-d
4509 @kindex M-d (Group)
4510 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4511 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4512 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4513
4514 @item H v
4515 @itemx V
4516 @kindex V (Group)
4517 @kindex H v (Group)
4518 @cindex version
4519 @findex gnus-version
4520 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4521
4522 @item ?
4523 @kindex ? (Group)
4524 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4525 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4526
4527 @item C-c C-i
4528 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4529 @cindex info
4530 @cindex manual
4531 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4532 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4533 @end table
4534
4535
4536 @node Group Timestamp
4537 @subsection Group Timestamp
4538 @cindex timestamps
4539 @cindex group timestamps
4540
4541 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4542 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4543 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4544
4545 @lisp
4546 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4547 @end lisp
4548
4549 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4550
4551 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4552 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4553
4554 @lisp
4555 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4556 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4557 @end lisp
4558
4559 This will result in lines looking like:
4560
4561 @example
4562 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4563 0: custom 19961002T012713
4564 @end example
4565
4566 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4567 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4568 something like:
4569
4570 @lisp
4571 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4572 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4573 @end lisp
4574
4575 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4576 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4577 trick:
4578
4579 @lisp
4580 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4581 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4582 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4583 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4584 (if time
4585 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4586 "")))
4587 @end lisp
4588
4589 To see what variables are dynamically bound (like
4590 @code{gnus-tmp-group}), you have to look at the source code. The
4591 variable names aren't guaranteed to be stable over Gnus versions,
4592 either.
4593
4594
4595 @node File Commands
4596 @subsection File Commands
4597 @cindex file commands
4598
4599 @table @kbd
4600
4601 @item r
4602 @kindex r (Group)
4603 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4604 @vindex gnus-init-file
4605 @cindex reading init file
4606 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4607 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4608
4609 @item s
4610 @kindex s (Group)
4611 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4612 @cindex saving .newsrc
4613 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4614 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4615 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4616
4617 @c @item Z
4618 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4619 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4620 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4621
4622 @end table
4623
4624
4625 @node Sieve Commands
4626 @subsection Sieve Commands
4627 @cindex group sieve commands
4628
4629 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4630 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4631 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4632 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4633 script that can be transferred to the server somehow.
4634
4635 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4636 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4637 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4638 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4639 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4640 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4641 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4642 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4643 regenerate the Sieve script.
4644
4645 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4646 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4647 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4648 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4649 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4650 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4651 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4652 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4653 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4654 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4655
4656 @example
4657 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4658 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4659 stop;
4660 @}
4661 @end example
4662
4663 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4664
4665 @table @kbd
4666
4667 @item D g
4668 @kindex D g (Group)
4669 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4670 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4671 @cindex generating sieve script
4672 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4673 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4674
4675 @item D u
4676 @kindex D u (Group)
4677 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4678 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4679 @cindex updating sieve script
4680 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4681 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4682 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4683
4684 @end table
4685
4686
4687 @node Summary Buffer
4688 @chapter Summary Buffer
4689 @cindex summary buffer
4690
4691 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4692 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4693
4694 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4695 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4696
4697 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4698
4699 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4700 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4701 available in Emacs.
4702
4703 @kindex v (Summary)
4704 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4705 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4706 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4707 @lisp
4708 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4709 @end lisp
4710
4711 @menu
4712 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4713 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4714 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4715 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4716 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4717 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4718 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4719 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4720 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4721 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4722 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4723 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4724 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4725 * Sticky Articles:: Article buffers that are not reused.
4726 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4727 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4728 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4729 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4730 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4731 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4732 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4733 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4734 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4735 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4736 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4737 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4738 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4739 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4740 or reselecting the current group.
4741 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4742 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4743 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4744 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4745 @end menu
4746
4747
4748 @node Summary Buffer Format
4749 @section Summary Buffer Format
4750 @cindex summary buffer format
4751
4752 @iftex
4753 @iflatex
4754 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4755 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4756 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4757 }
4758 @end iflatex
4759 @end iftex
4760
4761 @menu
4762 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4763 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4764 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4765 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4769 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4770 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4771 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4772 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4773 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4774 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4775 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4776 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4777 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4778 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4779
4780 @lisp
4781 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4782 'mail-extract-address-components)
4783 @end lisp
4784
4785 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4786 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4787 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4788 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4789
4790
4791 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4792 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4793
4794 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4795 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4796 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4797 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4798 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4799
4800 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4801 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4802 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4803 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4804 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4805 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4806
4807 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4808
4809 The following format specification characters and extended format
4810 specification(s) are understood:
4811
4812 @table @samp
4813 @item N
4814 Article number.
4815 @item S
4816 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4817 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4818 @item s
4819 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4820 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4821 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4822 @item F
4823 Full @code{From} header.
4824 @item n
4825 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4826 @item f
4827 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4828 From Newsgroups}).
4829 @item a
4830 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4831 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4832 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4833 may be more thorough.
4834 @item A
4835 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4836 the @code{a} spec.
4837 @item L
4838 Number of lines in the article.
4839 @item c
4840 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4841 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4842 @item k
4843 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4844 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4845 @item I
4846 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4847 @item B
4848 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4849 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4850
4851 @example
4852 >
4853 +->
4854 | +->
4855 | | \->
4856 | | \->
4857 | \->
4858 +->
4859 \->
4860 @end example
4861
4862 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4863 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4864 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4865 line-drawing glyphs.
4866 @table @code
4867 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4868 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4869 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4870 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4871
4872 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4873 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4874 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4875 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4876
4877 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4878 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4879 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4880 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4881
4882 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4883 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4884 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4885
4886 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4887 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4888 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4889
4890 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4891 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4892 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4893
4894 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4895 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4896 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4897
4898 @end table
4899
4900 @item T
4901 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4902 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4903 @item [
4904 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4905 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4906 @item ]
4907 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4908 for adopted articles.
4909 @item >
4910 One space for each thread level.
4911 @item <
4912 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4913 @item U
4914 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4915
4916 @item R
4917 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4918 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4919 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4920
4921 @item i
4922 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4923 @item z
4924 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4925 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4926 default level. If the difference between
4927 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4928 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4929 @item V
4930 Total thread score.
4931 @item x
4932 @code{Xref}.
4933 @item D
4934 @code{Date}.
4935 @item d
4936 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4937 @item o
4938 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4939 @item M
4940 @code{Message-ID}.
4941 @item r
4942 @code{References}.
4943 @item t
4944 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4945 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4946 @item e
4947 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4948 article has any children.
4949 @item P
4950 The line number.
4951 @item O
4952 Download mark.
4953 @item *
4954 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4955 @item &user-date;
4956 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4957 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4958 @item u
4959 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4960 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4961 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4962 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4963 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4964 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4965 @end table
4966
4967 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4968 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4969 There can only be one such area.
4970
4971 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4972 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4973 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4974 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4975 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4976 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4977
4978 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4979 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4980
4981 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4982
4983
4984 @node To From Newsgroups
4985 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4986 @cindex To
4987 @cindex Newsgroups
4988
4989 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4990 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4991 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4992 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4993 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4994
4995 @enumerate
4996 @item
4997 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4998 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4999 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
5000 instance:
5001
5002 @lisp
5003 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5004 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
5005 @end lisp
5006
5007 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
5008 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
5009
5010 @item
5011 @findex gnus-extra-header
5012 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
5013 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
5014 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
5015
5016 @example
5017 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
5018 @end example
5019
5020 @item
5021 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5022 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
5023 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
5024 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
5025 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
5026 headers are used instead.
5027
5028 To distinguish regular articles from those where the @code{From} field
5029 has been swapped, a string is prefixed to the @code{To} or
5030 @code{Newsgroups} header in the summary line. By default the string is
5031 @samp{-> } for @code{To} and @samp{=> } for @code{Newsgroups}, you can
5032 customize these strings with @code{gnus-summary-to-prefix} and
5033 @code{gnus-summary-newsgroup-prefix}.
5034
5035 @end enumerate
5036
5037 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
5038 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
5039 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
5040 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
5041 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
5042 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g., nnml) to cause
5043 regeneration.
5044
5045 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
5046 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
5047 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
5048 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
5049
5050 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
5051 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
5052
5053 @lisp
5054 (setq gnus-extra-headers
5055 '(To Newsgroups))
5056 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
5057 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
5058 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
5059 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
5060 "Your Name Here")
5061 @end lisp
5062
5063 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
5064 to fit your needs.)
5065
5066 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
5067 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
5068 support:
5069
5070 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
5071 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
5072 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
5073
5074 @example
5075 Newsgroups:full
5076 @end example
5077
5078 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
5079 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
5080
5081
5082 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
5083 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
5084
5085 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
5086 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
5087 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
5088 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
5089
5090 Here are the elements you can play with:
5091
5092 @table @samp
5093 @item G
5094 Group name.
5095 @item p
5096 Unprefixed group name.
5097 @item A
5098 Current article number.
5099 @item z
5100 Current article score.
5101 @item V
5102 Gnus version.
5103 @item U
5104 Number of unread articles in this group.
5105 @item e
5106 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
5107 summary buffer.
5108 @item Z
5109 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
5110 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
5111 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
5112 and no unselected ones.
5113 @item g
5114 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
5115 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
5116 @item S
5117 Subject of the current article.
5118 @item u
5119 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
5120 @item s
5121 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
5122 @item d
5123 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5124 @item t
5125 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
5126 @item r
5127 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
5128 @item E
5129 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
5130 @end table
5131
5132
5133 @node Summary Highlighting
5134 @subsection Summary Highlighting
5135
5136 @table @code
5137
5138 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5139 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
5140 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
5141 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
5142 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5143
5144 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
5145 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
5146 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
5147 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
5148
5149 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
5150 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
5151 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
5152 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
5153
5154 @item gnus-summary-highlight
5155 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
5156 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
5157 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
5158 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
5159 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
5160 to something like
5161 @lisp
5162 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
5163 ((> score default) . bold))
5164 @end lisp
5165 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
5166 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
5167 @end table
5168
5169
5170 @node Summary Maneuvering
5171 @section Summary Maneuvering
5172 @cindex summary movement
5173
5174 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
5175 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
5176
5177 None of these commands select articles.
5178
5179 @table @kbd
5180 @item G M-n
5181 @itemx M-n
5182 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5183 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5184 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5185 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5186 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5187
5188 @item G M-p
5189 @itemx M-p
5190 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5191 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5192 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5193 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5194 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5195
5196 @item G g
5197 @kindex G g (Summary)
5198 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5199 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5200 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5201 @end table
5202
5203 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5204 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5205 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5206 to the group buffer.
5207
5208 Variables related to summary movement:
5209
5210 @table @code
5211
5212 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5213 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5214 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5215 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5216 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5217 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5218 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5219 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5220 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5221 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5222 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5223 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5224 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5225 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5226
5227 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5228 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5229 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5230 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5231 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5232 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5233 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5234
5235 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5236
5237 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5238 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5239 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5240 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5241 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5242
5243 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5244 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5245 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5246 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5247 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5248 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5249 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5250 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5251 threads.
5252
5253 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5254 the given number of lines from the top.
5255
5256 @item gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5257 @vindex gnus-summary-stop-at-end-of-message
5258 If non-@code{nil}, don't go to the next article when hitting
5259 @kbd{SPC}, and you're at the end of the article.
5260
5261 @end table
5262
5263
5264 @node Choosing Articles
5265 @section Choosing Articles
5266 @cindex selecting articles
5267
5268 @menu
5269 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5270 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5271 @end menu
5272
5273
5274 @node Choosing Commands
5275 @subsection Choosing Commands
5276
5277 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5278 and they all select and display an article.
5279
5280 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5281 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5282
5283 @table @kbd
5284 @item SPACE
5285 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5286 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5287 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5288 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5289
5290 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5291 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5292 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5293
5294 @item G n
5295 @itemx n
5296 @kindex n (Summary)
5297 @kindex G n (Summary)
5298 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5299 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5300 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5301
5302 @item G p
5303 @itemx p
5304 @kindex p (Summary)
5305 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5306 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5307 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5308
5309 @item G N
5310 @itemx N
5311 @kindex N (Summary)
5312 @kindex G N (Summary)
5313 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5314 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5315
5316 @item G P
5317 @itemx P
5318 @kindex P (Summary)
5319 @kindex G P (Summary)
5320 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5321 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5322
5323 @item G C-n
5324 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5325 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5326 Go to the next article with the same subject
5327 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5328
5329 @item G C-p
5330 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5331 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5332 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5333 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5334
5335 @item G f
5336 @itemx .
5337 @kindex G f (Summary)
5338 @kindex . (Summary)
5339 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5340 Go to the first unread article
5341 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5342
5343 @item G b
5344 @itemx ,
5345 @kindex G b (Summary)
5346 @kindex , (Summary)
5347 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5348 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5349 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5350 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5351
5352 @item G l
5353 @itemx l
5354 @kindex l (Summary)
5355 @kindex G l (Summary)
5356 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5357 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5358
5359 @item G o
5360 @kindex G o (Summary)
5361 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5362 @cindex history
5363 @cindex article history
5364 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5365 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5366 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5367 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5368 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5369 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5370
5371 @item G j
5372 @itemx j
5373 @kindex j (Summary)
5374 @kindex G j (Summary)
5375 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5376 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5377 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5378
5379 @end table
5380
5381
5382 @node Choosing Variables
5383 @subsection Choosing Variables
5384
5385 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5386
5387 @table @code
5388 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5389 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5390 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5391 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5392 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5393 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5394
5395 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5396 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5397 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5398 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5399 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5400 hook will do so.
5401
5402 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5403 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5404 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5405 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5406 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5407 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5408 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5409 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5410 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5411 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5412 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5413 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5414 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5415 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5416
5417 @end table
5418
5419
5420 @node Paging the Article
5421 @section Scrolling the Article
5422 @cindex article scrolling
5423
5424 @table @kbd
5425
5426 @item SPACE
5427 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5428 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5429 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5430 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5431 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5432
5433 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5434 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5435 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5436 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5437 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5438 what is considered uninteresting with
5439 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5440 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5441
5442 @item DEL
5443 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5444 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5445 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5446
5447 @item RET
5448 @kindex RET (Summary)
5449 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5450 Scroll the current article one line forward
5451 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5452
5453 @item M-RET
5454 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5455 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5456 Scroll the current article one line backward
5457 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5458
5459 @item A g
5460 @itemx g
5461 @kindex A g (Summary)
5462 @kindex g (Summary)
5463 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5464 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5465 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5466 given a prefix, show a completely ``raw'' article, just the way it
5467 came from the server. If given a prefix twice (i.e., @kbd{C-u C-u
5468 g'}), fetch the current article, but don't run any of the article
5469 treatment functions.
5470
5471 @cindex charset, view article with different charset
5472 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5473 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5474 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5475
5476 @lisp
5477 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5478 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5479 (2 . big5)))
5480 @end lisp
5481
5482 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5483
5484 @item A <
5485 @itemx <
5486 @kindex < (Summary)
5487 @kindex A < (Summary)
5488 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5489 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5490 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5491
5492 @item A >
5493 @itemx >
5494 @kindex > (Summary)
5495 @kindex A > (Summary)
5496 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5497 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5498
5499 @item A s
5500 @itemx s
5501 @kindex A s (Summary)
5502 @kindex s (Summary)
5503 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5504 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5505 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5506
5507 @item h
5508 @kindex h (Summary)
5509 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5510 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5511
5512 @end table
5513
5514
5515 @node Reply Followup and Post
5516 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5517
5518 @menu
5519 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5520 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5521 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5522 * Canceling and Superseding::
5523 @end menu
5524
5525
5526 @node Summary Mail Commands
5527 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5528 @cindex mail
5529 @cindex composing mail
5530
5531 Commands for composing a mail message:
5532
5533 @table @kbd
5534
5535 @item S r
5536 @itemx r
5537 @kindex S r (Summary)
5538 @kindex r (Summary)
5539 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5540 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5541 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5542 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5543 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5544
5545 @item S R
5546 @itemx R
5547 @kindex R (Summary)
5548 @kindex S R (Summary)
5549 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5550 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5551 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5552 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5553 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5554
5555 @item S w
5556 @kindex S w (Summary)
5557 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5558 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5559 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5560 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5561 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5562 present, that's used instead.
5563
5564 @item S W
5565 @kindex S W (Summary)
5566 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5567 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5568 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5569 the process/prefix convention, but only uses the headers from the
5570 first article to determine the recipients.
5571
5572 @item S L
5573 @kindex S L (Summary)
5574 @findex gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original
5575 When replying to a message from a mailing list, send a reply to that
5576 message to the mailing list, and include the original message
5577 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-to-list-with-original}).
5578
5579 @item S v
5580 @kindex S v (Summary)
5581 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5582 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5583 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5584 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5585 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5586 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5587
5588 @item S V
5589 @kindex S V (Summary)
5590 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5591 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5592 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5593 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5594
5595 @item S B r
5596 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5597 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5598 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5599 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5600 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5601 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5602 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5603 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5604
5605 @item S B R
5606 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5607 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5608 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5609 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5610 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5611
5612 @item S o m
5613 @itemx C-c C-f
5614 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5615 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5616 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5617 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5618 Forward the current article to some other person
5619 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5620 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5621 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5622 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5623 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5624 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5625 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5626 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5627 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5628 section.
5629
5630 @item S m
5631 @itemx m
5632 @kindex m (Summary)
5633 @kindex S m (Summary)
5634 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5635 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5636 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5637 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5638 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5639
5640 @item S i
5641 @kindex S i (Summary)
5642 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5643 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5644 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5645 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5646
5647 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5648 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5649 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5650 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5651 for this to work though.
5652
5653 @item S D b
5654 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5655 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5656 @cindex bouncing mail
5657 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5658 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5659 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5660 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5661 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5662 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5663 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5664 very well fail, though.
5665
5666 @item S D r
5667 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5668 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5669 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5670 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5671 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5672 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5673 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5674 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5675 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5676 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5677
5678 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5679 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5680 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5681 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5682 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5683
5684 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5685 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5686
5687 @item S D e
5688 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5689 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5690
5691 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5692 if it were a new message before resending.
5693
5694 @item S O m
5695 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5696 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5697 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5698 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5699 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5700
5701 @item S M-c
5702 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5703 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5704 @cindex crossposting
5705 @cindex excessive crossposting
5706 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5707 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5708
5709 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5710 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5711 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5712 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5713 command understands the process/prefix convention
5714 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5715
5716 @end table
5717
5718 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5719 Manual}, for more information.
5720
5721
5722 @node Summary Post Commands
5723 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5724 @cindex post
5725 @cindex composing news
5726
5727 Commands for posting a news article:
5728
5729 @table @kbd
5730 @item S p
5731 @itemx a
5732 @kindex a (Summary)
5733 @kindex S p (Summary)
5734 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5735 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5736 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5737 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5738 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5739
5740 @item S f
5741 @itemx f
5742 @kindex f (Summary)
5743 @kindex S f (Summary)
5744 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5745 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5746 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5747
5748 @item S F
5749 @itemx F
5750 @kindex S F (Summary)
5751 @kindex F (Summary)
5752 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5753 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5754 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5755 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5756 process/prefix convention.
5757
5758 @item S n
5759 @kindex S n (Summary)
5760 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5761 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5762 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5763
5764 @item S N
5765 @kindex S N (Summary)
5766 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5767 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5768 message through mail and include the original message
5769 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5770 the process/prefix convention.
5771
5772 @item S o p
5773 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5774 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5775 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5776 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5777 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5778 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5779 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5780 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5781 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5782 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5783 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5784 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5785 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5786
5787 @item S O p
5788 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5789 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5790 @cindex digests
5791 @cindex making digests
5792 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5793 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5794 process/prefix convention.
5795
5796 @item S u
5797 @kindex S u (Summary)
5798 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5799 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5800 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5801 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5802 @end table
5803
5804 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5805 Manual}, for more information.
5806
5807
5808 @node Summary Message Commands
5809 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5810
5811 @table @kbd
5812 @item S y
5813 @kindex S y (Summary)
5814 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5815 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5816 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5817 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5818 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5819
5820 @end table
5821
5822
5823 @node Canceling and Superseding
5824 @subsection Canceling Articles
5825 @cindex canceling articles
5826 @cindex superseding articles
5827
5828 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5829 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5830
5831 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5832
5833 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5834 @kindex C (Summary)
5835 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5836 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5837 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5838 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5839 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5840 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5841
5842 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5843 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5844 question.
5845
5846 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5847 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5848 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5849
5850 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5851 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5852 message, Message Manual}).
5853
5854 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5855 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5856 your original article.
5857
5858 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5859 @kindex S (Summary)
5860 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5861 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5862 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5863 usual way.
5864
5865 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5866 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5867 have posted almost the same article twice.
5868
5869 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5870 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5871 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5872 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5873 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5874 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5875 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5876 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5877 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5878 canceled/superseded.
5879
5880 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5881
5882 @node Delayed Articles
5883 @section Delayed Articles
5884 @cindex delayed sending
5885 @cindex send delayed
5886
5887 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5888 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5889 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5890 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5891
5892 @lisp
5893 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5894 @end lisp
5895
5896 @findex gnus-delay-article
5897 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5898 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5899 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5900 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5901
5902 @itemize @bullet
5903 @item
5904 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5905 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5906 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5907 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5908
5909 @item
5910 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5911 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5912 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5913
5914 @item
5915 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5916 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5917 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5918 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5919 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5920 that means a time tomorrow.
5921 @end itemize
5922
5923 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5924 couple of variables:
5925
5926 @table @code
5927 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5928 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5929 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5930 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5931
5932 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5933 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5934 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5935 formats described above.
5936
5937 @item gnus-delay-group
5938 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5939 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5940 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5941 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5942
5943 @item gnus-delay-header
5944 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5945 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5946 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5947 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5948 @end table
5949
5950 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5951 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5952 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5953 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5954 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5955
5956 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5957 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5958 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5959 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5960 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5961 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5962 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5963
5964 @table @code
5965 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5966 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5967 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5968 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5969 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5970 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5971 argument is ignored.
5972
5973 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5974 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5975 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5976 @end table
5977
5978 When delaying an article with @kbd{C-c C-j}, Message mode will
5979 automatically add a @code{"Date"} header with the current time. In
5980 many cases you probably want the @code{"Date"} header to reflect the
5981 time the message is sent instead. To do this, you have to delete
5982 @code{Date} from @code{message-draft-headers}.
5983
5984
5985 @node Marking Articles
5986 @section Marking Articles
5987 @cindex article marking
5988 @cindex article ticking
5989 @cindex marks
5990
5991 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5992
5993 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5994 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5995 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5996
5997 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5998
5999 @ifinfo
6000 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
6001 @end ifinfo
6002
6003 @menu
6004 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
6005 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
6006 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
6007 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
6008 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
6009 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
6010 @end menu
6011
6012
6013 @node Unread Articles
6014 @subsection Unread Articles
6015
6016 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
6017 other.
6018
6019 @table @samp
6020 @item !
6021 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
6022 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
6023
6024 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
6025 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
6026 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
6027 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
6028 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
6029 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
6030 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
6031
6032 @item ?
6033 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
6034 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
6035
6036 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
6037 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
6038 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
6039 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
6040 messages.
6041
6042 @item SPACE
6043 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
6044 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
6045
6046 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
6047 @end table
6048
6049
6050 @node Read Articles
6051 @subsection Read Articles
6052 @cindex expirable mark
6053
6054 All the following marks mark articles as read.
6055
6056 @table @samp
6057
6058 @item r
6059 @vindex gnus-del-mark
6060 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
6061 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
6062
6063 @item R
6064 @vindex gnus-read-mark
6065 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
6066
6067 @item O
6068 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
6069 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
6070 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
6071
6072 @item K
6073 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
6074 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
6075
6076 @item X
6077 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
6078 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
6079
6080 @item Y
6081 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
6082 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
6083
6084 @item C
6085 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
6086 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
6087
6088 @item G
6089 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
6090 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
6091
6092 @item Q
6093 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
6094 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
6095 Threading}.
6096
6097 @item M
6098 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
6099 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
6100 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
6101
6102 @end table
6103
6104 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
6105 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
6106
6107 One more special mark, though:
6108
6109 @table @samp
6110 @item E
6111 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
6112 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
6113
6114 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
6115 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
6116 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
6117 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
6118 any time.
6119 @end table
6120
6121
6122 @node Other Marks
6123 @subsection Other Marks
6124 @cindex process mark
6125 @cindex bookmarks
6126
6127 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
6128 read or not.
6129
6130 @itemize @bullet
6131
6132 @item
6133 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
6134 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
6135 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
6136 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
6137 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
6138
6139 @item
6140 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
6141 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
6142 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
6143 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
6144
6145 @item
6146 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
6147 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
6148 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
6149
6150 @item
6151 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
6152 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
6153 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6154
6155 @item
6156 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
6157 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
6158 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
6159 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
6160
6161 @item
6162 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
6163 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
6164 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
6165
6166 @item
6167 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
6168 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
6169 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
6170 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
6171 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
6172 use.)
6173
6174 @item
6175 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
6176 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
6177 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
6178 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
6179 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
6180 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
6181
6182 @item
6183 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
6184 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6185 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6186 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6187 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6188 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6189 use.)
6190
6191 @item
6192 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6193 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6194 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6195 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6196 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6197
6198 @item
6199 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6200 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6201 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6202 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6203 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6204 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6205
6206 @end itemize
6207
6208 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6209 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6210 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6211
6212 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6213 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6214 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6215
6216
6217 @node Setting Marks
6218 @subsection Setting Marks
6219 @cindex setting marks
6220
6221 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6222
6223 @table @kbd
6224 @item M c
6225 @itemx M-u
6226 @kindex M c (Summary)
6227 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6228 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6229 @cindex mark as unread
6230 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6231 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6232 article as unread.
6233
6234 @item M t
6235 @itemx !
6236 @kindex ! (Summary)
6237 @kindex M t (Summary)
6238 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6239 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6240 @xref{Article Caching}.
6241
6242 @item M ?
6243 @itemx ?
6244 @kindex ? (Summary)
6245 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6246 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6247 Mark the current article as dormant
6248 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6249
6250 @item M d
6251 @itemx d
6252 @kindex M d (Summary)
6253 @kindex d (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6255 Mark the current article as read
6256 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6257
6258 @item D
6259 @kindex D (Summary)
6260 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6261 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6262 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6263
6264 @item M k
6265 @itemx k
6266 @kindex k (Summary)
6267 @kindex M k (Summary)
6268 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6269 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6270 and then select the next unread article
6271 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6272
6273 @item M K
6274 @itemx C-k
6275 @kindex M K (Summary)
6276 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6277 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6278 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6279 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6280
6281 @item M C
6282 @kindex M C (Summary)
6283 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6284 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6285 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6286
6287 @item M C-c
6288 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6289 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6290 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6291 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6292
6293 @item M H
6294 @kindex M H (Summary)
6295 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6296 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6297 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6298
6299 @item M h
6300 @kindex M h (Summary)
6301 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6302 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6303 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6304
6305 @item C-w
6306 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6307 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6308 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6309 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6310
6311 @item M V k
6312 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6313 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6314 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6315 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6316
6317 @item M e
6318 @itemx E
6319 @kindex M e (Summary)
6320 @kindex E (Summary)
6321 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6322 Mark the current article as expirable
6323 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6324
6325 @item M b
6326 @kindex M b (Summary)
6327 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6328 Set a bookmark in the current article
6329 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6330
6331 @item M B
6332 @kindex M B (Summary)
6333 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6334 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6335 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6336
6337 @item M V c
6338 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6339 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6340 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6341 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6342
6343 @item M V u
6344 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6345 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6346 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6347 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6348
6349 @item M V m
6350 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6351 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6352 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6353 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6354 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6355 @end table
6356
6357 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6358 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6359 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6360 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6361 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6362 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6363 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6364 The default is @code{t}.
6365
6366
6367 @node Generic Marking Commands
6368 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6369
6370 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6371 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6372 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6373 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6374 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6375 well.
6376
6377 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6378 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6379 command should do.
6380
6381 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6382 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6383 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6384 to list in this manual.
6385
6386 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6387 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6388 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6389 article, you could say something like:
6390
6391 @lisp
6392 @group
6393 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6394 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6395 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6396 @end group
6397 @end lisp
6398
6399 @noindent
6400 or
6401
6402 @lisp
6403 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6404 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6405 @end lisp
6406
6407
6408 @node Setting Process Marks
6409 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6410 @cindex setting process marks
6411
6412 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6413 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6414 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6415 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6416 articles into the cache. For more information,
6417 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6418
6419 @table @kbd
6420
6421 @item M P p
6422 @itemx #
6423 @kindex # (Summary)
6424 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6425 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6426 Mark the current article with the process mark
6427 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6428 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6429
6430 @item M P u
6431 @itemx M-#
6432 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6433 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6434 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6435 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6436
6437 @item M P U
6438 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6439 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6440 Remove the process mark from all articles
6441 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6442
6443 @item M P i
6444 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6445 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6446 Invert the list of process marked articles
6447 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6448
6449 @item M P R
6450 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6451 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6452 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6453 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6454
6455 @item M P G
6456 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6457 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6458 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6459 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6460
6461 @item M P r
6462 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6463 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6464 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6465
6466 @item M P g
6467 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6468 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6469 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6470
6471 @item M P t
6472 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6473 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6474 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6475 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6476
6477 @item M P T
6478 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6479 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6480 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6481 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6482
6483 @item M P v
6484 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6485 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6486 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6487 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6488
6489 @item M P s
6490 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6491 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6492 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6493
6494 @item M P S
6495 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6496 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6497 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6498 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6499
6500 @item M P a
6501 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6502 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6503 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6504
6505 @item M P b
6506 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6507 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6508 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6509 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6510
6511 @item M P k
6512 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6513 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6514 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6515 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6516
6517 @item M P y
6518 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6519 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6520 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6521 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6522
6523 @item M P w
6524 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6525 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6526 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6527 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6528
6529 @end table
6530
6531 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6532 set process marks based on article body contents.
6533
6534
6535 @node Limiting
6536 @section Limiting
6537 @cindex limiting
6538
6539 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6540 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6541 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6542 buffer.
6543
6544 Limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched from
6545 the servers. These commands don't query the server for additional
6546 articles.
6547
6548 @table @kbd
6549
6550 @item / /
6551 @itemx / s
6552 @kindex / / (Summary)
6553 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6554 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6555 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6556 matching articles.
6557
6558 @item / a
6559 @kindex / a (Summary)
6560 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6561 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6562 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6563 matching articles.
6564
6565 @item / R
6566 @kindex / R (Summary)
6567 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient
6568 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some recipient
6569 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-recipient}). If given a prefix, exclude
6570 matching articles.
6571
6572 @item / A
6573 @kindex / A (Summary)
6574 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-address
6575 Limit the summary buffer to articles in which contents of From, To or Cc
6576 header match a given address (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-address}). If
6577 given a prefix, exclude matching articles.
6578
6579 @item / S
6580 @kindex / S (Summary)
6581 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons
6582 Limit the summary buffer to articles that aren't part of any displayed
6583 threads (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-singletons}). If given a prefix,
6584 limit to articles that are part of displayed threads.
6585
6586 @item / x
6587 @kindex / x (Summary)
6588 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6589 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6590 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6591 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6592 matching articles.
6593
6594 @item / u
6595 @itemx x
6596 @kindex / u (Summary)
6597 @kindex x (Summary)
6598 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6599 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6600 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6601 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6602 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6603
6604 @item / m
6605 @kindex / m (Summary)
6606 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6607 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6608 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6609
6610 @item / t
6611 @kindex / t (Summary)
6612 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6613 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6614 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6615 articles younger than that number of days.
6616
6617 @item / n
6618 @kindex / n (Summary)
6619 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6620 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6621 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6622 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6623
6624 @item / w
6625 @kindex / w (Summary)
6626 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6627 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6628 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6629 the stack.
6630
6631 @item / .
6632 @kindex / . (Summary)
6633 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6634 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6635 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6636
6637 @item / v
6638 @kindex / v (Summary)
6639 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6640 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6641 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6642
6643 @item / p
6644 @kindex / p (Summary)
6645 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6646 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6647 group parameter predicate
6648 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6649 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6650
6651 @item / r
6652 @kindex / r (Summary)
6653 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-replied
6654 Limit the summary buffer to replied articles
6655 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-replied}). If given a prefix, exclude
6656 replied articles.
6657
6658 @item / E
6659 @itemx M S
6660 @kindex M S (Summary)
6661 @kindex / E (Summary)
6662 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6663 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6664 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6665
6666 @item / D
6667 @kindex / D (Summary)
6668 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6669 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6670 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6671
6672 @item / *
6673 @kindex / * (Summary)
6674 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6675 Include all cached articles in the limit
6676 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6677
6678 @item / d
6679 @kindex / d (Summary)
6680 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6681 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6682 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6683
6684 @item / M
6685 @kindex / M (Summary)
6686 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6687 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6688
6689 @item / T
6690 @kindex / T (Summary)
6691 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6692 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6693
6694 @item / c
6695 @kindex / c (Summary)
6696 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6697 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6698 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6699
6700 @item / C
6701 @kindex / C (Summary)
6702 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6703 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6704 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6705 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6706
6707 @item / b
6708 @kindex / b (Summary)
6709 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies
6710 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have bodies that match a
6711 certain regexp (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-bodies}). If given a
6712 prefix, reverse the limit. This command is quite slow since it
6713 requires selecting each article to find the matches.
6714
6715 @item / h
6716 @kindex / h (Summary)
6717 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-headers
6718 Like the previous command, only limit to headers instead
6719 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-headers}).
6720
6721 @end table
6722
6723
6724 The following commands aren't limiting commands, but use the @kbd{/}
6725 prefix as well.
6726
6727 @table @kbd
6728 @item / N
6729 @kindex / N (Summary)
6730 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6731 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6732 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6733
6734 @item / o
6735 @kindex / o (Summary)
6736 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6737 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6738 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6739
6740 @end table
6741
6742
6743 @node Threading
6744 @section Threading
6745 @cindex threading
6746 @cindex article threading
6747
6748 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6749 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6750 hierarchical fashion.
6751
6752 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6753 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6754 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6755 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6756 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6757 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6758 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6759
6760 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6761
6762 @table @dfn
6763 @item root
6764 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6765
6766 @item thread
6767 A tree-like article structure.
6768
6769 @item sub-thread
6770 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6771
6772 @item loose threads
6773 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6774 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6775 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6776 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6777 called loose threads.
6778
6779 @item thread gathering
6780 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6781
6782 @item sparse threads
6783 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6784 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6785
6786 @end table
6787
6788
6789 @menu
6790 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6791 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6792 @end menu
6793
6794
6795 @node Customizing Threading
6796 @subsection Customizing Threading
6797 @cindex customizing threading
6798
6799 @menu
6800 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6801 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6802 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6803 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6804 @end menu
6805
6806
6807 @node Loose Threads
6808 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6809 @cindex <
6810 @cindex >
6811 @cindex loose threads
6812
6813 @table @code
6814 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6815 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6816 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6817 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6818 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6819 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6820
6821 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6822 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6823 There are four possible values:
6824
6825 @iftex
6826 @iflatex
6827 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6828 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6829 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6830 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6831 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6832 }
6833 @end iflatex
6834 @end iftex
6835
6836 @cindex adopting articles
6837
6838 @table @code
6839
6840 @item adopt
6841 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6842 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6843 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6844 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6845
6846 @item dummy
6847 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6848 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6849 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6850 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6851 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6852 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6853 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6854 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6855 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6856 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6857
6858 @item empty
6859 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6860 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6861 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6862 Buffer Format}).)
6863
6864 @item none
6865 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6866 display them after one another.
6867
6868 @item nil
6869 Don't gather loose threads.
6870 @end table
6871
6872 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6873 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6874 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6875 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6876 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6877 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6878 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6879 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6880 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6881 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6882 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6883
6884 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6885 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6886 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6887 Matching}).
6888
6889 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6890 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6891 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6892 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6893 simplification is used.
6894
6895 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6896 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6897 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6898 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6899
6900 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6901 @lisp
6902 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6903 (concat
6904 "\\`\\[?\\("
6905 (mapconcat
6906 'identity
6907 '("looking"
6908 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6909 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6910 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6911 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6912 ;; ...
6913 )
6914 "\\|")
6915 "\\)\\s *\\("
6916 (mapconcat 'identity
6917 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6918 "\\|")
6919 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6920 @end lisp
6921
6922 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6923 subjects.
6924
6925 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6926 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6927 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6928 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6929 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6930 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6931
6932 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6933
6934 @table @code
6935 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6936 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6937 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6938
6939 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6940 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6941 Simplify fuzzily.
6942
6943 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6944 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6945 Remove excessive whitespace.
6946
6947 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6948 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6949 Remove all whitespace.
6950 @end table
6951
6952 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6953
6954
6955 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6956 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6957 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6958 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6959 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6960 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6961 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6962 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6963
6964 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6965 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6966 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6967 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6968 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6969 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6970 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6971 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6972 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6973 cholera:
6974
6975 @table @code
6976 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6977 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6978 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6979 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6980
6981 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6982 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6983 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6984 @end table
6985
6986 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6987 something like:
6988
6989 @lisp
6990 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6991 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6992 @end lisp
6993
6994 @end table
6995
6996
6997 @node Filling In Threads
6998 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6999
7000 @table @code
7001 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
7002 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
7003 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
7004 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
7005 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
7006 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
7007 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
7008 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
7009 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
7010 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
7011 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
7012 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
7013 do about that.
7014
7015 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
7016 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
7017 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
7018
7019 The server has to support @acronym{NOV} for any of this to work.
7020
7021 @cindex Gmane, gnus-fetch-old-headers
7022 This feature can seriously impact performance it ignores all locally
7023 cached header entries. Setting it to @code{t} for groups for a server
7024 that doesn't expire articles (such as news.gmane.org), leads to very
7025 slow summary generation.
7026
7027 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7028 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
7029 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
7030 newsgroups.
7031
7032 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
7033 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
7034 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
7035 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
7036 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
7037 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
7038 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
7039 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
7040 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
7041 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
7042 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
7043 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
7044 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
7045 @code{nil} by default.
7046
7047 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
7048 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
7049 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
7050 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
7051 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
7052 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
7053 web-based groups.
7054
7055 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
7056 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
7057 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
7058
7059 @end table
7060
7061
7062 @node More Threading
7063 @subsubsection More Threading
7064
7065 @table @code
7066 @item gnus-show-threads
7067 @vindex gnus-show-threads
7068 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
7069 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
7070 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
7071 slower and more awkward.
7072
7073 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7074 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7075 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
7076 generated.
7077
7078 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
7079 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
7080 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
7081
7082 Here's an example:
7083
7084 @lisp
7085 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
7086 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
7087 gnus-article-unseen-p))
7088 @end lisp
7089
7090 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
7091 unread, but you get my drift.)
7092
7093
7094 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
7095 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
7096 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
7097 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
7098 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
7099 threads are expunged.
7100
7101 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
7102 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
7103 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
7104 will be hidden.
7105
7106 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7107 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
7108 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
7109 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
7110 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
7111 result in a new thread.
7112
7113 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
7114 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
7115 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
7116 The default is 4.
7117
7118 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7119 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
7120 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
7121 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
7122 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
7123 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
7124 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
7125 Setting this variable to an alternate value
7126 (e.g., @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
7127 appropriate hook (e.g., @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
7128 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
7129
7130 @end table
7131
7132
7133 @node Low-Level Threading
7134 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
7135
7136 @table @code
7137
7138 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
7139 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
7140 Hook run before parsing any headers.
7141
7142 @item gnus-alter-header-function
7143 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
7144 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
7145 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
7146 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
7147 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
7148 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
7149 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
7150 meaningful. Here's one example:
7151
7152 @lisp
7153 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
7154
7155 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
7156 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
7157 (when (string-match
7158 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
7159 (mail-header-set-id
7160 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
7161 header))))
7162 @end lisp
7163
7164 @end table
7165
7166
7167 @node Thread Commands
7168 @subsection Thread Commands
7169 @cindex thread commands
7170
7171 @table @kbd
7172
7173 @item T k
7174 @itemx C-M-k
7175 @kindex T k (Summary)
7176 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
7177 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
7178 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
7179 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
7180 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
7181 articles instead.
7182
7183 @item T l
7184 @itemx C-M-l
7185 @kindex T l (Summary)
7186 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
7187 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
7188 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
7189 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
7190
7191 @item T i
7192 @kindex T i (Summary)
7193 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
7194 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
7195 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
7196
7197 @item T #
7198 @kindex T # (Summary)
7199 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
7200 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
7201 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
7202
7203 @item T M-#
7204 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
7205 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
7206 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
7207 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
7208
7209 @item T T
7210 @kindex T T (Summary)
7211 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
7212 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
7213
7214 @item T s
7215 @kindex T s (Summary)
7216 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
7217 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
7218 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
7219
7220 @item T h
7221 @kindex T h (Summary)
7222 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
7223 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
7224
7225 @item T S
7226 @kindex T S (Summary)
7227 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
7228 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
7229
7230 @item T H
7231 @kindex T H (Summary)
7232 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
7233 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
7234
7235 @item T t
7236 @kindex T t (Summary)
7237 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
7238 Re-thread the current article's thread
7239 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
7240 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
7241
7242 @item T ^
7243 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7244 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7245 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7246 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7247
7248 @item T M-^
7249 @kindex T M-^ (Summary)
7250 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-children
7251 Make the current article the parent of the marked articles
7252 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-children}).
7253
7254 @end table
7255
7256 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7257 understand the numeric prefix.
7258
7259 @table @kbd
7260
7261 @item T n
7262 @kindex T n (Summary)
7263 @itemx C-M-f
7264 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7265 @itemx M-down
7266 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7267 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7268 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7269
7270 @item T p
7271 @kindex T p (Summary)
7272 @itemx C-M-b
7273 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7274 @itemx M-up
7275 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7276 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7277 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7278
7279 @item T d
7280 @kindex T d (Summary)
7281 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7282 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7283
7284 @item T u
7285 @kindex T u (Summary)
7286 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7287 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7288
7289 @item T o
7290 @kindex T o (Summary)
7291 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7292 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7293 @end table
7294
7295 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7296 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7297 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7298 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7299 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7300 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7301 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7302 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7303 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7304 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7305 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7306 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7307 Matching}).
7308
7309
7310 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7311 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7312
7313 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7314 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7315 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7316 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7317 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7318 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient
7319 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7320 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7321 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7322 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7323 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7324 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7325 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7326 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7327 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7328
7329 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7330 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7331 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-recipient},
7332 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7333 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date},
7334 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7335 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7336 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7337 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7338 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7339
7340 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7341 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7342 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread. Exceptions
7343 to this rule are @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number} and
7344 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date}.
7345
7346 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7347 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7348 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7349 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7350 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7351 ascending article order.
7352
7353 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7354 by number, you could do something like:
7355
7356 @lisp
7357 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7358 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7359 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7360 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7361 @end lisp
7362
7363 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7364 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7365 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7366 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7367 which the articles arrived.
7368
7369 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7370 say something like:
7371
7372 @lisp
7373 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7374 '((not gnus-thread-sort-by-number)
7375 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7376 @end lisp
7377
7378 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7379 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7380 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7381 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7382 tickles your fancy.
7383
7384 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7385 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7386 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-date
7387 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7388 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7389 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7390 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7391 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7392 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-most-recent-number
7393 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7394 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7395 variable. It is very similar to the
7396 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7397 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7398 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7399 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7400 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7401 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7402 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7403
7404 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7405 say something like:
7406
7407 @lisp
7408 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7409 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7410 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7411 @end lisp
7412
7413 You can define group specific sorting via @code{gnus-parameters},
7414 @xref{Group Parameters}.
7415
7416
7417 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7418 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7419 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7420 @cindex article pre-fetch
7421 @cindex pre-fetch
7422
7423 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7424 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7425 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7426 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7427 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7428
7429 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7430 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7431
7432 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7433 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7434 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7435 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7436 connection is blocked.
7437
7438 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7439 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7440 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7441 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7442
7443 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7444 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7445 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7446 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7447 extra connection.
7448
7449 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7450 you really want to.
7451
7452 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7453 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7454 happen automatically.
7455
7456 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7457 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7458 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7459 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7460 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7461 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7462 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7463
7464 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7465 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7466 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7467 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7468 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7469 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7470 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7471 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7472 article data structure as the only parameter.
7473
7474 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7475 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7476
7477 @lisp
7478 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7479 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7480 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7481 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7482 100)))
7483
7484 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7485 @end lisp
7486
7487 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7488 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7489 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7490
7491 @vindex gnus-async-post-fetch-function
7492 @findex gnus-html-prefetch-images
7493 After an article has been prefetched, this
7494 @code{gnus-async-post-fetch-function} will be called. The buffer will
7495 be narrowed to the region of the article that was fetched. A useful
7496 value would be @code{gnus-html-prefetch-images}, which will prefetch
7497 and store images referenced in the article, so that you don't have to
7498 wait for them to be fetched when you read the article. This is useful
7499 for @acronym{HTML} messages that have external images.
7500
7501 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7502 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7503 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7504 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7505
7506 @table @code
7507 @item read
7508 Remove articles when they are read.
7509
7510 @item exit
7511 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7512 @end table
7513
7514 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7515
7516 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7517 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7518 @c from the next group.
7519
7520
7521 @node Article Caching
7522 @section Article Caching
7523 @cindex article caching
7524 @cindex caching
7525
7526 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7527 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7528 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7529 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7530 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7531
7532 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7533
7534 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7535 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7536 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7537 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7538 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7539 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7540 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7541 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7542
7543 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7544 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7545 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7546 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7547 as dormant, and don't worry.
7548
7549 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7550
7551 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7552 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7553 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7554 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7555 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7556 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7557 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7558 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7559 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7560 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7561
7562 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7563 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7564 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7565 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7566 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7567 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7568 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7569 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7570 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7571 not then be downloaded by this command.
7572
7573 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7574 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7575 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7576 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7577 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7578 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7579
7580 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7581 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7582 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7583 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7584 variables, the group is not cached.
7585
7586 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7587 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7588 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7589 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7590 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7591 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7592 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7593 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7594 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7595 file.
7596
7597 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7598 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7599 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7600 where, isn't that cool?
7601
7602 @node Persistent Articles
7603 @section Persistent Articles
7604 @cindex persistent articles
7605
7606 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7607 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7608 useful in my opinion.
7609
7610 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7611 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7612 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7613 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7614 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7615 the expiry going on at the news server.
7616
7617 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7618 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7619 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7620
7621 @table @kbd
7622
7623 @item *
7624 @kindex * (Summary)
7625 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7626 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7627
7628 @item M-*
7629 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7630 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7631 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7632 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7633 article.
7634 @end table
7635
7636 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7637
7638 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7639 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7640 interested in persistent articles:
7641
7642 @lisp
7643 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7644 @end lisp
7645
7646 @node Sticky Articles
7647 @section Sticky Articles
7648 @cindex sticky articles
7649
7650 When you select an article the current article buffer will be reused
7651 according to the value of the variable
7652 @code{gnus-single-article-buffer}. If its value is non-@code{nil} (the
7653 default) all articles reuse the same article buffer. Else each group
7654 has its own article buffer.
7655
7656 This implies that it's not possible to have more than one article buffer
7657 in a group at a time. But sometimes you might want to display all the
7658 latest emails from your mother, your father, your aunt, your uncle and
7659 your 17 cousins to coordinate the next Christmas party.
7660
7661 That's where sticky articles come in handy. A sticky article buffer
7662 basically is a normal article buffer, but it won't be reused when you
7663 select another article. You can make an article sticky with:
7664
7665 @table @kbd
7666 @item A S
7667 @kindex A S (Summary)
7668 @findex gnus-sticky-article
7669 Make the current article sticky. If a prefix arg is given, ask for a
7670 name for this sticky article buffer.
7671 @end table
7672
7673 To close a sticky article buffer you can use these commands:
7674
7675 @table @kbd
7676 @item q
7677 @kindex q (Article)
7678 @findex bury-buffer
7679 Puts this sticky article buffer at the end of the list of all buffers.
7680
7681 @item k
7682 @kindex k (Article)
7683 @findex gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffer
7684 Kills this sticky article buffer.
7685 @end table
7686
7687 To kill all sticky article buffers you can use:
7688
7689 @defun gnus-kill-sticky-article-buffers ARG
7690 Kill all sticky article buffers.
7691 If a prefix ARG is given, ask for confirmation.
7692 @end defun
7693
7694 @node Article Backlog
7695 @section Article Backlog
7696 @cindex backlog
7697 @cindex article backlog
7698
7699 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7700 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7701 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7702 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7703 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7704 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7705 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7706 increase memory usage some.
7707
7708 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7709 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7710 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7711 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7712 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7713 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7714 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7715
7716 The default value is 20.
7717
7718
7719 @node Saving Articles
7720 @section Saving Articles
7721 @cindex saving articles
7722
7723 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7724 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7725 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7726 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7727 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7728
7729 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7730 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7731 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7732
7733 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7734 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7735 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7736
7737 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7738 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7739 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7740 deleted before saving.
7741
7742 @table @kbd
7743
7744 @item O o
7745 @itemx o
7746 @kindex O o (Summary)
7747 @kindex o (Summary)
7748 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7749 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7750 Save the current article using the default article saver
7751 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7752
7753 @item O m
7754 @kindex O m (Summary)
7755 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7756 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7757 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7758
7759 @item O r
7760 @kindex O r (Summary)
7761 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7762 Save the current article in Rmail format
7763 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}). This is mbox since Emacs 23,
7764 Babyl in older versions.
7765
7766 @item O f
7767 @kindex O f (Summary)
7768 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7769 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7770 Save the current article in plain file format
7771 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7772
7773 @item O F
7774 @kindex O F (Summary)
7775 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7776 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7777 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7778
7779 @item O b
7780 @kindex O b (Summary)
7781 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7782 Save the current article body in plain file format
7783 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7784
7785 @item O h
7786 @kindex O h (Summary)
7787 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7788 Save the current article in mh folder format
7789 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7790
7791 @item O v
7792 @kindex O v (Summary)
7793 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7794 Save the current article in a VM folder
7795 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7796
7797 @item O p
7798 @itemx |
7799 @kindex O p (Summary)
7800 @kindex | (Summary)
7801 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7802 @vindex gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command
7803 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7804 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7805 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7806 complete headers in the piped output. The symbolic prefix @code{r} is
7807 special; it lets this command pipe a raw article including all headers.
7808 The @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} variable can be set
7809 to a string containing the default command and options (default
7810 @code{nil}).
7811
7812 @item O P
7813 @kindex O P (Summary)
7814 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7815 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7816 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7817 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7818 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7819 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7820 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7821
7822 @end table
7823
7824 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7825 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7826 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7827 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7828 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7829 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7830 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7831 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7832 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7833 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7834 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7835 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7836 files.
7837
7838
7839 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7840 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7841 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7842 functions below, or you can create your own.
7843
7844 @table @code
7845
7846 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7847 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7848 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7849 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7850 This is the default format, that used by the Rmail package. Since Emacs
7851 23, Rmail uses standard mbox format. Before this, it used the
7852 @dfn{Babyl} format. Accordingly, this command writes mbox format since
7853 Emacs 23, unless appending to an existing Babyl file. In older versions
7854 of Emacs, it always uses Babyl format. Uses the function in the
7855 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7856 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7857
7858 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7859 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7860 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7861 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7862 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7863 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7864
7865 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7866 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7867 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7868 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7869 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7870 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7871 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7872
7873 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7874 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7875 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7876 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7877 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7878 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7879
7880 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7881 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7882 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7883 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7884 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7885
7886 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7887 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7888 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7889 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7890 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7891 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7892
7893 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7894 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7895 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7896 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7897 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7898 @cindex rcvstore
7899 @cindex MH folders
7900 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7901 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7902 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7903 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7904 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7905
7906 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7907 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7908 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7909 reader to use this setting.
7910
7911 @item gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7912 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-pipe
7913 Pipe the article to a shell command. This function takes optional two
7914 arguments COMMAND and RAW@. Valid values for COMMAND include:
7915
7916 @itemize @bullet
7917 @item a string@*
7918 The executable command name and possibly arguments.
7919 @item @code{nil}@*
7920 You will be prompted for the command in the minibuffer.
7921 @item the symbol @code{default}@*
7922 It will be replaced with the command which the variable
7923 @code{gnus-summary-pipe-output-default-command} holds or the command
7924 last used for saving.
7925 @end itemize
7926
7927 Non-@code{nil} value for RAW overrides @code{:decode} and
7928 @code{:headers} properties (see below) and the raw article including all
7929 headers will be piped.
7930 @end table
7931
7932 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7933
7934 @table @code
7935 @item :decode
7936 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7937 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7938 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7939 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file},
7940 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}, and
7941 @code{gnus-summary-save-in-pipe}.
7942
7943 @item :function
7944 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7945 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7946 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7947 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7948 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7949 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7950
7951 @item :headers
7952 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7953 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7954 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7955 headers should be saved.
7956 @end table
7957
7958 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7959 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7960 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7961 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7962 default.
7963
7964 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7965 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7966 available functions that generate names:
7967
7968 @table @code
7969
7970 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7971 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7972 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7973
7974 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7975 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7976 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7977
7978 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7979 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7980 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7981
7982 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7983 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7984 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7985
7986 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7987 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7988 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7989 @end table
7990
7991 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7992 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7993 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7994 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7995 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7996 like:
7997
7998 @lisp
7999 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
8000 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
8001 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
8002 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
8003 @end lisp
8004
8005 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
8006 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
8007 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
8008 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
8009 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
8010 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
8011 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
8012 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
8013 called returns a string or a list of strings.
8014
8015 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
8016 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
8017 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
8018 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
8019
8020 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
8021 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
8022 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
8023 name.
8024
8025 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
8026 lots of mail groups called things like
8027 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
8028 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
8029 following will do just that:
8030
8031 @lisp
8032 (defun my-save-name (group)
8033 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
8034 (substring group (match-end 0))))
8035
8036 (setq gnus-split-methods
8037 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
8038 (my-save-name)))
8039 @end lisp
8040
8041
8042 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
8043 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
8044 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
8045 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
8046 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
8047 all the files in the top level directory
8048 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
8049 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
8050 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
8051 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
8052
8053 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
8054 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
8055 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
8056 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
8057 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
8058 for kill files.
8059
8060 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
8061 a spool, you could
8062
8063 @lisp
8064 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
8065 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
8066 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
8067 @end lisp
8068
8069 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
8070 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
8071 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
8072 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
8073
8074
8075 @node Decoding Articles
8076 @section Decoding Articles
8077 @cindex decoding articles
8078
8079 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
8080 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
8081
8082 @menu
8083 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
8084 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
8085 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
8086 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
8087 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
8088 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
8089 @end menu
8090
8091 @cindex series
8092 @cindex article series
8093 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
8094 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
8095 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
8096 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
8097 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
8098
8099 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
8100 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
8101 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
8102
8103 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
8104 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
8105 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
8106
8107 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
8108 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
8109 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
8110
8111
8112 @node Uuencoded Articles
8113 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
8114 @cindex uudecode
8115 @cindex uuencoded articles
8116
8117 @table @kbd
8118
8119 @item X u
8120 @kindex X u (Summary)
8121 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
8122 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
8123 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
8124
8125 @item X U
8126 @kindex X U (Summary)
8127 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
8128 Uudecodes and saves the current series
8129 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8130
8131 @item X v u
8132 @kindex X v u (Summary)
8133 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
8134 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
8135
8136 @item X v U
8137 @kindex X v U (Summary)
8138 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
8139 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
8140 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
8141
8142 @end table
8143
8144 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
8145 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
8146 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
8147 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
8148 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
8149
8150 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
8151 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
8152 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
8153 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
8154 @kbd{X u}.
8155
8156 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
8157 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
8158 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
8159 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
8160 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
8161 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
8162 off.
8163
8164
8165 @node Shell Archives
8166 @subsection Shell Archives
8167 @cindex unshar
8168 @cindex shell archives
8169 @cindex shared articles
8170
8171 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
8172 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
8173 some commands to deal with these:
8174
8175 @table @kbd
8176
8177 @item X s
8178 @kindex X s (Summary)
8179 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
8180 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
8181
8182 @item X S
8183 @kindex X S (Summary)
8184 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
8185 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
8186
8187 @item X v s
8188 @kindex X v s (Summary)
8189 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
8190 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
8191
8192 @item X v S
8193 @kindex X v S (Summary)
8194 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
8195 Unshars, views and saves the current series
8196 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
8197 @end table
8198
8199
8200 @node PostScript Files
8201 @subsection PostScript Files
8202 @cindex PostScript
8203
8204 @table @kbd
8205
8206 @item X p
8207 @kindex X p (Summary)
8208 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
8209 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
8210
8211 @item X P
8212 @kindex X P (Summary)
8213 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
8214 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
8215 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
8216
8217 @item X v p
8218 @kindex X v p (Summary)
8219 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
8220 View the current PostScript series
8221 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
8222
8223 @item X v P
8224 @kindex X v P (Summary)
8225 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
8226 View and save the current PostScript series
8227 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
8228 @end table
8229
8230
8231 @node Other Files
8232 @subsection Other Files
8233
8234 @table @kbd
8235 @item X o
8236 @kindex X o (Summary)
8237 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
8238 Save the current series
8239 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
8240
8241 @item X b
8242 @kindex X b (Summary)
8243 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
8244 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
8245 doesn't really work yet.
8246
8247 @item X Y
8248 @kindex X Y (Summary)
8249 @findex gnus-uu-decode-yenc
8250 yEnc-decode the current series and save it (@code{gnus-uu-decode-yenc}).
8251 @end table
8252
8253
8254 @node Decoding Variables
8255 @subsection Decoding Variables
8256
8257 Adjective, not verb.
8258
8259 @menu
8260 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
8261 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
8262 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
8263 @end menu
8264
8265
8266 @node Rule Variables
8267 @subsubsection Rule Variables
8268 @cindex rule variables
8269
8270 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
8271 variables are of the form
8272
8273 @lisp
8274 (list '(regexp1 command2)
8275 '(regexp2 command2)
8276 ...)
8277 @end lisp
8278
8279 @table @code
8280
8281 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8282 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8283 @cindex sox
8284 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
8285 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
8286 say something like:
8287 @lisp
8288 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
8289 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
8290 @end lisp
8291
8292 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8293 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
8294 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
8295 user and default view rules.
8296
8297 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8298 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
8299 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
8300 archives.
8301 @end table
8302
8303
8304 @node Other Decode Variables
8305 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
8306
8307 @table @code
8308 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8309
8310 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
8311 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
8312 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
8313 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
8314 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
8315
8316 @table @code
8317
8318 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
8319 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
8320 View the file.
8321
8322 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
8323 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
8324 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
8325 @end table
8326
8327 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8328 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
8329 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
8330 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
8331 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
8332 time.
8333
8334 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8335 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
8336 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
8337
8338 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8339 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
8340 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
8341 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
8342 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
8343 kludgy.
8344
8345 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8346 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
8347 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
8348
8349 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8350 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8351 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8352 looking for files to display.
8353
8354 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8355 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8356 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8357 after viewing it.
8358
8359 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8360 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8361 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8362 rules.
8363
8364 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8365 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8366 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8367 unpacking commands.
8368
8369 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8370 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8371 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8372 from articles.
8373
8374 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8375 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8376 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8377 decoded articles as unread.
8378
8379 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8380 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8381 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8382 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8383
8384 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8385 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8386 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8387
8388 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8389 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8390 @cindex metamail
8391 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8392 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8393 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8394 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8395
8396 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8397 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8398 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8399 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8400 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8401 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8402 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8403 simply dropped them.
8404
8405 @end table
8406
8407
8408 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8409 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8410
8411 @table @code
8412
8413 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8414 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8415 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8416 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8417 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8418 for you when you post the article.
8419
8420 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8421 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8422 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8423 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8424
8425 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8426 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8427 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8428 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8429 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8430 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8431 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8432
8433 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8434 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8435 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8436 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8437 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8438 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8439 Default is @code{t}.
8440
8441 @end table
8442
8443
8444 @node Viewing Files
8445 @subsection Viewing Files
8446 @cindex viewing files
8447 @cindex pseudo-articles
8448
8449 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8450 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8451 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8452 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8453 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8454 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8455 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8456
8457 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8458 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8459 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8460 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8461
8462 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8463 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8464 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8465
8466 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8467 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8468 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8469 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8470 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8471
8472 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8473 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8474 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8475 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8476 a list of parameters to that command.
8477
8478 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8479 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8480 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8481
8482 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8483 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8484 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8485
8486
8487 @node Article Treatment
8488 @section Article Treatment
8489
8490 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8491 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8492 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8493 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8494 these articles easier.
8495
8496 @menu
8497 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8498 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8499 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8500 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8501 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8502 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8503 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8504 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8505 * Article Display:: Display various stuff:
8506 X-Face, Picons, Gravatars, Smileys.
8507 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8508 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8509 @end menu
8510
8511
8512 @node Article Highlighting
8513 @subsection Article Highlighting
8514 @cindex highlighting
8515
8516 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8517 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8518
8519 @table @kbd
8520
8521 @item W H a
8522 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8523 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8524 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8525 Do much highlighting of the current article
8526 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8527 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8528
8529 @item W H h
8530 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8531 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8532 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8533 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8534 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8535 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8536 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8537 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8538 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8539 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8540 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8541 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8542
8543 @item W H c
8544 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8545 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8546 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8547
8548 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8549
8550 @table @code
8551 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8552
8553 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8554 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8555 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8556
8557 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8558 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8559 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8560
8561 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8562 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8563 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8564 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8565 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8566 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8567
8568 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8569 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8570 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8571
8572 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8573 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8574 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8575
8576 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8577 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8578 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8579 that it's a citation.
8580
8581 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8582 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8583 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8584
8585 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8586 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8587 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8588
8589 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8590 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8591 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8592 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8593
8594 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8595 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8596 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8597 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8598 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8599 is @code{t}.
8600
8601 @end table
8602
8603
8604 @item W H s
8605 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8606 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8607 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8608 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8609 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8610 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8611 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8612 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8613 default.
8614
8615 @end table
8616
8617 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8618
8619
8620 @node Article Fontisizing
8621 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8622 @cindex emphasis
8623 @cindex article emphasis
8624
8625 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8626 @kindex W e (Summary)
8627 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8628 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8629 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8630 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8631
8632 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8633 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8634 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8635 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8636 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8637 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8638 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8639 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8640 highlighting.
8641
8642 @lisp
8643 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8644 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8645 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8646 @end lisp
8647
8648 @cindex slash
8649 @cindex asterisk
8650 @cindex underline
8651 @cindex /
8652 @cindex *
8653
8654 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8655 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8656 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8657 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8658 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8659 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8660 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8661 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8662 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8663 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8664 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8665 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8666 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8667
8668 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8669 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8670 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8671 say something like:
8672
8673 @lisp
8674 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8675 @end lisp
8676
8677 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8678
8679 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8680 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8681 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8682 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8683
8684 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8685
8686
8687 @node Article Hiding
8688 @subsection Article Hiding
8689 @cindex article hiding
8690
8691 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8692 too much cruft in most articles.
8693
8694 @table @kbd
8695
8696 @item W W a
8697 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8698 @findex gnus-article-hide
8699 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8700 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8701 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8702
8703 @item W W h
8704 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8705 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8706 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8707 Headers}.
8708
8709 @item W W b
8710 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8711 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8712 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8713 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8714
8715 @item W W s
8716 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8717 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8718 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8719 Signature}.
8720
8721 @item W W l
8722 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8723 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8724 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8725 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8726 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8727 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8728 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8729 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8730
8731 @table @code
8732
8733 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8734 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8735 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8736 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8737
8738 @end table
8739
8740 @item W W P
8741 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8742 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8743 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8744 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8745
8746 @item W W B
8747 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8748 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8749 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8750 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8751 @cindex banner
8752 @cindex OneList
8753 @cindex stripping advertisements
8754 @cindex advertisements
8755 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8756 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8757 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8758 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8759 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8760 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8761 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8762 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8763 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8764 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8765 used.
8766
8767 For instance:
8768
8769 @lisp
8770 (setq gnus-article-banner-alist
8771 ((googleGroups .
8772 "^\n*--~--~---------\\(.+\n\\)+")))
8773 @end lisp
8774
8775 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8776 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8777 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8778
8779 @table @code
8780
8781 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8782 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8783 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8784 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8785 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8786 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8787 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8788 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8789 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8790 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8791 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8792
8793 @lisp
8794 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8795 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8796 @end lisp
8797
8798 @end table
8799
8800 @item W W c
8801 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8802 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8803 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8804 customizing the hiding:
8805
8806 @table @code
8807
8808 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8809 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8810 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8811 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8812 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8813 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8814 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8815 specs are valid:
8816
8817 @table @samp
8818 @item b
8819 Starting point of the hidden text.
8820 @item e
8821 Ending point of the hidden text.
8822 @item l
8823 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8824 @item n
8825 Number of lines of hidden text.
8826 @end table
8827
8828 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8829 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8830 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8831 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8832 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8833
8834 @end table
8835
8836 @item W W C-c
8837 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8838 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8839
8840 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8841 following two variables:
8842
8843 @table @code
8844 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8845 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8846 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8847 50), hide the cited text.
8848
8849 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8850 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8851 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8852 is hidden.
8853 @end table
8854
8855 @item W W C
8856 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8857 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8858 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8859 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8860 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8861 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8862
8863 @end table
8864
8865 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8866 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8867 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8868
8869 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8870 citation customization.
8871
8872 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8873 automatically.
8874
8875
8876 @node Article Washing
8877 @subsection Article Washing
8878 @cindex washing
8879 @cindex article washing
8880
8881 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8882 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8883
8884 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8885 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8886 Cleaner, perhaps.
8887
8888 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8889 articles by default.
8890
8891 @table @kbd
8892
8893 @item C-u g
8894 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8895 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8896 the server.
8897
8898 @item g
8899 Force redisplaying of the current article
8900 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8901 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8902 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8903 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8904
8905 @item W l
8906 @kindex W l (Summary)
8907 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8908 Remove page breaks from the current article
8909 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8910 delimiters.
8911
8912 @item W r
8913 @kindex W r (Summary)
8914 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8915 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8916 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8917 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8918 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8919 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8920
8921 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8922 positions in the alphabet, e.g., @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8923 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8924 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8925
8926 @item W m
8927 @kindex W m (Summary)
8928 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8929 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8930
8931 @item W i
8932 @kindex W i (Summary)
8933 @findex gnus-summary-idna-message
8934 Decode IDNA encoded domain names in the current articles. IDNA
8935 encoded domain names looks like @samp{xn--bar}. If a string remain
8936 unencoded after running invoking this, it is likely an invalid IDNA
8937 string (@samp{xn--bar} is invalid). You must have GNU Libidn
8938 (@url{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/}) installed for this command
8939 to work.
8940
8941 @item W t
8942 @item t
8943 @kindex W t (Summary)
8944 @kindex t (Summary)
8945 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8946 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8947 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8948
8949 @item W v
8950 @kindex W v (Summary)
8951 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8952 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8953 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8954
8955 @item W o
8956 @kindex W o (Summary)
8957 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8958 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8959
8960 @item W d
8961 @kindex W d (Summary)
8962 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8963 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8964 @cindex Smartquotes
8965 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8966 @cindex Latin 1
8967 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8968 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8969 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8970 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8971 interactively.
8972
8973 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8974 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8975 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8976 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8977
8978 @item W U
8979 @kindex W U (Summary)
8980 @findex gnus-article-treat-non-ascii
8981 @cindex Unicode
8982 @cindex Non-@acronym{ASCII}
8983 Translate many non-@acronym{ASCII} characters into their
8984 @acronym{ASCII} equivalents (@code{gnus-article-treat-non-ascii}).
8985 This is mostly useful if you're on a terminal that has a limited font
8986 and doesn't show accented characters, ``advanced'' punctuation, and the
8987 like. For instance, @samp{»} is translated into @samp{>>}, and so on.
8988
8989 @item W Y f
8990 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8991 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8992 @cindex Outlook Express
8993 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8994 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8995 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8996
8997 @item W Y u
8998 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8999 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
9000 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
9001 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
9002 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
9003 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
9004 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
9005 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
9006 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
9007 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
9008
9009 @item W Y a
9010 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
9011 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
9012 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
9013 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
9014
9015 @item W Y c
9016 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
9017 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
9018 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
9019 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
9020
9021 @item W w
9022 @kindex W w (Summary)
9023 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
9024 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
9025
9026 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
9027 when filling.
9028
9029 @item W Q
9030 @kindex W Q (Summary)
9031 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
9032 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
9033
9034 @item W C
9035 @kindex W C (Summary)
9036 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
9037 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
9038 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
9039
9040 @item W c
9041 @kindex W c (Summary)
9042 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
9043 Translate CRLF pairs (i.e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
9044 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
9045 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
9046 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
9047
9048 @item W q
9049 @kindex W q (Summary)
9050 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
9051 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
9052 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
9053 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
9054 makes strings like @samp{d@'ej@`a vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu},
9055 which doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually
9056 done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9057 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9058 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9059
9060 @item W 6
9061 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
9062 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
9063 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
9064 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
9065 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
9066 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9067 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
9068 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
9069
9070 @item W Z
9071 @kindex W Z (Summary)
9072 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
9073 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
9074 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
9075 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
9076
9077 @item W A
9078 @kindex W A (Summary)
9079 @findex gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences
9080 @cindex @acronym{ANSI} control sequences
9081 Translate @acronym{ANSI} SGR control sequences into overlays or
9082 extents (@code{gnus-article-treat-ansi-sequences}). @acronym{ANSI}
9083 sequences are used in some Chinese hierarchies for highlighting.
9084
9085 @item W u
9086 @kindex W u (Summary)
9087 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
9088 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
9089 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
9090 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
9091 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
9092
9093 @item W h
9094 @kindex W h (Summary)
9095 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
9096 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
9097 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
9098 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
9099
9100 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
9101 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
9102 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
9103
9104 The default is to use the function specified by
9105 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
9106 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
9107 @acronym{HTML}. Pre-defined functions you can use include:
9108
9109 @table @code
9110 @item shr
9111 Use Gnus simple html renderer.
9112
9113 @item gnus-w3m
9114 Use Gnus rendered based on w3m.
9115
9116 @item w3
9117 Use Emacs/W3.
9118
9119 @item w3m
9120 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
9121
9122 @item w3m-standalone
9123 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
9124
9125 @item links
9126 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
9127
9128 @item lynx
9129 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
9130
9131 @item html2text
9132 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
9133
9134 @end table
9135
9136 @item W b
9137 @kindex W b (Summary)
9138 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
9139 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
9140 @xref{Article Buttons}.
9141
9142 @item W B
9143 @kindex W B (Summary)
9144 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
9145 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
9146 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
9147
9148 @item W p
9149 @kindex W p (Summary)
9150 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
9151 Verify a signed control message
9152 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
9153 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
9154 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
9155 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
9156 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
9157 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
9158
9159 @item W s
9160 @kindex W s (Summary)
9161 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
9162 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
9163 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
9164 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
9165
9166 @item W a
9167 @kindex W a (Summary)
9168 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
9169 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
9170 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
9171
9172 @item W E l
9173 @kindex W E l (Summary)
9174 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
9175 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
9176 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
9177
9178 @item W E m
9179 @kindex W E m (Summary)
9180 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
9181 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
9182 lines with a single empty line.
9183 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
9184
9185 @item W E t
9186 @kindex W E t (Summary)
9187 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
9188 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
9189 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
9190
9191 @item W E a
9192 @kindex W E a (Summary)
9193 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
9194 Do all the three commands above
9195 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
9196
9197 @item W E A
9198 @kindex W E A (Summary)
9199 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
9200 Remove all blank lines
9201 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
9202
9203 @item W E s
9204 @kindex W E s (Summary)
9205 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
9206 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
9207 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
9208
9209 @item W E e
9210 @kindex W E e (Summary)
9211 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
9212 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
9213 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
9214
9215 @end table
9216
9217 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
9218
9219
9220 @node Article Header
9221 @subsection Article Header
9222
9223 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
9224
9225 @table @kbd
9226
9227 @item W G u
9228 @kindex W G u (Summary)
9229 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
9230 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
9231
9232 @item W G n
9233 @kindex W G n (Summary)
9234 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
9235 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
9236 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
9237
9238 @item W G f
9239 @kindex W G f (Summary)
9240 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
9241 Fold all the message headers
9242 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
9243
9244 @item W E w
9245 @kindex W E w (Summary)
9246 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
9247 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
9248 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
9249
9250 @end table
9251
9252
9253 @node Article Buttons
9254 @subsection Article Buttons
9255 @cindex buttons
9256
9257 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
9258 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
9259 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
9260 button on these references.
9261
9262 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9263 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
9264 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
9265 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
9266 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
9267
9268 @table @code
9269
9270 @item gnus-button-alist
9271 @vindex gnus-button-alist
9272 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
9273
9274 @lisp
9275 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9276 @end lisp
9277
9278 @table @var
9279
9280 @item regexp
9281 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
9282 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
9283 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
9284 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
9285 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
9286
9287 @item button-par
9288 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
9289 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
9290 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
9291
9292 @item use-p
9293 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
9294 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
9295 avoid false matches. Often variables named
9296 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
9297 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
9298
9299 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
9300
9301 @item function
9302 This function will be called when you click on this button.
9303
9304 @item data-par
9305 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
9306 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
9307
9308 @end table
9309
9310 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
9311
9312 @lisp
9313 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
9314 @end lisp
9315
9316 @item gnus-header-button-alist
9317 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
9318 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
9319 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
9320 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
9321
9322 @lisp
9323 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
9324 @end lisp
9325
9326 @var{header} is a regular expression.
9327 @end table
9328
9329 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
9330
9331 @table @code
9332 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
9333 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
9334
9335 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
9336
9337 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
9338 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
9339 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
9340 default values of the variables above.
9341
9342 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
9343
9344 @item gnus-button-man-handler
9345 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
9346 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
9347 argument with a string naming the man page.
9348
9349 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
9350
9351 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9352 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
9353 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
9354
9355 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9356 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
9357 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
9358 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
9359 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
9360 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
9361 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
9362 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
9363 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
9364 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
9365 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
9366 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9367
9368 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9369 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
9370 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
9371 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
9372 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
9373 string is invalid.
9374
9375 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9376 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
9377 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
9378 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
9379
9380 @c Misc stuff
9381
9382 @item gnus-article-button-face
9383 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9384 Face used on buttons.
9385
9386 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9387 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9388 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9389
9390 @end table
9391
9392 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9393
9394
9395 @node Article Button Levels
9396 @subsection Article button levels
9397 @cindex button levels
9398 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9399 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9400 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9401 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9402 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9403 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9404 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9405 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9406
9407 @lisp
9408 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9409 (setq gnus-parameters
9410 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9411 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9412 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9413 @end lisp
9414
9415 @table @code
9416
9417 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9418 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9419 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9420 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9421 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9422 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9423
9424 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9425 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9426 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9427 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9428 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9429 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9430 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9431 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9432 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9433 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9434 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9435 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9436 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9437
9438 @item gnus-button-man-level
9439 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9440 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9441 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9442
9443 @item gnus-button-message-level
9444 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9445 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9446 Related variables and functions include
9447 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9448 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9449 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9450 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9451
9452 @end table
9453
9454
9455 @node Article Date
9456 @subsection Article Date
9457
9458 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9459 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9460 when the article was sent.
9461
9462 @table @kbd
9463
9464 @item W T u
9465 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9466 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9467 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9468 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9469
9470 @item W T i
9471 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9472 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9473 @cindex ISO 8601
9474 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9475 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9476
9477 @item W T l
9478 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9479 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9480 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9481
9482 @item W T p
9483 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9484 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9485 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9486 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9487
9488 @item W T s
9489 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9490 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9491 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9492 @findex format-time-string
9493 Display the date using a user-defined format
9494 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9495 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9496 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9497 for a list of possible format specs.
9498
9499 @item W T e
9500 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9501 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9502 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9503 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9504 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9505 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9506
9507 @example
9508 Date: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9509 @end example
9510
9511 This line is updated continually by default. The frequency (in
9512 seconds) is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-update-date-headers}
9513 variable.
9514
9515 If you wish to switch updating off, say:
9516
9517 @vindex gnus-article-update-date-headers
9518 @lisp
9519 (setq gnus-article-update-date-headers nil)
9520 @end lisp
9521
9522 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9523
9524 @item W T o
9525 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9526 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9527 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9528 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9529 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9530 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9531 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9532
9533 @end table
9534
9535 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9536 preferred format automatically.
9537
9538
9539 @node Article Display
9540 @subsection Article Display
9541 @cindex picons
9542 @cindex x-face
9543 @cindex smileys
9544 @cindex gravatars
9545
9546 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9547 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9548
9549 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9550 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9551
9552 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9553 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9554
9555 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9556 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9557
9558 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9559 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9560
9561 Gravatars reside on-line and are fetched from
9562 @uref{http://www.gravatar.com/} (@pxref{Gravatars}).
9563
9564 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9565 they'll be removed.
9566
9567 @table @kbd
9568 @item W D x
9569 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9570 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9571 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9572 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9573
9574 @item W D d
9575 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9576 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9577 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9578 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9579
9580 @item W D s
9581 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9582 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9583 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9584
9585 @item W D f
9586 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9587 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9588 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9589
9590 @item W D m
9591 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9592 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9593 Piconify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9594 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9595
9596 @item W D n
9597 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9598 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9599 Piconify all news headers (i.e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9600 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9601
9602 @item W D g
9603 @kindex W D g (Summary)
9604 @findex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
9605 Gravatarify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9606
9607 @item W D h
9608 @kindex W D h (Summary)
9609 @findex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
9610 Gravatarify all mail headers (i.e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9611 (@code{gnus-treat-from-gravatar}).
9612
9613 @item W D D
9614 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9615 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9616 Remove all images from the article buffer
9617 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9618
9619 @item W D W
9620 @kindex W D W (Summary)
9621 @findex gnus-html-show-images
9622 If you're reading an @acronym{HTML} article rendered with
9623 @code{gnus-article-html}, then you can insert any blocked images in
9624 the buffer with this command.
9625 (@code{gnus-html-show-images}).
9626
9627 @end table
9628
9629
9630
9631 @node Article Signature
9632 @subsection Article Signature
9633 @cindex signatures
9634 @cindex article signature
9635
9636 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9637 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9638 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9639 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9640 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9641 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9642 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9643 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9644 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9645
9646 @lisp
9647 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9648 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9649 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9650 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9651 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9652 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9653 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9654 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9655 @end lisp
9656
9657 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9658 positives.
9659
9660 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9661 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9662 signature when displaying articles.
9663
9664 @enumerate
9665 @item
9666 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9667 that integer.
9668 @item
9669 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9670 than that number.
9671 @item
9672 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9673 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9674 @item
9675 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9676 in question is not a signature.
9677 @end enumerate
9678
9679 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9680 listed above. Here's an example:
9681
9682 @lisp
9683 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9684 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9685 @end lisp
9686
9687 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9688 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9689 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9690 signature after all.
9691
9692
9693 @node Article Miscellanea
9694 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9695
9696 @table @kbd
9697 @item A t
9698 @kindex A t (Summary)
9699 @findex gnus-article-babel
9700 Translate the article from one language to another
9701 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9702
9703 @end table
9704
9705
9706 @node MIME Commands
9707 @section MIME Commands
9708 @cindex MIME decoding
9709 @cindex attachments
9710 @cindex viewing attachments
9711
9712 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9713 instance, @kbd{3 K v} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9714
9715 @table @kbd
9716 @item b
9717 @itemx K v
9718 @kindex b (Summary)
9719 @kindex K v (Summary)
9720 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9721
9722 @item K o
9723 @kindex K o (Summary)
9724 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9725
9726 @item K O
9727 @kindex K O (Summary)
9728 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} part and strip it
9729 from the article. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred
9730 via the message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
9731
9732 @item K r
9733 @kindex K r (Summary)
9734 Replace the @acronym{MIME} part with an external body.
9735
9736 @item K d
9737 @kindex K d (Summary)
9738 Delete the @acronym{MIME} part and add some information about the
9739 removed part.
9740
9741 @item K c
9742 @kindex K c (Summary)
9743 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9744
9745 @item K e
9746 @kindex K e (Summary)
9747 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9748
9749 @item K i
9750 @kindex K i (Summary)
9751 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9752
9753 @item K |
9754 @kindex K | (Summary)
9755 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9756 @end table
9757
9758 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9759 the same manner:
9760
9761 @table @kbd
9762 @item K H
9763 @kindex K H (Summary)
9764 @findex gnus-article-browse-html-article
9765 View @samp{text/html} parts of the current article with a WWW browser.
9766 Inline images embedded in a message using the @code{cid} scheme, as they
9767 are generally considered to be safe, will be processed properly. The
9768 message header is added to the beginning of every @acronym{HTML} part
9769 unless the prefix argument is given.
9770
9771 Warning: Spammers use links to images (using the @code{http} scheme) in
9772 @acronym{HTML} articles to verify whether you have read the message. As
9773 this command passes the @acronym{HTML} content to the browser without
9774 eliminating these ``web bugs'' you should only use it for mails from
9775 trusted senders.
9776
9777 If you always want to display @acronym{HTML} parts in the browser, set
9778 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} to @code{nil}.
9779
9780 This command creates temporary files to pass @acronym{HTML} contents
9781 including images if any to the browser, and deletes them when exiting
9782 the group (if you want).
9783
9784 @item K b
9785 @kindex K b (Summary)
9786 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9787 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9788 parts.
9789
9790 @item K m
9791 @kindex K m (Summary)
9792 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9793 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9794 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9795 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9796 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9797
9798 @item X m
9799 @kindex X m (Summary)
9800 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9801 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9802 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9803 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9804
9805 @item M-t
9806 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9807 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9808 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9809 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9810
9811 @item W M w
9812 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9813 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9814 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9815 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9816
9817 @item W M c
9818 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9819 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9820 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9821 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9822
9823 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9824 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9825 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9826 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9827 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9828 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9829
9830 @item W M v
9831 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9832 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9833 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9834 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9835
9836 @end table
9837
9838 Relevant variables:
9839
9840 @table @code
9841 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9842 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9843 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9844 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9845 @code{nil}.
9846
9847 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9848
9849 @lisp
9850 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9851 '("text/x-vcard"))
9852 @end lisp
9853
9854 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9855 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9856 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9857 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9858 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9859 default is @code{t}.
9860
9861 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9862 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9863 @cindex uuencode
9864 @cindex yEnc
9865 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9866 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9867 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9868 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9869 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9870 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9871 for encoding in Gnus.
9872
9873 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9874 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9875 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9876 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9877 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9878 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9879 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9880 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9881
9882 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9883 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9884 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9885 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9886 displayed. This variable overrides
9887 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9888 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9889 is @code{nil}.
9890
9891 E.g., to see security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9892 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9893 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9894
9895 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9896 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9897 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9898 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9899 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9900
9901 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9902 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9903 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9904 default value is @code{nil}.
9905
9906 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9907 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9908 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9909 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9910 users to gather information from the article (e.g., add Vcard info to
9911 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e.g., automatically
9912 save all jpegs into some directory).
9913
9914 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9915
9916 @lisp
9917 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9918 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9919 (with-temp-buffer
9920 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9921 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9922 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9923 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9924 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9925 @end lisp
9926
9927 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9928 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9929 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9930
9931 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9932 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9933 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9934
9935 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9936 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9937 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9938
9939 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9940 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9941 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9942 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9943 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9944
9945 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9946 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9947 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9948 overrides @code{nil} values of
9949 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9950 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9951
9952 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9953 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9954 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9955 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9956
9957 Ready-made functions include@*
9958 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9959 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9960 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9961 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9962 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9963 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9964 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9965 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9966 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9967 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9968 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9969 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9970
9971 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9972 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9973
9974 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9975 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9976 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9977
9978 @lisp
9979 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9980 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9981 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9982 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9983 @end lisp
9984
9985 @noindent
9986 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9987
9988 @end table
9989
9990
9991 @node Charsets
9992 @section Charsets
9993 @cindex charsets
9994
9995 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9996 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9997 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9998 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9999 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
10000 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
10001 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
10002
10003 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
10004 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
10005 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
10006 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
10007
10008 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
10009 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
10010 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
10011 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
10012 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
10013 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
10014 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
10015 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
10016 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
10017
10018 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
10019 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
10020 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
10021 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
10022 quoted-printable header encoding.
10023
10024 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
10025 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
10026 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
10027
10028 @table @var
10029 @item test
10030 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
10031 variable to query,
10032 @item header
10033 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
10034 means encode all charsets),
10035 @item body-list
10036 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
10037 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
10038 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
10039 @end table
10040
10041 @cindex Russian
10042 @cindex koi8-r
10043 @cindex koi8-u
10044 @cindex iso-8859-5
10045 @cindex coding system aliases
10046 @cindex preferred charset
10047
10048 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
10049 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
10050 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
10051
10052 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
10053
10054 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
10055 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
10056
10057 @lisp
10058 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
10059 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
10060 @end lisp
10061
10062 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
10063 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
10064
10065 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
10066
10067 @lisp
10068 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
10069 @end lisp
10070
10071 This will almost do the right thing.
10072
10073 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
10074 something like
10075
10076 @lisp
10077 (codepage-setup 1251)
10078 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
10079 @end lisp
10080
10081
10082 @node Article Commands
10083 @section Article Commands
10084
10085 @table @kbd
10086
10087 @item A P
10088 @cindex PostScript
10089 @cindex printing
10090 @kindex A P (Summary)
10091 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
10092 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
10093 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
10094 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
10095 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
10096 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
10097
10098 @item A C
10099 @vindex gnus-fetch-partial-articles
10100 @findex gnus-summary-show-complete-article
10101 If @code{<backend>-fetch-partial-articles} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
10102 fetch partial articles, if the backend it fetches them from supports
10103 it. Currently only @code{nnimap} does. If you're looking at a
10104 partial article, and want to see the complete article instead, then
10105 the @kbd{A C} command (@code{gnus-summary-show-complete-article}) will
10106 do so.
10107
10108 @end table
10109
10110
10111 @node Summary Sorting
10112 @section Summary Sorting
10113 @cindex summary sorting
10114
10115 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
10116 can't really see why you'd want that.
10117
10118 @table @kbd
10119
10120 @item C-c C-s C-n
10121 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10122 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
10123 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
10124
10125 @item C-c C-s C-m C-n
10126 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
10127 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number
10128 Sort by most recent article number
10129 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-number}).
10130
10131 @item C-c C-s C-a
10132 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
10133 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
10134 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
10135
10136 @item C-c C-s C-t
10137 @kindex C-c C-s C-t (Summary)
10138 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient
10139 Sort by recipient (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-recipient}).
10140
10141 @item C-c C-s C-s
10142 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
10143 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
10144 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
10145
10146 @item C-c C-s C-d
10147 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
10148 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
10149 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
10150
10151 @item C-c C-s C-m C-d
10152 @kindex C-c C-s C-m C-d (Summary)
10153 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date
10154 Sort by most recent date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-most-recent-date}).
10155
10156 @item C-c C-s C-l
10157 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
10158 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
10159 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
10160
10161 @item C-c C-s C-c
10162 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
10163 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
10164 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
10165
10166 @item C-c C-s C-i
10167 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
10168 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
10169 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
10170
10171 @item C-c C-s C-r
10172 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
10173 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
10174 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
10175
10176 @item C-c C-s C-o
10177 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
10178 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
10179 Sort using the default sorting method
10180 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
10181 @end table
10182
10183 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
10184 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
10185 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
10186 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
10187 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
10188 Commands}).
10189
10190 If a prefix argument if given, the sort order is reversed.
10191
10192
10193 @node Finding the Parent
10194 @section Finding the Parent
10195 @cindex parent articles
10196 @cindex referring articles
10197
10198 @table @kbd
10199 @item ^
10200 @kindex ^ (Summary)
10201 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
10202 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
10203 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
10204 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
10205 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
10206 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
10207 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
10208 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
10209 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
10210
10211 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
10212 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
10213 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
10214 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
10215 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
10216 article.
10217
10218 @item A R (Summary)
10219 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
10220 @kindex A R (Summary)
10221 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
10222 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
10223
10224 @item A T (Summary)
10225 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
10226 @kindex A T (Summary)
10227 Display the full thread where the current article appears
10228 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
10229 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
10230 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
10231 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
10232 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
10233 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
10234
10235 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
10236 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i.e.,
10237 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
10238 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
10239 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
10240 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
10241
10242 @item M-^ (Summary)
10243 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
10244 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
10245 @cindex Message-ID
10246 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
10247 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
10248 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
10249 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
10250 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
10251 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
10252
10253 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
10254 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
10255 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
10256 @end table
10257
10258 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
10259 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
10260 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
10261 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
10262 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
10263 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
10264 necessary.
10265
10266 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
10267 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
10268 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
10269 match.
10270
10271 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
10272 then ask Google if that fails:
10273
10274 @lisp
10275 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
10276 '(current
10277 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
10278 @end lisp
10279
10280 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
10281 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
10282 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
10283 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
10284 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
10285 group. @code{nnmh} does not support this at all.
10286
10287 Fortunately, the special @code{nnregistry} back end is able to locate
10288 articles in any groups, regardless of their back end (@pxref{Registry
10289 Article Refer Method, fetching by @code{Message-ID} using the
10290 registry}).
10291
10292 @node Alternative Approaches
10293 @section Alternative Approaches
10294
10295 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
10296 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
10297
10298 @menu
10299 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
10300 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
10301 @end menu
10302
10303
10304 @node Pick and Read
10305 @subsection Pick and Read
10306 @cindex pick and read
10307
10308 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
10309 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
10310 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
10311 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
10312
10313 @findex gnus-pick-mode
10314 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
10315 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
10316 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
10317 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
10318 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
10319
10320 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
10321
10322 @table @kbd
10323 @item .
10324 @kindex . (Pick)
10325 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
10326 Pick the article or thread on the current line
10327 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10328 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
10329 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
10330 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
10331 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
10332 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
10333
10334 @item SPACE
10335 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
10336 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
10337 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
10338 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
10339
10340 @item u
10341 @kindex u (Pick)
10342 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
10343 Unpick the thread or article
10344 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
10345 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
10346 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
10347 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
10348 the thread or article at that line.
10349
10350 @item RET
10351 @kindex RET (Pick)
10352 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
10353 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
10354 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
10355 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
10356 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
10357 will still be visible when you are reading.
10358
10359 @end table
10360
10361 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
10362 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
10363 which is mapped to the same function
10364 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
10365
10366 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
10367
10368 @lisp
10369 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
10370 @end lisp
10371
10372 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
10373 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
10374
10375 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
10376 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
10377 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
10378
10379 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
10380 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
10381 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
10382 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
10383 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
10384 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
10385 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
10386
10387
10388 @node Binary Groups
10389 @subsection Binary Groups
10390 @cindex binary groups
10391
10392 @findex gnus-binary-mode
10393 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
10394 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
10395 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
10396 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
10397 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
10398 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
10399
10400 @kindex g (Binary)
10401 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
10402 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
10403 command, when you have turned on this mode
10404 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
10405
10406 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
10407 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
10408
10409
10410 @node Tree Display
10411 @section Tree Display
10412 @cindex trees
10413
10414 @vindex gnus-use-trees
10415 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
10416 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
10417 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
10418 in the tree buffer.
10419
10420 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
10421
10422 @table @code
10423 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
10424 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
10425 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
10426
10427 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10428 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
10429 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
10430 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
10431 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
10432
10433 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
10434 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
10435 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
10436 default is @code{modeline}.
10437
10438 @item gnus-tree-line-format
10439 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
10440 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
10441 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
10442 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
10443 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
10444 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
10445
10446 Valid specs are:
10447
10448 @table @samp
10449 @item n
10450 The name of the poster.
10451 @item f
10452 The @code{From} header.
10453 @item N
10454 The number of the article.
10455 @item [
10456 The opening bracket.
10457 @item ]
10458 The closing bracket.
10459 @item s
10460 The subject.
10461 @end table
10462
10463 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10464
10465 Variables related to the display are:
10466
10467 @table @code
10468 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10469 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10470 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10471 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10472 @example
10473 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10474 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10475 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10476 @end example
10477 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10478
10479 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10480 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10481 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10482 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10483
10484 @end table
10485
10486 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10487 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10488 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10489 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10490 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10491 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10492 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10493 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10494 other windows displayed next to it.
10495
10496 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10497 at all times:
10498
10499 @lisp
10500 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10501 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10502 @end lisp
10503
10504 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10505 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10506 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10507 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10508 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10509 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10510 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10511
10512 @end table
10513
10514 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10515
10516 @example
10517 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10518 | \[Jan]
10519 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10520 | \(***)-[Eri]
10521 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10522 \[Bjo]
10523 \[Gun]
10524 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10525 @end example
10526
10527 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10528
10529 @example
10530 @group
10531 @{***@}
10532 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10533 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10534 |--\-----\-----\ |
10535 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10536 | | |--\
10537 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10538 |
10539 [Paa]
10540 @end group
10541 @end example
10542
10543 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10544 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10545 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10546
10547 @lisp
10548 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10549 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10550 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10551 (gnus-add-configuration
10552 '(article
10553 (vertical 1.0
10554 (horizontal 0.25
10555 (summary 0.75 point)
10556 (tree 1.0))
10557 (article 1.0))))
10558 @end lisp
10559
10560 @xref{Window Layout}.
10561
10562
10563 @node Mail Group Commands
10564 @section Mail Group Commands
10565 @cindex mail group commands
10566
10567 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10568 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10569
10570 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10571 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10572
10573 @table @kbd
10574
10575 @item B e
10576 @kindex B e (Summary)
10577 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10578 @cindex expiring mail
10579 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10580 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10581 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10582 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10583
10584 @item B C-M-e
10585 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10586 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10587 @cindex expiring mail
10588 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10589 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10590 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10591 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10592
10593 @item B DEL
10594 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10595 @cindex deleting mail
10596 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10597 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10598 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10599 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10600 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10601
10602 @item B m
10603 @kindex B m (Summary)
10604 @cindex move mail
10605 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10606 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10607 Move the article from one mail group to another
10608 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10609 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10610
10611 @item B c
10612 @kindex B c (Summary)
10613 @cindex copy mail
10614 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10615 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10616 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10617 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10618 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10619
10620 @item B B
10621 @kindex B B (Summary)
10622 @cindex crosspost mail
10623 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10624 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10625 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10626 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10627 be properly updated.
10628
10629 @item B i
10630 @kindex B i (Summary)
10631 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10632 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10633 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10634 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10635
10636 @item B I
10637 @kindex B I (Summary)
10638 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10639 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10640 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10641 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10642
10643 @item B r
10644 @kindex B r (Summary)
10645 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10646 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10647 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10648 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10649 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10650 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10651 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10652 (which is the default).
10653
10654 @item B w
10655 @itemx e
10656 @kindex B w (Summary)
10657 @kindex e (Summary)
10658 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10659 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10660 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10661 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10662 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10663 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10664 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10665
10666 @item B q
10667 @kindex B q (Summary)
10668 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10669 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10670 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10671 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10672
10673 @item B t
10674 @kindex B t (Summary)
10675 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10676 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10677 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10678
10679 @item B p
10680 @kindex B p (Summary)
10681 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10682 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10683 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10684 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10685 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10686 article from your news server (or rather, from
10687 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10688 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10689 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10690 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10691 just not have arrived yet.
10692
10693 @item K E
10694 @kindex K E (Summary)
10695 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10696 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10697 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10698 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10699 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10700
10701 @end table
10702
10703 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10704 @cindex moving articles
10705 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10706 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10707 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10708 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10709 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10710 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10711 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10712
10713 @lisp
10714 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10715 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10716 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10717 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10718 @end lisp
10719
10720
10721 @node Various Summary Stuff
10722 @section Various Summary Stuff
10723
10724 @menu
10725 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10726 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10727 * Summary Generation Commands::
10728 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10729 @end menu
10730
10731 @table @code
10732 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10733 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10734 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10735 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10736 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10737 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10738
10739 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10740 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10741 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10742 current article.
10743
10744 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10745 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10746 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10747
10748 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10749 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10750 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10751 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10752 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10753 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10754 have been set.
10755
10756 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10757 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10758 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10759 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10760 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10761
10762 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10763 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10764 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10765 generated.
10766
10767 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10768 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10769 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10770 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10771 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10772 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10773 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10774 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10775 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10776 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10777
10778 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10779 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10780 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10781 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10782 list of articles to be selected.
10783
10784 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10785 the list in one particular group:
10786
10787 @lisp
10788 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10789 (if (string= group "some.group")
10790 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10791 articles))
10792 @end lisp
10793
10794 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10795 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10796 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10797 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10798 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10799 buffer is active.
10800
10801 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10802 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10803 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10804 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10805 variable will be used instead.
10806
10807 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10808 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10809 buffers. For example:
10810
10811 @lisp
10812 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10813 '(message-use-followup-to
10814 (gnus-visible-headers .
10815 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10816 @end lisp
10817
10818 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10819
10820 @end table
10821
10822
10823 @node Summary Group Information
10824 @subsection Summary Group Information
10825
10826 @table @kbd
10827
10828 @item H d
10829 @kindex H d (Summary)
10830 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10831 Give a brief description of the current group
10832 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10833 rereading the description from the server.
10834
10835 @item H h
10836 @kindex H h (Summary)
10837 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10838 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10839 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10840
10841 @item H i
10842 @kindex H i (Summary)
10843 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10844 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10845 @end table
10846
10847
10848 @node Searching for Articles
10849 @subsection Searching for Articles
10850
10851 @table @kbd
10852
10853 @item M-s
10854 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10855 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10856 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10857 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10858
10859 @item M-r
10860 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10861 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10862 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10863 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10864
10865 @item M-S
10866 @kindex M-S (Summary)
10867 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward
10868 Repeat the previous search forwards
10869 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-forward}).
10870
10871 @item M-R
10872 @kindex M-R (Summary)
10873 @findex gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward
10874 Repeat the previous search backwards
10875 (@code{gnus-summary-repeat-search-article-backward}).
10876
10877 @item &
10878 @kindex & (Summary)
10879 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10880 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10881 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10882 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10883 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10884 search backward instead.
10885
10886 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10887 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10888
10889 @item M-&
10890 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10891 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10892 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10893 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10894 @end table
10895
10896 @node Summary Generation Commands
10897 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10898
10899 @table @kbd
10900
10901 @item Y g
10902 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10903 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10904 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10905
10906 @item Y c
10907 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10908 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10909 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10910 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10911
10912 @item Y d
10913 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10914 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10915 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10916 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10917
10918 @item Y t
10919 @kindex Y t (Summary)
10920 @findex gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles
10921 Pull all ticked articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10922 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-ticked-articles}).
10923
10924 @end table
10925
10926
10927 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10928 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10929
10930 @table @kbd
10931
10932 @item A D
10933 @itemx C-d
10934 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10935 @kindex A D (Summary)
10936 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10937 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10938 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10939 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10940 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10941 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10942 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10943 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10944 fashion.
10945
10946 @vindex gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit
10947 The variable @code{gnus-auto-select-on-ephemeral-exit} controls what
10948 article should be selected after exiting a digest group. Valid values
10949 include:
10950
10951 @table @code
10952 @item next
10953 Select the next article.
10954
10955 @item next-unread
10956 Select the next unread article.
10957
10958 @item next-noselect
10959 Move the cursor to the next article. This is the default.
10960
10961 @item next-unread-noselect
10962 Move the cursor to the next unread article.
10963 @end table
10964
10965 If it has any other value or there is no next (unread) article, the
10966 article selected before entering to the digest group will appear.
10967
10968 @item C-M-d
10969 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10970 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10971 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10972 several documents into one biiig group
10973 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10974 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10975 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10976 command understands the process/prefix convention
10977 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10978
10979 @item C-t
10980 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10981 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10982 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10983 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10984 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10985 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10986
10987 @item =
10988 @kindex = (Summary)
10989 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10990 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10991 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10992
10993 @item C-M-e
10994 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10995 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10996 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10997 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10998
10999 @item C-M-a
11000 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
11001 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
11002 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
11003 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
11004
11005 @end table
11006
11007
11008 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
11009 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
11010 @cindex summary exit
11011 @cindex exiting groups
11012
11013 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
11014 group and return you to the group buffer.
11015
11016 @table @kbd
11017
11018 @item Z Z
11019 @itemx Z Q
11020 @itemx q
11021 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
11022 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
11023 @kindex q (Summary)
11024 @findex gnus-summary-exit
11025 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
11026 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
11027 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
11028 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
11029 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
11030 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
11031 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
11032 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
11033 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
11034 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
11035 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
11036
11037 @item Z E
11038 @itemx Q
11039 @kindex Z E (Summary)
11040 @kindex Q (Summary)
11041 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
11042 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
11043 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
11044
11045 @item Z c
11046 @itemx c
11047 @kindex Z c (Summary)
11048 @kindex c (Summary)
11049 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
11050 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
11051 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
11052 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
11053
11054 @item Z C
11055 @kindex Z C (Summary)
11056 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
11057 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
11058 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
11059
11060 @item Z n
11061 @kindex Z n (Summary)
11062 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
11063 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
11064 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
11065
11066 @item Z p
11067 @kindex Z p (Summary)
11068 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group
11069 Mark all articles as read and go to the previous group
11070 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-prev-group}).
11071
11072 @item Z R
11073 @itemx C-x C-s
11074 @kindex Z R (Summary)
11075 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
11076 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
11077 Exit this group, and then enter it again
11078 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
11079 all articles, both read and unread.
11080
11081 @item Z G
11082 @itemx M-g
11083 @kindex Z G (Summary)
11084 @kindex M-g (Summary)
11085 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
11086 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
11087 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
11088 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
11089 articles, both read and unread.
11090
11091 @item Z N
11092 @kindex Z N (Summary)
11093 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
11094 Exit the group and go to the next group
11095 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
11096
11097 @item Z P
11098 @kindex Z P (Summary)
11099 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
11100 Exit the group and go to the previous group
11101 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
11102
11103 @item Z s
11104 @kindex Z s (Summary)
11105 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
11106 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
11107 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
11108 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
11109 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
11110 @end table
11111
11112 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
11113 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
11114 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
11115 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
11116
11117 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
11118 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
11119 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
11120 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
11121 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
11122 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
11123 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
11124 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
11125 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
11126 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
11127 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
11128 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
11129
11130 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
11131
11132 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
11133 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
11134 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.)@: when you exit the
11135 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
11136 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
11137 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
11138 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
11139 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
11140 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
11141
11142
11143 @node Crosspost Handling
11144 @section Crosspost Handling
11145
11146 @cindex velveeta
11147 @cindex spamming
11148 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
11149 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
11150 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
11151 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
11152 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
11153 heinous crime.
11154
11155 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
11156 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
11157 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
11158 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
11159 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
11160
11161 @cindex cross-posting
11162 @cindex Xref
11163 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
11164 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
11165 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
11166 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
11167 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
11168 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
11169 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
11170 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
11171 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
11172 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
11173 the cross reference mechanism.
11174
11175 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
11176 @cindex overview.fmt
11177 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
11178 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
11179 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
11180 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
11181 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
11182 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
11183 overview files.
11184
11185 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
11186 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
11187 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
11188
11189 C'est la vie.
11190
11191 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
11192
11193
11194 @node Duplicate Suppression
11195 @section Duplicate Suppression
11196
11197 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
11198 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
11199 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
11200 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
11201 reasons.
11202
11203 @enumerate
11204 @item
11205 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
11206 is evil and not very common.
11207
11208 @item
11209 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
11210 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
11211
11212 @item
11213 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
11214 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
11215
11216 @item
11217 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
11218 @end enumerate
11219
11220 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
11221 well, but these four are the most common situations.
11222
11223 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
11224 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
11225 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
11226 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
11227 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
11228 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
11229 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
11230 once.
11231
11232 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
11233 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
11234 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
11235 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
11236 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
11237 saw the article in.
11238
11239 @table @code
11240 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
11241 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
11242 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
11243
11244 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
11245 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
11246 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
11247 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
11248 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
11249 session are suppressed.
11250
11251 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
11252 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
11253 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
11254 suppression list. The default is 10000.
11255
11256 @item gnus-duplicate-file
11257 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
11258 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
11259 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
11260 @end table
11261
11262 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
11263 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
11264 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
11265 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
11266 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
11267 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
11268 to you to figure out, I think.
11269
11270 @node Security
11271 @section Security
11272
11273 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
11274 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
11275 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
11276 things to work:
11277
11278 @enumerate
11279 @item
11280 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
11281 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG@. The Lisp interface
11282 to GnuPG included with Emacs is called EasyPG (@pxref{Top, ,EasyPG,
11283 epa, EasyPG Assistant user's manual}), but PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg,
11284 PGG Manual}), and Mailcrypt are also supported.
11285
11286 @item
11287 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL@. OpenSSL 0.9.6
11288 or newer is recommended.
11289
11290 @end enumerate
11291
11292 The variables that control security functionality on reading/composing
11293 messages include:
11294
11295 @table @code
11296 @item mm-verify-option
11297 @vindex mm-verify-option
11298 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
11299 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
11300 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11301
11302 @item mm-decrypt-option
11303 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
11304 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
11305 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
11306 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
11307
11308 @item mm-sign-option
11309 @vindex mm-sign-option
11310 Option of creating signed parts. @code{nil}, use default signing
11311 keys; @code{guided}, ask user to select signing keys from the menu.
11312
11313 @item mm-encrypt-option
11314 @vindex mm-encrypt-option
11315 Option of creating encrypted parts. @code{nil}, use the first
11316 public-key matching the @samp{From:} header as the recipient;
11317 @code{guided}, ask user to select recipient keys from the menu.
11318
11319 @item mml1991-use
11320 @vindex mml1991-use
11321 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11322 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but @code{pgg},
11323 and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported although
11324 deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available interface in
11325 this order.
11326
11327 @item mml2015-use
11328 @vindex mml2015-use
11329 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
11330 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{epg}, but
11331 @code{pgg}, and @code{mailcrypt} are also supported
11332 although deprecated. By default, Gnus uses the first available
11333 interface in this order.
11334
11335 @end table
11336
11337 By default the buttons that display security information are not
11338 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
11339 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
11340 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
11341 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
11342 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
11343 how to customize these variables to always display security
11344 information.
11345
11346 @cindex snarfing keys
11347 @cindex importing PGP keys
11348 @cindex PGP key ring import
11349 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
11350 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
11351 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
11352 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
11353 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
11354 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
11355 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
11356 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
11357 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
11358
11359 @example
11360 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
11361 @end example
11362 @noindent
11363 This happens to also be the default action defined in
11364 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
11365
11366 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
11367 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
11368 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
11369
11370 @node Mailing List
11371 @section Mailing List
11372 @cindex mailing list
11373 @cindex RFC 2396
11374
11375 @kindex A M (summary)
11376 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
11377 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
11378 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
11379 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
11380 summary buffer.
11381
11382 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
11383
11384 @table @kbd
11385
11386 @item C-c C-n h
11387 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
11388 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
11389 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
11390
11391 @item C-c C-n s
11392 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
11393 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
11394 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
11395
11396 @item C-c C-n u
11397 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
11398 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
11399 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
11400 field exists.
11401
11402 @item C-c C-n p
11403 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
11404 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
11405 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
11406
11407 @item C-c C-n o
11408 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
11409 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
11410 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
11411
11412 @item C-c C-n a
11413 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
11414 @findex gnus-mailing-list-archive
11415 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
11416
11417 @end table
11418
11419
11420 @node Article Buffer
11421 @chapter Article Buffer
11422 @cindex article buffer
11423
11424 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
11425 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
11426 tell Gnus otherwise.
11427
11428 @menu
11429 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
11430 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
11431 * HTML:: Reading @acronym{HTML} messages.
11432 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
11433 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
11434 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
11435 @end menu
11436
11437
11438 @node Hiding Headers
11439 @section Hiding Headers
11440 @cindex hiding headers
11441 @cindex deleting headers
11442
11443 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
11444 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
11445
11446 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
11447 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
11448 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
11449 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
11450 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
11451 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
11452 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
11453 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
11454 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
11455
11456 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
11457
11458 @table @code
11459
11460 @item gnus-visible-headers
11461 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
11462 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
11463 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
11464 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
11465
11466 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
11467 the article and the subject, you'd say:
11468
11469 @lisp
11470 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
11471 @end lisp
11472
11473 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11474 remain visible.
11475
11476 @item gnus-ignored-headers
11477 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
11478 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
11479 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
11480 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
11481 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
11482
11483 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
11484 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
11485
11486 @lisp
11487 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
11488 @end lisp
11489
11490 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
11491 be removed.
11492
11493 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
11494 variable will have no effect.
11495
11496 @end table
11497
11498 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
11499 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
11500 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
11501 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
11502 the headers are to be displayed.
11503
11504 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
11505 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11506
11507 @lisp
11508 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11509 @end lisp
11510
11511 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11512 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11513
11514 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11515 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11516 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11517 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11518 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11519 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11520 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11521 from sight.
11522
11523 These conditions are:
11524 @table @code
11525 @item empty
11526 Remove all empty headers.
11527 @item followup-to
11528 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11529 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11530 @item reply-to
11531 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11532 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11533 parameter is set.
11534 @item newsgroups
11535 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11536 name.
11537 @item to-address
11538 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11539 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11540 @item to-list
11541 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11542 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11543 @item cc-list
11544 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11545 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11546 @item date
11547 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11548 old.
11549 @item long-to
11550 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11551 @item many-to
11552 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11553 @end table
11554
11555 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11556
11557 @lisp
11558 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11559 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11560 @end lisp
11561
11562 This is also the default value for this variable.
11563
11564
11565 @node Using MIME
11566 @section Using MIME
11567 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11568
11569 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11570 while people stand around yawning.
11571
11572 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11573 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11574
11575 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11576 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11577 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11578
11579 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11580 @findex gnus-display-mime
11581 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11582 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11583 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11584 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11585
11586 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11587 @acronym{MIME} button:
11588
11589 @table @kbd
11590 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11591 @item RET (Article)
11592 @kindex RET (Article)
11593 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11594 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11595 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11596 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11597 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11598 object is displayed inline.
11599
11600 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11601 @item M-RET (Article)
11602 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11603 @itemx v (Article)
11604 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11605 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11606
11607 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11608 @item t (Article)
11609 @kindex t (Article)
11610 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11611 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11612
11613 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11614 @item C (Article)
11615 @kindex C (Article)
11616 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11617 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11618
11619 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11620 @item o (Article)
11621 @kindex o (Article)
11622 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11623 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11624
11625 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11626 @item C-o (Article)
11627 @kindex C-o (Article)
11628 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11629 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11630 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11631 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11632 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11633 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11634
11635 @findex gnus-mime-replace-part
11636 @item r (Article)
11637 @kindex r (Article)
11638 Prompt for a file name, replace the @acronym{MIME} object with an
11639 external body referring to the file via the message/external-body
11640 @acronym{MIME} type. (@code{gnus-mime-replace-part}).
11641
11642 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11643 @item d (Article)
11644 @kindex d (Article)
11645 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11646 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11647 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11648
11649 @c FIXME: gnus-auto-select-part should be documented here
11650
11651 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11652 @item c (Article)
11653 @kindex c (Article)
11654 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11655 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). If given a prefix, copy the raw contents
11656 without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual
11657 charset stuff (see @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in
11658 @ref{Paging the Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11659 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11660 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11661 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11662
11663 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11664 @item p (Article)
11665 @kindex p (Article)
11666 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11667 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11668 @file{.mailcap} file.
11669
11670 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11671 @item i (Article)
11672 @kindex i (Article)
11673 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11674 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11675 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11676 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11677 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11678 Article}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and @file{.bz2} are
11679 automatically decompressed depending on @code{jka-compr} regardless of
11680 @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed Files,, Accessing
11681 Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11682
11683 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11684 @item E (Article)
11685 @kindex E (Article)
11686 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11687 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11688 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11689
11690 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11691 @item e (Article)
11692 @kindex e (Article)
11693 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11694 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11695
11696 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11697 @item | (Article)
11698 @kindex | (Article)
11699 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11700
11701 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11702 @item . (Article)
11703 @kindex . (Article)
11704 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11705 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11706
11707 @end table
11708
11709 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11710 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11711 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11712
11713 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11714 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11715 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11716 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11717 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11718 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11719 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11720 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11721 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11722
11723 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11724
11725 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11726
11727
11728 @node HTML
11729 @section @acronym{HTML}
11730 @cindex @acronym{HTML}
11731
11732 If you have @code{w3m} installed on your system, Gnus can display
11733 @acronym{HTML} articles in the article buffer. There are many Gnus
11734 add-ons for doing this, using various approaches, but there's one
11735 (sort of) built-in method that's used by default.
11736
11737 For a complete overview, consult @xref{Display Customization,
11738 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. This
11739 section only describes the default method.
11740
11741 @table @code
11742 @item mm-text-html-renderer
11743 @vindex mm-text-html-renderer
11744 If set to @code{gnus-article-html}, Gnus will use the built-in method,
11745 that's based on @code{w3m}.
11746
11747 @item gnus-blocked-images
11748 @vindex gnus-blocked-images
11749 External images that have @acronym{URL}s that match this regexp won't
11750 be fetched and displayed. For instance, do block all @acronym{URL}s
11751 that have the string ``ads'' in them, do the following:
11752
11753 @lisp
11754 (setq gnus-blocked-images "ads")
11755 @end lisp
11756
11757 This can also be a function to be evaluated. If so, it will be
11758 called with the group name as the parameter. The default value is
11759 @code{gnus-block-private-groups}, which will return @samp{"."} for
11760 anything that isn't a newsgroup. This means that no external images
11761 will be fetched as a result of reading mail, so that nobody can use
11762 web bugs (and the like) to track whether you've read email.
11763
11764 Also @pxref{Misc Article} for @code{gnus-inhibit-images}.
11765
11766 @item gnus-html-cache-directory
11767 @vindex gnus-html-cache-directory
11768 Gnus will download and cache images according to how
11769 @code{gnus-blocked-images} is set. These images will be stored in
11770 this directory.
11771
11772 @item gnus-html-cache-size
11773 @vindex gnus-html-cache-size
11774 When @code{gnus-html-cache-size} bytes have been used in that
11775 directory, the oldest files will be deleted. The default is 500MB.
11776
11777 @item gnus-html-frame-width
11778 @vindex gnus-html-frame-width
11779 The width to use when rendering HTML@. The default is 70.
11780
11781 @item gnus-max-image-proportion
11782 @vindex gnus-max-image-proportion
11783 How big pictures displayed are in relation to the window they're in.
11784 A value of 0.7 (the default) means that they are allowed to take up
11785 70% of the width and height of the window. If they are larger than
11786 this, and Emacs supports it, then the images will be rescaled down to
11787 fit these criteria.
11788
11789 @end table
11790
11791 To use this, make sure that you have @code{w3m} and @code{curl}
11792 installed. If you have, then Gnus should display @acronym{HTML}
11793 automatically.
11794
11795
11796
11797 @node Customizing Articles
11798 @section Customizing Articles
11799 @cindex article customization
11800
11801 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11802 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11803 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11804 called automatically when you select the articles.
11805
11806 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11807 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11808 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11809 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11810
11811 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11812 for sensible values.
11813
11814 @enumerate
11815 @item
11816 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11817
11818 @item
11819 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11820
11821 @item
11822 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11823
11824 @item
11825 @code{first}: Do this treatment on the first body part.
11826
11827 @item
11828 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last body part.
11829
11830 @item
11831 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11832 than this number.
11833
11834 @item
11835 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11836 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11837 regexps in the list.
11838
11839 @item
11840 A list where the first element is not a string:
11841
11842 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11843 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11844 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11845
11846 @lisp
11847 (or last
11848 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11849 @end lisp
11850
11851 @end enumerate
11852
11853 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11854 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11855 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11856 considered to contain just a single part.
11857
11858 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11859 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11860 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11861 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11862 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11863 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11864 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11865
11866 @ifinfo
11867 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11868 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11869 @c `i foo-bar'.
11870 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11871 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11872 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11873 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11874 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11875 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11876 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11877 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11878 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11879 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11880 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11881 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11882 @vindex gnus-treat-date
11883 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11884 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11885 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11886 @vindex gnus-treat-from-gravatar
11887 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-gravatar
11888 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11889 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11890 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11891 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11892 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11893 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11894 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11895 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11896 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11897 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11898 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11899 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11900 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11901 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11902 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11903 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11904 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11905 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11906 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11907 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11908 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11909 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11910 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11911 @end ifinfo
11912
11913 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11914 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11915 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11916 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11917
11918 @table @code
11919 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11920 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11921
11922 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11923
11924 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11925 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11926 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11927 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11928 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, first, integer)
11929 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11930 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11931 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11932 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11933 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11934
11935 @xref{Article Washing}.
11936
11937 @item gnus-treat-date (head)
11938
11939 This will transform/add date headers according to the
11940 @code{gnus-article-date-headers} variable. This is a list of Date
11941 headers to display. The formats available are:
11942
11943 @table @code
11944 @item ut
11945 Universal time, aka GMT, aka ZULU.
11946
11947 @item local
11948 The user's local time zone.
11949
11950 @item english
11951 A semi-readable English sentence.
11952
11953 @item lapsed
11954 The time elapsed since the message was posted.
11955
11956 @item combined-lapsed
11957 Both the original date header and a (shortened) elapsed time.
11958
11959 @item original
11960 The original date header.
11961
11962 @item iso8601
11963 ISO8601 format, i.e., ``2010-11-23T22:05:21''.
11964
11965 @item user-defined
11966 A format done according to the @code{gnus-article-time-format}
11967 variable.
11968
11969 @end table
11970
11971 @xref{Article Date}.
11972
11973 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11974 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11975 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11976
11977 @xref{Picons}.
11978
11979 @item gnus-treat-from-gravatar (head)
11980 @item gnus-treat-mail-gravatar (head)
11981
11982 @xref{Gravatars}.
11983
11984 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11985
11986 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11987
11988 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11989 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11990 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11991
11992 @xref{Smileys}.
11993
11994 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11995 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11996
11997 @xref{X-Face}.
11998
11999 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
12000 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
12001
12002 @xref{Face}.
12003
12004 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
12005 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
12006 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
12007 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
12008 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
12009 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
12010 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
12011 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
12012 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
12013 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
12014 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
12015 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
12016 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
12017 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
12018 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
12019 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
12020 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
12021 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
12022 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
12023 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
12024
12025 @xref{Article Hiding}.
12026
12027 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
12028 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
12029 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
12030 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
12031 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
12032 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
12033
12034 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
12035
12036 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
12037 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
12038 @item gnus-treat-ansi-sequences (t)
12039 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
12040 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
12041
12042 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
12043 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
12044 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
12045 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
12046 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
12047 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
12048 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
12049 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
12050
12051 @xref{Article Header}.
12052
12053
12054 @end table
12055
12056 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
12057 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
12058 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
12059 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
12060 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
12061 everything.
12062
12063
12064 @node Article Keymap
12065 @section Article Keymap
12066
12067 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
12068 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
12069 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
12070 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
12071 buffer.
12072
12073 @kindex v (Article)
12074 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
12075 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12076 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12077
12078 A few additional keystrokes are available:
12079
12080 @table @kbd
12081
12082 @item SPACE
12083 @kindex SPACE (Article)
12084 @findex gnus-article-next-page
12085 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
12086 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
12087
12088 @item DEL
12089 @kindex DEL (Article)
12090 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
12091 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
12092 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
12093
12094 @item C-c ^
12095 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
12096 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
12097 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
12098 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
12099 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
12100
12101 @item C-c C-m
12102 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
12103 @findex gnus-article-mail
12104 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
12105 given a prefix, include the mail.
12106
12107 @item s
12108 @kindex s (Article)
12109 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
12110 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
12111 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
12112
12113 @item ?
12114 @kindex ? (Article)
12115 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
12116 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
12117 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
12118
12119 @item TAB
12120 @kindex TAB (Article)
12121 @findex gnus-article-next-button
12122 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
12123 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
12124
12125 @item M-TAB
12126 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
12127 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
12128 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
12129
12130 @item R
12131 @kindex R (Article)
12132 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
12133 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
12134 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If the region is active,
12135 only yank the text in the region.
12136
12137 @item S W
12138 @kindex S W (Article)
12139 @findex gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original
12140 Send a wide reply to the current article and yank the current article
12141 (@code{gnus-article-wide-reply-with-original}). If the region is
12142 active, only yank the text in the region.
12143
12144 @item F
12145 @kindex F (Article)
12146 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
12147 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
12148 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If the region is active,
12149 only yank the text in the region.
12150
12151
12152 @end table
12153
12154
12155 @node Misc Article
12156 @section Misc Article
12157
12158 @table @code
12159
12160 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
12161 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
12162 @cindex article buffers, several
12163 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
12164 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
12165 article buffer.
12166
12167 @item gnus-widen-article-window
12168 @cindex gnus-widen-article-window
12169 If non-@code{nil}, selecting the article buffer with the @kbd{h}
12170 command will ``widen'' the article window to take the entire frame.
12171
12172 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
12173 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
12174 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
12175 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
12176 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
12177
12178 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
12179 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
12180 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
12181 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
12182 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
12183 the contents of the article buffer.
12184
12185 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
12186 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
12187 Hook called in article mode buffers.
12188
12189 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12190 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
12191 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
12192 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
12193
12194 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
12195 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
12196 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
12197 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
12198
12199 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
12200 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
12201 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
12202 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
12203 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
12204 with two extensions:
12205
12206 @table @samp
12207
12208 @item w
12209 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
12210 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
12211 performed. The characters and their meaning:
12212
12213 @table @samp
12214
12215 @item c
12216 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
12217
12218 @item h
12219 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
12220
12221 @item p
12222 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
12223 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
12224 security status, i.e., good or bad signature.)
12225
12226 @item s
12227 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
12228
12229 @item o
12230 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
12231
12232 @item e
12233 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasized strings in the article buffer.
12234
12235 @end table
12236
12237 @item m
12238 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
12239
12240 @end table
12241
12242 @vindex gnus-break-pages
12243
12244 @item gnus-break-pages
12245 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
12246 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
12247 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
12248 paging will not be done.
12249
12250 @item gnus-page-delimiter
12251 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
12252 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
12253 (formfeed).
12254
12255 @cindex IDNA
12256 @cindex internationalized domain names
12257 @vindex gnus-use-idna
12258 @item gnus-use-idna
12259 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
12260 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
12261 @samp{Cc} headers. @xref{IDNA, ,IDNA,message, The Message Manual},
12262 for how to compose such messages. This requires
12263 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
12264 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
12265
12266 @vindex gnus-inhibit-images
12267 @item gnus-inhibit-images
12268 If this is non-@code{nil}, inhibit displaying of images inline in the
12269 article body. It is effective to images that are in articles as
12270 @acronym{MIME} parts, and images in @acronym{HTML} articles rendered
12271 when @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization,
12272 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) is
12273 @code{shr} or @code{gnus-w3m}.
12274
12275 @end table
12276
12277
12278 @node Composing Messages
12279 @chapter Composing Messages
12280 @cindex composing messages
12281 @cindex messages
12282 @cindex mail
12283 @cindex sending mail
12284 @cindex reply
12285 @cindex followup
12286 @cindex post
12287 @cindex using gpg
12288 @cindex using s/mime
12289 @cindex using smime
12290
12291 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
12292 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
12293 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
12294 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
12295 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
12296 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
12297
12298 @menu
12299 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
12300 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
12301 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
12302 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
12303 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
12304 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
12305 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
12306 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
12307 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
12308 @end menu
12309
12310 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
12311 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
12312
12313
12314 @node Mail
12315 @section Mail
12316
12317 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
12318
12319 @table @code
12320 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
12321 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
12322 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
12323 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
12324 @code{nil} include all headers.
12325
12326 @item gnus-add-to-list
12327 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
12328 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
12329 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
12330
12331 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12332 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
12333 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
12334 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
12335 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
12336 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
12337 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
12338 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
12339
12340 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
12341 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
12342
12343 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12344 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
12345 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
12346 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
12347 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
12348
12349 @end table
12350
12351
12352 @node Posting Server
12353 @section Posting Server
12354
12355 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
12356 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
12357
12358 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
12359
12360 It can be quite complicated.
12361
12362 @vindex gnus-post-method
12363 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
12364 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
12365 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
12366 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
12367 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
12368 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
12369 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
12370 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
12371 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
12372
12373 @lisp
12374 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
12375 @end lisp
12376
12377 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
12378 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
12379 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
12380 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
12381
12382 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
12383 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
12384
12385 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
12386 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
12387 for posting.
12388
12389 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
12390 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
12391
12392 @vindex message-send-mail-function
12393 When sending mail, Message invokes the function specified by the
12394 variable @code{message-send-mail-function}. Gnus tries to set it to a
12395 value suitable for your system.
12396 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Mail Variables,message,Message manual}, for more
12397 information.
12398
12399
12400 @node POP before SMTP
12401 @section POP before SMTP
12402 @cindex pop before smtp
12403 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
12404
12405 Does your @acronym{ISP} use @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
12406 authentication? This authentication method simply requires you to
12407 contact the @acronym{POP} server before sending email. To do that,
12408 put the following lines in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
12409
12410 @lisp
12411 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
12412 @end lisp
12413
12414 @noindent
12415 The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function does @acronym{POP}
12416 authentication according to the value of @code{mail-sources} without
12417 fetching mails, just before sending a mail. @xref{Mail Sources}.
12418
12419 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
12420 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
12421 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
12422 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
12423 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
12424 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
12425
12426 @lisp
12427 (setq mail-source-primary-source
12428 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12429 :password "secret"))
12430 @end lisp
12431
12432 @noindent
12433 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
12434 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
12435
12436 @lisp
12437 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
12438 (lambda ()
12439 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
12440 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
12441 :password "secret")))
12442 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
12443 @end lisp
12444
12445
12446 @node Mail and Post
12447 @section Mail and Post
12448
12449 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
12450 posting:
12451
12452 @table @code
12453 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
12454 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
12455 @cindex mailing lists
12456
12457 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
12458 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
12459 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
12460 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
12461 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
12462 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
12463 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
12464 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
12465 still a pain, though.
12466
12467 @item gnus-user-agent
12468 @vindex gnus-user-agent
12469 @cindex User-Agent
12470
12471 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
12472 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
12473 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
12474 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
12475 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
12476 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
12477 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
12478
12479 @end table
12480
12481 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
12482 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
12483 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
12484
12485 @cindex ispell
12486 @findex ispell-message
12487 @lisp
12488 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
12489 @end lisp
12490
12491 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
12492 you're in, you could say something like the following:
12493
12494 @lisp
12495 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
12496 (lambda ()
12497 (cond
12498 ((string-match
12499 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
12500 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
12501 (t
12502 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
12503 @end lisp
12504
12505 Modify to suit your needs.
12506
12507 @vindex gnus-message-highlight-citation
12508 If @code{gnus-message-highlight-citation} is t, different levels of
12509 citations are highlighted like in Gnus article buffers also in message
12510 mode buffers.
12511
12512 @node Archived Messages
12513 @section Archived Messages
12514 @cindex archived messages
12515 @cindex sent messages
12516
12517 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
12518 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
12519 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
12520 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}. The
12521 default is "sent.%Y-%m", which gives you one archive group per month.
12522
12523 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
12524 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
12525 Group Commands}).
12526
12527 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
12528 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
12529 use to store sent messages. The default is @code{"archive"}, and when
12530 actually being used it is expanded into:
12531
12532 @lisp
12533 (nnfolder "archive"
12534 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
12535 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
12536 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
12537 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
12538 @end lisp
12539
12540 @quotation
12541 @vindex gnus-update-message-archive-method
12542 Note: a server like this is saved in the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file first
12543 so that it may be used as a real method of the server which is named
12544 @code{"archive"} (that is, for the case where
12545 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} is set to @code{"archive"}) ever
12546 since. If it once has been saved, it will never be updated by default
12547 even if you change the value of @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12548 afterward. Therefore, the server @code{"archive"} doesn't necessarily
12549 mean the @code{nnfolder} server like this at all times. If you want the
12550 saved method to reflect always the value of
12551 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, set the
12552 @code{gnus-update-message-archive-method} variable to a non-@code{nil}
12553 value. The default value of this variable is @code{nil}.
12554 @end quotation
12555
12556 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
12557 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
12558 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
12559 directory chosen, you could say something like:
12560
12561 @lisp
12562 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
12563 '(nnfolder "archive"
12564 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
12565 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
12566 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
12567 @end lisp
12568
12569 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
12570 @cindex Gcc
12571 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
12572 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
12573 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
12574
12575 This variable can be used to do the following:
12576
12577 @table @asis
12578 @item a string
12579 Messages will be saved in that group.
12580
12581 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
12582 message will not be stored in the select method given by
12583 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
12584 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
12585 has the default value shown above. Then setting
12586 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
12587 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
12588 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
12589 @samp{nnml:foo}.
12590
12591 @item a list of strings
12592 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
12593
12594 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
12595 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
12596
12597 @item @code{nil}
12598 No message archiving will take place.
12599 @end table
12600
12601 Let's illustrate:
12602
12603 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
12604 @lisp
12605 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
12606 @end lisp
12607
12608 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
12609 @lisp
12610 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
12611 @end lisp
12612
12613 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
12614 @lisp
12615 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12616 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
12617 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
12618 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
12619 @end lisp
12620
12621 More complex stuff:
12622 @lisp
12623 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12624 '((if (message-news-p)
12625 "misc-news"
12626 "misc-mail")))
12627 @end lisp
12628
12629 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
12630 messages in one file per month:
12631
12632 @lisp
12633 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
12634 '((if (message-news-p)
12635 "misc-news"
12636 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12637 @end lisp
12638
12639 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12640 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12641 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12642 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12643 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12644 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12645 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12646 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12647 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12648 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12649
12650 @table @code
12651 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12652 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12653 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12654
12655 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12656 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12657 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12658 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12659 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12660 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12661 changed in the future.
12662
12663 @item gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12664 @vindex gnus-gcc-self-resent-messages
12665 Like the @code{gcc-self} group parameter, applied only for unmodified
12666 messages that @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} (@pxref{Summary Mail
12667 Commands}) resends. Non-@code{nil} value of this variable takes
12668 precedence over any existing @code{Gcc} header.
12669
12670 If this is @code{none}, no @code{Gcc} copy will be made. If this is
12671 @code{t}, messages resent will be @code{Gcc} copied to the current
12672 group. If this is a string, it specifies a group to which resent
12673 messages will be @code{Gcc} copied. If this is @code{nil}, @code{Gcc}
12674 will be done according to existing @code{Gcc} header(s), if any. If
12675 this is @code{no-gcc-self}, that is the default, resent messages will be
12676 @code{Gcc} copied to groups that existing @code{Gcc} header specifies,
12677 except for the current group.
12678
12679 @item gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12680 @vindex gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook
12681 @itemx gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12682 @vindex gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook
12683
12684 These hooks are run before/after encoding the message body of the Gcc
12685 copy of a sent message. The current buffer (when the hook is run)
12686 contains the message including the message header. Changes made to
12687 the message will only affect the Gcc copy, but not the original
12688 message. You can use these hooks to edit the copy (and influence
12689 subsequent transformations), e.g., remove MML secure tags
12690 (@pxref{Signing and encrypting}).
12691
12692 @end table
12693
12694
12695 @node Posting Styles
12696 @section Posting Styles
12697 @cindex posting styles
12698 @cindex styles
12699
12700 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12701
12702 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12703 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12704 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12705 on?
12706
12707 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12708 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12709 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12710 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12711 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12712 variable:
12713
12714 @lisp
12715 ((".*"
12716 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12717 (organization "What me?"))
12718 ("^comp"
12719 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12720 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12721 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12722 @end lisp
12723
12724 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12725 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12726 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12727 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12728 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12729 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12730 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12731 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12732
12733 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12734 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12735 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12736 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12737 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12738 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12739 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12740 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12741 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12742 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12743 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12744 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12745 said to @dfn{match}.
12746
12747 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12748 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12749 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12750 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12751 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12752 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12753 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12754 name can be one of:
12755
12756 @itemize @bullet
12757 @item @code{signature}
12758 @item @code{signature-file}
12759 @item @code{x-face-file}
12760 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12761 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12762 @item @code{body}
12763 @end itemize
12764
12765 Note that the @code{signature-file} attribute honors the variable
12766 @code{message-signature-directory}.
12767
12768 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12769 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12770 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12771 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12772 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12773
12774 The attribute value can be a string, a function with zero arguments
12775 (the return value will be used), a variable (its value will be used)
12776 or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value will be
12777 used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12778 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current
12779 article are available through the @code{message-reply-headers}
12780 variable, which is a vector of the following headers: number subject
12781 from date id references chars lines xref extra.
12782
12783 In the case of a string value, if the @code{match} is a regular
12784 expression, a @samp{gnus-match-substitute-replacement} is proceed on
12785 the value to replace the positional parameters @samp{\@var{n}} by the
12786 corresponding parenthetical matches (see @xref{Replacing Match,,
12787 Replacing the Text that Matched, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}.)
12788
12789 @vindex message-reply-headers
12790
12791 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12792 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12793 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12794
12795 @findex message-mail-p
12796 @findex message-news-p
12797
12798 So here's a new example:
12799
12800 @lisp
12801 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12802 '((".*"
12803 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12804 (name "User Name")
12805 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12806 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12807 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12808 ("^rec.humor"
12809 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12810 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12811 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12812 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12813 (signature my-news-signature))
12814 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12815 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12816 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12817 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12818 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12819 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12820 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12821 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12822 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12823 ("X-Message-SMTP-Method" "smtp smtp.example.org 587")
12824 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12825 ("nnml:.*"
12826 (From (with-current-buffer gnus-article-buffer
12827 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12828 ("^nn.+:"
12829 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12830 @end lisp
12831
12832 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12833 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12834 if you fill many roles.
12835 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12836 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12837
12838 Of particular interest in the ``work-mail'' style is the
12839 @samp{X-Message-SMTP-Method} header. It specifies how to send the
12840 outgoing email. You may want to sent certain emails through certain
12841 @acronym{SMTP} servers due to company policies, for instance.
12842 @xref{Mail Variables, ,Message Variables, message, Message Manual}.
12843
12844
12845 @node Drafts
12846 @section Drafts
12847 @cindex drafts
12848
12849 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12850 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12851 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12852 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12853 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12854
12855 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12856 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12857 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12858 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12859 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12860 group.)
12861
12862 @cindex nndraft
12863 @vindex nndraft-directory
12864 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12865 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12866 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12867 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12868 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12869 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12870
12871 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12872 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12873 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12874 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12875 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12876 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12877 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12878 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12879 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12880
12881 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12882 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12883 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12884 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12885 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12886 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12887 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12888 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12889 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12890 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12891 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12892 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12893 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12894 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12895 @c
12896 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12897 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12898 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12899
12900 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12901 @kindex D e (Draft)
12902 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12903 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12904 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12905
12906 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12907 Articles}).
12908
12909 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12910 @kindex D s (Draft)
12911 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12912 @kindex D S (Draft)
12913 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12914 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12915 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12916 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12917 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12918 in the buffer.
12919
12920 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12921 @kindex D t (Draft)
12922 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12923 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12924 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12925
12926 Finally, if you want to delete a draft, use the normal @kbd{B DEL}
12927 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
12928
12929
12930 @node Rejected Articles
12931 @section Rejected Articles
12932 @cindex rejected articles
12933
12934 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12935 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12936 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12937 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12938
12939 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12940 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12941 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12942 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12943 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12944
12945 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12946 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12947 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12948
12949 @node Signing and encrypting
12950 @section Signing and encrypting
12951 @cindex using gpg
12952 @cindex using s/mime
12953 @cindex using smime
12954
12955 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12956 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12957 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12958 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12959
12960 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12961 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12962 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12963 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12964 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12965 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12966 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12967 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12968 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12969 automatically encrypted messages.
12970
12971 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12972 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12973 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12974
12975 @table @kbd
12976
12977 @item C-c C-m s s
12978 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12979 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12980
12981 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12982
12983 @item C-c C-m s o
12984 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12985 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12986
12987 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12988
12989 @item C-c C-m s p
12990 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12991 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12992
12993 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12994
12995 @item C-c C-m c s
12996 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12997 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12998
12999 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
13000
13001 @item C-c C-m c o
13002 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
13003 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
13004
13005 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
13006
13007 @item C-c C-m c p
13008 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
13009 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
13010
13011 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
13012
13013 @item C-c C-m C-n
13014 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
13015 @findex mml-unsecure-message
13016 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
13017
13018 @end table
13019
13020 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
13021
13022 @node Select Methods
13023 @chapter Select Methods
13024 @cindex foreign groups
13025 @cindex select methods
13026
13027 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
13028 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
13029 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
13030 personal mail group.
13031
13032 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
13033 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
13034 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g., @code{nntp},
13035 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
13036 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
13037 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
13038
13039 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
13040 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
13041
13042 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
13043 group as.
13044
13045 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
13046 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
13047 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
13048 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
13049 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
13050
13051 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
13052
13053 @menu
13054 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
13055 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
13056 * Using IMAP:: Reading mail from @acronym{IMAP}.
13057 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
13058 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
13059 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files.
13060 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
13061 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
13062 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
13063 @end menu
13064
13065
13066 @node Server Buffer
13067 @section Server Buffer
13068
13069 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
13070 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
13071 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
13072 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
13073 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
13074 back end represents a virtual server.
13075
13076 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
13077 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
13078 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
13079 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
13080
13081 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
13082 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
13083 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
13084 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
13085 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
13086 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
13087 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
13088
13089 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
13090 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
13091
13092 @menu
13093 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
13094 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
13095 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
13096 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
13097 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
13098 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
13099 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
13100 @end menu
13101
13102 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
13103 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
13104
13105
13106 @node Server Buffer Format
13107 @subsection Server Buffer Format
13108 @cindex server buffer format
13109
13110 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
13111 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
13112 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
13113 variable, with some simple extensions:
13114
13115 @table @samp
13116
13117 @item h
13118 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
13119
13120 @item n
13121 The name of this server.
13122
13123 @item w
13124 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
13125
13126 @item s
13127 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
13128
13129 @item a
13130 Whether this server is agentized.
13131 @end table
13132
13133 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
13134 The mode line can also be customized by using the
13135 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
13136 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
13137
13138 @table @samp
13139 @item S
13140 Server name.
13141
13142 @item M
13143 Server method.
13144 @end table
13145
13146 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
13147
13148
13149 @node Server Commands
13150 @subsection Server Commands
13151 @cindex server commands
13152
13153 @table @kbd
13154
13155 @item v
13156 @kindex v (Server)
13157 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
13158 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
13159 command or better use it as a prefix key.
13160
13161 @item a
13162 @kindex a (Server)
13163 @findex gnus-server-add-server
13164 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
13165
13166 @item e
13167 @kindex e (Server)
13168 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
13169 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
13170
13171 @item S
13172 @kindex S (Server)
13173 @findex gnus-server-show-server
13174 Show the definition of a server (@code{gnus-server-show-server}).
13175
13176 @item SPACE
13177 @kindex SPACE (Server)
13178 @findex gnus-server-read-server
13179 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
13180
13181 @item q
13182 @kindex q (Server)
13183 @findex gnus-server-exit
13184 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
13185
13186 @item k
13187 @kindex k (Server)
13188 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
13189 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
13190
13191 @item y
13192 @kindex y (Server)
13193 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
13194 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
13195
13196 @item c
13197 @kindex c (Server)
13198 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13199 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
13200
13201 @item l
13202 @kindex l (Server)
13203 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
13204 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
13205
13206 @item s
13207 @kindex s (Server)
13208 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
13209 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
13210 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
13211 servers.
13212
13213 @item g
13214 @kindex g (Server)
13215 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
13216 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
13217 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
13218 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
13219
13220 @item z
13221 @kindex z (Server)
13222 @findex gnus-server-compact-server
13223
13224 Compact all groups in the server under point
13225 (@code{gnus-server-compact-server}). Currently implemented only in
13226 nnml (@pxref{Mail Spool}). This removes gaps between article numbers,
13227 hence getting a correct total article count.
13228
13229 @end table
13230
13231 Some more commands for closing, disabling, and re-opening servers are
13232 listed in @ref{Unavailable Servers}.
13233
13234
13235 @node Example Methods
13236 @subsection Example Methods
13237
13238 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
13239
13240 @lisp
13241 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
13242 @end lisp
13243
13244 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
13245
13246 @lisp
13247 (nnspool "")
13248 @end lisp
13249
13250 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
13251 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
13252 will.
13253
13254 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
13255 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
13256
13257 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
13258 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
13259 look like then:
13260
13261 @lisp
13262 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
13263 @end lisp
13264
13265 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
13266 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
13267
13268 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
13269 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
13270 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
13271 your private mail:
13272
13273 @lisp
13274 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
13275 @end lisp
13276
13277 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
13278 that.)
13279
13280 Here's the method for a public spool:
13281
13282 @lisp
13283 (nnmh "public"
13284 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
13285 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
13286 @end lisp
13287
13288 @cindex proxy
13289 @cindex firewall
13290
13291 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
13292 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
13293 on the firewall machine and connect with
13294 @uref{http://netcat.sourceforge.net/, netcat} from there to the
13295 @acronym{NNTP} server.
13296 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
13297 should probably look something like this:
13298
13299 @lisp
13300 (nntp "firewall"
13301 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)
13302 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
13303 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host"))
13304 @end lisp
13305
13306 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
13307 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
13308 configuration to the example above:
13309
13310 @lisp
13311 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13312 @end lisp
13313
13314 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}. Here's an example for
13315 an indirect connection:
13316
13317 @lisp
13318 (setq gnus-select-method
13319 '(nntp "indirect"
13320 (nntp-address "news.server.example")
13321 (nntp-via-user-name "intermediate_user_name")
13322 (nntp-via-address "intermediate.host.example")
13323 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
13324 (nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches ("-C"))
13325 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat)))
13326 @end lisp
13327
13328 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
13329 provide automatic authorization, of course.
13330
13331 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
13332 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
13333 netcat connection to the news server as follows:
13334
13335 @lisp
13336 (nntp "outside"
13337 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13338 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13339 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13340 @end lisp
13341
13342
13343 @node Creating a Virtual Server
13344 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
13345
13346 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
13347 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
13348
13349 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
13350 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
13351 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
13352
13353 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
13354
13355 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
13356 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
13357 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
13358 will contain the following:
13359
13360 @lisp
13361 (nnml "cache")
13362 @end lisp
13363
13364 Change that to:
13365
13366 @lisp
13367 (nnml "cache"
13368 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
13369 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
13370 @end lisp
13371
13372 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
13373 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
13374 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
13375
13376
13377 @node Server Variables
13378 @subsection Server Variables
13379 @cindex server variables
13380 @cindex server parameters
13381
13382 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
13383 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
13384 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
13385 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
13386 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
13387
13388 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
13389 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
13390 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
13391 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
13392 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
13393 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
13394 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
13395 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
13396 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
13397
13398 @lisp
13399 (nnml "public"
13400 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
13401 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
13402 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
13403 @end lisp
13404
13405 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
13406
13407 @node Servers and Methods
13408 @subsection Servers and Methods
13409
13410 Wherever you would normally use a select method
13411 (e.g., @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
13412 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
13413 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
13414 over.
13415
13416
13417 @node Unavailable Servers
13418 @subsection Unavailable Servers
13419
13420 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
13421 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
13422 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
13423 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
13424 actually the case or not.
13425
13426 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
13427 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
13428 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
13429 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
13430 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
13431 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
13432 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
13433 it will regard that server as ``down''.
13434
13435 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
13436 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
13437
13438 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
13439 with the following commands:
13440
13441 @table @kbd
13442
13443 @item O
13444 @kindex O (Server)
13445 @findex gnus-server-open-server
13446 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
13447 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
13448
13449 @item C
13450 @kindex C (Server)
13451 @findex gnus-server-close-server
13452 Close the connection (if any) to the server
13453 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
13454
13455 @item D
13456 @kindex D (Server)
13457 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
13458 Mark the current server as unreachable
13459 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
13460
13461 @item M-o
13462 @kindex M-o (Server)
13463 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
13464 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
13465 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
13466
13467 @item M-c
13468 @kindex M-c (Server)
13469 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
13470 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
13471 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
13472
13473 @item R
13474 @kindex R (Server)
13475 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
13476 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
13477 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
13478
13479 @item c
13480 @kindex c (Server)
13481 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
13482 Copy a server and give it a new name
13483 (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}). This can be useful if you have a
13484 complex method definition, and want to use the same definition towards
13485 a different (physical) server.
13486
13487 @item L
13488 @kindex L (Server)
13489 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
13490 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
13491
13492 @end table
13493
13494
13495 @node Getting News
13496 @section Getting News
13497 @cindex reading news
13498 @cindex news back ends
13499
13500 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
13501 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
13502 or it can read from a local spool.
13503
13504 @menu
13505 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13506 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
13507 @end menu
13508
13509
13510 @node NNTP
13511 @subsection NNTP
13512 @cindex nntp
13513
13514 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
13515 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
13516 server as the, uhm, address.
13517
13518 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
13519 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
13520 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
13521 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
13522
13523 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
13524 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
13525 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
13526
13527 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
13528 server:
13529
13530 @table @code
13531
13532 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
13533 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
13534 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
13535 @cindex authinfo
13536 @cindex authentication
13537 @cindex nntp authentication
13538 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13539 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
13540 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
13541 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
13542 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
13543 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
13544 present in this hook.
13545
13546 @item nntp-authinfo-function
13547 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
13548 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
13549 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
13550 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
13551 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
13552 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
13553 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
13554 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
13555 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
13556 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
13557 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
13558
13559 @enumerate
13560 @item
13561 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
13562
13563 @item
13564 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
13565
13566 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
13567 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
13568 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
13569 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
13570 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
13571 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
13572 @samp{force} is explained below.
13573
13574 @end enumerate
13575
13576 Here's an example file:
13577
13578 @example
13579 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
13580 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
13581 @end example
13582
13583 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
13584 have to be first, for instance.
13585
13586 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
13587 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
13588 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
13589 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
13590 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
13591 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
13592 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
13593
13594 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
13595 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
13596
13597 @example
13598 default force yes
13599 @end example
13600
13601 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
13602 previously mentioned.
13603
13604 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
13605
13606 @item nntp-server-action-alist
13607 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
13608 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
13609 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
13610 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
13611
13612 @lisp
13613 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
13614 '(("innd" (ding))))
13615 @end lisp
13616
13617 You probably don't want to do that, though.
13618
13619 The default value is
13620
13621 @lisp
13622 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
13623 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
13624 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
13625 @end lisp
13626
13627 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
13628 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
13629
13630 @item nntp-maximum-request
13631 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
13632 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
13633 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
13634 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
13635 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
13636 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
13637 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
13638
13639 @item nntp-connection-timeout
13640 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
13641 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
13642 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
13643 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
13644 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
13645 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
13646 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
13647 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
13648 no timeouts are done.
13649
13650 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
13651 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
13652 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
13653 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
13654 can be used.
13655
13656 @item nntp-xover-commands
13657 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
13658 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
13659 @cindex XOVER
13660 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
13661 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
13662 "XOVERVIEW")}.
13663
13664 @item nntp-nov-gap
13665 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
13666 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
13667 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
13668 if you have read articles 2--5000 in the group, and only want to read
13669 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
13670 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
13671 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
13672 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
13673 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
13674 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
13675 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
13676
13677 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13678 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
13679 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
13680 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
13681 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
13682 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
13683 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
13684 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
13685 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
13686 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
13687 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
13688 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
13689 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
13690 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
13691 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
13692 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
13693 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
13694
13695 @lisp
13696 (setq gnus-select-method
13697 '(nntp "newszilla"
13698 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13699 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13700 @dots{}))
13701 @end lisp
13702
13703 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13704
13705 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13706 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13707 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13708
13709 @item nntp-record-commands
13710 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13711 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13712 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13713 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13714 that doesn't seem to work.
13715
13716 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13717 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13718 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13719 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13720 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13721 Seven pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped
13722 in two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13723 indirect ones (three pre-made).
13724
13725 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13726 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13727 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13728 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13729 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13730 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13731 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13732 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13733 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13734
13735 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13736 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13737 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13738 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13739 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13740 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13741 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13742
13743 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13744 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13745 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13746 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13747 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13748 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13749 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13750
13751 @lisp
13752 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13753 @end lisp
13754
13755 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID@. This works for
13756 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13757
13758 @item nntp-server-list-active-group
13759 If @code{nil}, then always use @samp{GROUP} instead of @samp{LIST
13760 ACTIVE}. This is usually slower, but on misconfigured servers that
13761 don't update their active files often, this can help.
13762
13763
13764 @end table
13765
13766 @menu
13767 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13768 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13769 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13770 @end menu
13771
13772
13773 @node Direct Functions
13774 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13775 @cindex direct connection functions
13776
13777 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13778 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13779 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13780 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13781
13782 @table @code
13783 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13784 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13785 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13786 remote system. If both Emacs and the server supports it, the
13787 connection will be upgraded to an encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS}
13788 connection automatically.
13789
13790 @item network-only
13791 The same as the above, but don't do automatic @acronym{STARTTLS} upgrades.
13792
13793 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13794 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13795 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13796 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GnuTLS}
13797 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13798
13799 @lisp
13800 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13801 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13802 ;;
13803 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13804 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13805 (nntp-port-number 563)
13806 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13807 @end lisp
13808
13809 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13810 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13811 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13812 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL}
13813 @ignore
13814 @c Defunct URL, ancient package, so don't mention it.
13815 or @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay}
13816 @end ignore
13817 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13818
13819 @lisp
13820 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13821 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13822 ;;
13823 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13824 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13825 (nntp-port-number 563)
13826 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13827 @end lisp
13828
13829 @findex nntp-open-netcat-stream
13830 @item nntp-open-netcat-stream
13831 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server using the @code{netcat}
13832 program. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have
13833 the default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13834 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13835 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13836 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13837
13838 @lisp
13839 (nntp "socksified"
13840 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13841 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-netcat-stream)
13842 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13843 @end lisp
13844
13845 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13846 session, which is not a good idea.
13847
13848 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13849 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13850 Like @code{nntp-open-netcat-stream}, but uses @code{telnet} rather than
13851 @code{netcat}. @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things
13852 like line-end-conversion, but sometimes netcat is simply
13853 not available. The previous example would turn into:
13854
13855 @lisp
13856 (nntp "socksified"
13857 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13858 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13859 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
13860 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
13861 @end lisp
13862 @end table
13863
13864
13865 @node Indirect Functions
13866 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13867 @cindex indirect connection functions
13868
13869 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13870 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13871 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13872 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13873 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13874 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13875
13876 @table @code
13877 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13878 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat
13879 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then uses @code{netcat} to connect
13880 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13881 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13882
13883 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-netcat}-specific variables:
13884
13885 @table @code
13886 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13887 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13888 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13889 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13890
13891 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13892 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13893 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13894 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13895 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13896 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections.
13897 @end table
13898
13899 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13900 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13901 Does essentially the same, but uses @code{telnet} instead of @samp{netcat}
13902 to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the intermediate host.
13903 @code{telnet} is a bit less robust because of things like
13904 line-end-conversion, but sometimes @code{netcat} is simply not available.
13905
13906 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13907
13908 @table @code
13909 @item nntp-telnet-command
13910 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13911 Command used to connect to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from the
13912 intermediate host. The default is @samp{telnet}.
13913
13914 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13915 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13916 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13917 @code{nntp-telnet-command} command. The default is @code{("-8")}.
13918
13919 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13920 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13921 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13922 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13923
13924 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13925 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13926 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13927 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. If you use @samp{ssh}, you may need to set
13928 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13929 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13930 host. The default is @code{nil}.
13931 @end table
13932
13933 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13934 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13935
13936 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13937 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13938 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13939 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13940
13941 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13942
13943 @table @code
13944 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13945 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13946 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13947 @samp{telnet}.
13948
13949 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13950 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13951 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13952 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13953
13954 @item nntp-via-user-password
13955 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13956 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13957
13958 @item nntp-via-envuser
13959 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13960 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13961 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13962 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13963
13964 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13965 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13966 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13967 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13968
13969 @end table
13970
13971 Note that you may want to change the value for @code{nntp-end-of-line}
13972 to @samp{\n} (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13973 @end table
13974
13975
13976 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13977 functions:
13978
13979 @table @code
13980
13981 @item nntp-via-user-name
13982 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13983 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13984
13985 @item nntp-via-address
13986 @vindex nntp-via-address
13987 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13988
13989 @end table
13990
13991
13992 @node Common Variables
13993 @subsubsection Common Variables
13994
13995 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13996 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13997 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13998 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13999 variables individually).
14000
14001 @table @code
14002
14003 @item nntp-pre-command
14004 @vindex nntp-pre-command
14005 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
14006 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
14007 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
14008 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
14009
14010 @item nntp-address
14011 @vindex nntp-address
14012 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
14013
14014 @item nntp-port-number
14015 @vindex nntp-port-number
14016 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14017 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
14018 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
14019 than named ports (i.e., use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
14020 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
14021 not work with named ports.
14022
14023 @item nntp-end-of-line
14024 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
14025 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
14026 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
14027 using a non native telnet connection function.
14028
14029 @item nntp-netcat-command
14030 @vindex nntp-netcat-command
14031 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
14032 @samp{netcat}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
14033 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
14034 @samp{nc}.
14035
14036 @item nntp-netcat-switches
14037 @vindex nntp-netcat-switches
14038 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-netcat-command}. The default
14039 is @samp{()}.
14040
14041 @end table
14042
14043 @node News Spool
14044 @subsection News Spool
14045 @cindex nnspool
14046 @cindex news spool
14047
14048 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
14049 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
14050 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
14051 instance.
14052
14053 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
14054 anything else) as the address.
14055
14056 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
14057 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
14058 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
14059 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
14060
14061 @table @code
14062
14063 @item nnspool-inews-program
14064 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
14065 Program used to post an article.
14066
14067 @item nnspool-inews-switches
14068 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
14069 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
14070
14071 @item nnspool-spool-directory
14072 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
14073 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
14074 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
14075
14076 @item nnspool-nov-directory
14077 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
14078 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
14079 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
14080
14081 @item nnspool-lib-dir
14082 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
14083 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
14084
14085 @item nnspool-active-file
14086 @vindex nnspool-active-file
14087 The name of the active file.
14088
14089 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
14090 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
14091 The name of the group descriptions file.
14092
14093 @item nnspool-history-file
14094 @vindex nnspool-history-file
14095 The name of the news history file.
14096
14097 @item nnspool-active-times-file
14098 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
14099 The name of the active date file.
14100
14101 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
14102 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
14103 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
14104 that it finds.
14105
14106 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14107 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
14108 @cindex sed
14109 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
14110 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
14111 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
14112 there.
14113
14114 @end table
14115
14116
14117 @node Using IMAP
14118 @section Using IMAP
14119 @cindex imap
14120
14121 The most popular mail backend is probably @code{nnimap}, which
14122 provides access to @acronym{IMAP} servers. @acronym{IMAP} servers
14123 store mail remotely, so the client doesn't store anything locally.
14124 This means that it's a convenient choice when you're reading your mail
14125 from different locations, or with different user agents.
14126
14127 @menu
14128 * Connecting to an IMAP Server:: Getting started with @acronym{IMAP}.
14129 * Customizing the IMAP Connection:: Variables for @acronym{IMAP} connection.
14130 * Client-Side IMAP Splitting:: Put mail in the correct mail box.
14131 @end menu
14132
14133
14134 @node Connecting to an IMAP Server
14135 @subsection Connecting to an IMAP Server
14136
14137 Connecting to an @acronym{IMAP} can be very easy. Type @kbd{B} in the
14138 group buffer, or (if your primary interest is reading email), say
14139 something like:
14140
14141 @example
14142 (setq gnus-select-method
14143 '(nnimap "imap.gmail.com"))
14144 @end example
14145
14146 You'll be prompted for a user name and password. If you grow tired of
14147 that, then add the following to your @file{~/.authinfo} file:
14148
14149 @example
14150 machine imap.gmail.com login <username> password <password> port imap
14151 @end example
14152
14153 That should basically be it for most users.
14154
14155
14156 @node Customizing the IMAP Connection
14157 @subsection Customizing the IMAP Connection
14158
14159 Here's an example method that's more complex:
14160
14161 @example
14162 (nnimap "imap.gmail.com"
14163 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14164 (nnimap-split-methods default)
14165 (nnimap-expunge t)
14166 (nnimap-stream ssl))
14167 @end example
14168
14169 @table @code
14170 @item nnimap-address
14171 The address of the server, like @samp{imap.gmail.com}.
14172
14173 @item nnimap-server-port
14174 If the server uses a non-standard port, that can be specified here. A
14175 typical port would be @code{"imap"} or @code{"imaps"}.
14176
14177 @item nnimap-stream
14178 How @code{nnimap} should connect to the server. Possible values are:
14179
14180 @table @code
14181 @item undecided
14182 This is the default, and this first tries the @code{ssl} setting, and
14183 then tries the @code{network} setting.
14184
14185 @item ssl
14186 This uses standard @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14187
14188 @item network
14189 Non-encrypted and unsafe straight socket connection, but will upgrade
14190 to encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} if both Emacs and the server
14191 supports it.
14192
14193 @item starttls
14194 Encrypted @acronym{STARTTLS} over the normal @acronym{IMAP} port.
14195
14196 @item shell
14197 If you need to tunnel via other systems to connect to the server, you
14198 can use this option, and customize @code{nnimap-shell-program} to be
14199 what you need.
14200
14201 @end table
14202
14203 @item nnimap-authenticator
14204 Some @acronym{IMAP} servers allow anonymous logins. In that case,
14205 this should be set to @code{anonymous}.
14206
14207 @item nnimap-expunge
14208 If non-@code{nil}, expunge articles after deleting them. This is always done
14209 if the server supports UID EXPUNGE, but it's not done by default on
14210 servers that doesn't support that command.
14211
14212 @item nnimap-streaming
14213 Virtually all @acronym{IMAP} server support fast streaming of data.
14214 If you have problems connecting to the server, try setting this to
14215 @code{nil}.
14216
14217 @item nnimap-fetch-partial-articles
14218 If non-@code{nil}, fetch partial articles from the server. If set to
14219 a string, then it's interpreted as a regexp, and parts that have
14220 matching types will be fetched. For instance, @samp{"text/"} will
14221 fetch all textual parts, while leaving the rest on the server.
14222
14223 @item nnimap-record-commands
14224 If non-@code{nil}, record all @acronym{IMAP} commands in the
14225 @samp{"*imap log*"} buffer.
14226
14227 @end table
14228
14229
14230 @node Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14231 @subsection Client-Side IMAP Splitting
14232
14233 Many people prefer to do the sorting/splitting of mail into their mail
14234 boxes on the @acronym{IMAP} server. That way they don't have to
14235 download the mail they're not all that interested in.
14236
14237 If you do want to do client-side mail splitting, then the following
14238 variables are relevant:
14239
14240 @table @code
14241 @item nnimap-inbox
14242 This is the @acronym{IMAP} mail box that will be scanned for new mail.
14243
14244 @item nnimap-split-methods
14245 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-methods} (@pxref{Splitting
14246 Mail}), except the symbol @code{default}, which means that it should
14247 use the value of the @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable.
14248
14249 @item nnimap-split-fancy
14250 Uses the same syntax as @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
14251
14252 @item nnimap-unsplittable-articles
14253 List of flag symbols to ignore when doing splitting. That is,
14254 articles that have these flags won't be considered when splitting.
14255 The default is @samp{(%Deleted %Seen)}.
14256
14257 @end table
14258
14259 Here's a complete example @code{nnimap} backend with a client-side
14260 ``fancy'' splitting method:
14261
14262 @example
14263 (nnimap "imap.example.com"
14264 (nnimap-inbox "INBOX")
14265 (nnimap-split-methods
14266 (| ("MailScanner-SpamCheck" "spam" "spam.detected")
14267 (to "foo@@bar.com" "foo")
14268 "undecided")))
14269 @end example
14270
14271
14272 @node Getting Mail
14273 @section Getting Mail
14274 @cindex reading mail
14275 @cindex mail
14276
14277 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD@? But of
14278 course.
14279
14280 @menu
14281 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
14282 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
14283 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
14284 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
14285 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
14286 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
14287 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
14288 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
14289 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
14290 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
14291 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
14292 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
14293 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
14294 @end menu
14295
14296
14297 @node Mail in a Newsreader
14298 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
14299
14300 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
14301 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
14302 of a culture shock.
14303
14304 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
14305 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
14306
14307 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
14308 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
14309 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
14310 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
14311
14312 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
14313
14314 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
14315 deleted? How awful!
14316
14317 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
14318 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
14319 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
14320 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
14321 Mail}.
14322
14323 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
14324 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
14325 they want to treat a message.
14326
14327 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
14328 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
14329 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
14330 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
14331 archived somewhere else.
14332
14333 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
14334 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
14335 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
14336 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
14337 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
14338
14339 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
14340 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
14341 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
14342
14343 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
14344 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
14345 differently.
14346
14347 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
14348 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
14349 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
14350 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
14351 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
14352
14353 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
14354 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
14355 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
14356 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
14357 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
14358 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
14359 You Do.)
14360
14361
14362 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
14363 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
14364
14365 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
14366 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
14367 and things will happen automatically.
14368
14369 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
14370 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14371
14372 @lisp
14373 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
14374 @end lisp
14375
14376 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
14377 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
14378 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
14379 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
14380 like any other group.
14381
14382 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
14383
14384 @lisp
14385 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14386 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14387 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14388 ("other" "")))
14389 @end lisp
14390
14391 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
14392 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
14393 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
14394 last group.
14395
14396 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
14397 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
14398 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
14399
14400
14401 @node Splitting Mail
14402 @subsection Splitting Mail
14403 @cindex splitting mail
14404 @cindex mail splitting
14405 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
14406
14407 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
14408 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
14409 to be split into groups.
14410
14411 @lisp
14412 (setq nnmail-split-methods
14413 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
14414 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
14415 ("mail.other" "")))
14416 @end lisp
14417
14418 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
14419 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
14420 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
14421 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
14422 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
14423 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
14424 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
14425
14426 @lisp
14427 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
14428 @end lisp
14429
14430 @noindent
14431 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
14432 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14433
14434 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
14435 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
14436 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
14437 mail belongs in that group.
14438
14439 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
14440 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
14441 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
14442 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
14443 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
14444 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
14445 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
14446 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
14447 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
14448 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
14449
14450 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
14451 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
14452 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
14453 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
14454 thinks should carry this mail message.
14455
14456 This variable can also be a fancy split method. For the syntax,
14457 see @ref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
14458
14459 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
14460 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
14461 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
14462 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
14463
14464 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
14465 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
14466 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
14467 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
14468 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
14469
14470 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
14471 @cindex crosspost
14472 @cindex links
14473 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
14474 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
14475 links. If that's the case for you, set
14476 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
14477 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
14478
14479 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
14480 @findex nnmail-split-history
14481 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
14482 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
14483 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
14484 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
14485 Group Commands}).
14486
14487 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
14488 Header lines longer than the value of
14489 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
14490 function.
14491
14492 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
14493 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
14494 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
14495 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
14496 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
14497 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
14498 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
14499 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
14500 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
14501 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
14502 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
14503 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
14504
14505 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14506 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
14507 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
14508 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
14509 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
14510 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
14511 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
14512 other kinds of entries.)
14513
14514 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
14515 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
14516 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
14517 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
14518 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
14519 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
14520 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
14521 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
14522 month's rent money.
14523
14524
14525 @node Mail Sources
14526 @subsection Mail Sources
14527
14528 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
14529 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
14530 maildir, for instance.
14531
14532 @menu
14533 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
14534 * Mail Source Functions::
14535 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
14536 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
14537 @end menu
14538
14539
14540 @node Mail Source Specifiers
14541 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
14542 @cindex POP
14543 @cindex mail server
14544 @cindex procmail
14545 @cindex mail spool
14546 @cindex mail source
14547
14548 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
14549 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
14550
14551 Here's an example:
14552
14553 @lisp
14554 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
14555 @end lisp
14556
14557 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
14558 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
14559 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
14560 default values.
14561
14562 The @code{mail-sources} is global for all mail groups. You can specify
14563 an additional mail source for a particular group by including the
14564 @code{group} mail specifier in @code{mail-sources}, and setting a
14565 @code{mail-source} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) specifying
14566 a single mail source. When this is used, @code{mail-sources} is
14567 typically just @code{(group)}; the @code{mail-source} parameter for a
14568 group might look like this:
14569
14570 @lisp
14571 (mail-source . (file :path "home/user/spools/foo.spool"))
14572 @end lisp
14573
14574 This means that the group's (and only this group's) messages will be
14575 fetched from the spool file @samp{/user/spools/foo.spool}.
14576
14577 The following mail source types are available:
14578
14579 @table @code
14580 @item file
14581 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
14582
14583 Keywords:
14584
14585 @table @code
14586 @item :path
14587 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
14588 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
14589 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
14590
14591 @item :prescript
14592 @itemx :postscript
14593 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14594 @end table
14595
14596 An example file mail source:
14597
14598 @lisp
14599 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
14600 @end lisp
14601
14602 Or using the default file name:
14603
14604 @lisp
14605 (file)
14606 @end lisp
14607
14608 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
14609 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
14610 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
14611 mail spool while moving the mail.
14612
14613 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
14614
14615 @lisp
14616 (setq mail-sources
14617 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
14618 @end lisp
14619
14620 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
14621
14622 @example
14623 #!/bin/sh
14624 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
14625 # flu@@iki.fi
14626
14627 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
14628 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
14629 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
14630 @end example
14631
14632 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
14633 file you want to use.
14634
14635
14636 @item directory
14637 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
14638 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
14639 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
14640 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
14641 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
14642 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
14643 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
14644 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
14645 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
14646 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
14647
14648 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
14649 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
14650 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
14651 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
14652
14653 Keywords:
14654
14655 @table @code
14656 @item :path
14657 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
14658 value.
14659
14660 @item :suffix
14661 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
14662 @samp{.spool}.
14663
14664 @item :predicate
14665 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
14666 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
14667 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
14668 predicate are considered.
14669
14670 @item :prescript
14671 @itemx :postscript
14672 Script run before/after fetching mail.
14673
14674 @end table
14675
14676 An example directory mail source:
14677
14678 @lisp
14679 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
14680 :suffix ".prcml")
14681 @end lisp
14682
14683 @item pop
14684 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14685
14686 Keywords:
14687
14688 @table @code
14689 @item :server
14690 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
14691 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14692
14693 @item :port
14694 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (e.g.,
14695 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (e.g., @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
14696 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
14697 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
14698 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
14699
14700 @item :user
14701 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
14702 name.
14703
14704 @item :password
14705 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
14706 the user is prompted.
14707
14708 @item :program
14709 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
14710 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
14711
14712 @example
14713 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
14714 @end example
14715
14716 The valid format specifier characters are:
14717
14718 @table @samp
14719 @item t
14720 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
14721 included in this string.
14722
14723 @item s
14724 The name of the server.
14725
14726 @item P
14727 The port number of the server.
14728
14729 @item u
14730 The user name to use.
14731
14732 @item p
14733 The password to use.
14734 @end table
14735
14736 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14737 corresponding keywords.
14738
14739 @item :prescript
14740 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14741 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14742
14743 One popular way to use this is to set up an SSH tunnel to access the
14744 @acronym{POP} server. Here's an example:
14745
14746 @lisp
14747 (pop :server "127.0.0.1"
14748 :port 1234
14749 :user "foo"
14750 :password "secret"
14751 :prescript
14752 "nohup ssh -f -L 1234:pop.server:110 remote.host sleep 3600 &")
14753 @end lisp
14754
14755 @item :postscript
14756 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
14757 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
14758
14759 @item :function
14760 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
14761 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
14762 mail should be moved to.
14763
14764 @item :authentication
14765 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
14766 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
14767 @code{password}.
14768
14769 @end table
14770
14771 @vindex pop3-movemail
14772 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
14773 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
14774 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
14775 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
14776 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
14777 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
14778 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
14779 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
14780 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
14781
14782 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
14783 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
14784 name, and default fetcher:
14785
14786 @lisp
14787 (pop)
14788 @end lisp
14789
14790 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
14791
14792 @lisp
14793 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
14794 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
14795 @end lisp
14796
14797 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
14798
14799 @lisp
14800 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
14801 @end lisp
14802
14803 @item maildir
14804 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
14805 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
14806 contains exactly one mail.
14807
14808 Keywords:
14809
14810 @table @code
14811 @item :path
14812 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
14813 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
14814 @file{~/Maildir/}.
14815 @item :subdirs
14816 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
14817 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
14818
14819 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
14820 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
14821 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
14822 @c below.
14823
14824 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
14825 from locking problems).
14826
14827 @end table
14828
14829 Two example maildir mail sources:
14830
14831 @lisp
14832 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
14833 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
14834 @end lisp
14835
14836 @lisp
14837 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
14838 :subdirs ("new"))
14839 @end lisp
14840
14841 @item imap
14842 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
14843 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (i.e.,
14844 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
14845 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
14846 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{Using IMAP}, for more information.
14847
14848 Keywords:
14849
14850 @table @code
14851 @item :server
14852 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
14853 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
14854
14855 @item :port
14856 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
14857 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
14858
14859 @item :user
14860 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
14861 name.
14862
14863 @item :password
14864 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
14865 prompted.
14866
14867 @item :stream
14868 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
14869 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
14870 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
14871 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
14872
14873 @item :authentication
14874 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
14875 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
14876 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
14877 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
14878
14879 @item :program
14880 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
14881 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
14882 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
14883
14884 @example
14885 ssh %s imapd
14886 @end example
14887
14888 Make sure nothing is interfering with the output of the program, e.g.,
14889 don't forget to redirect the error output to the void. The valid format
14890 specifier characters are:
14891
14892 @table @samp
14893 @item s
14894 The name of the server.
14895
14896 @item l
14897 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
14898
14899 @item p
14900 The port number of the server.
14901 @end table
14902
14903 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
14904 corresponding keywords.
14905
14906 @item :mailbox
14907 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
14908 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
14909
14910 @item :predicate
14911 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
14912 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
14913 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
14914 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
14915 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
14916 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
14917
14918 @item :fetchflag
14919 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
14920 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
14921 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
14922 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
14923
14924 @item :dontexpunge
14925 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
14926 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
14927
14928 @end table
14929
14930 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
14931
14932 @lisp
14933 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
14934 :stream kerberos4
14935 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
14936 @end lisp
14937
14938 @item group
14939 Get the actual mail source from the @code{mail-source} group parameter,
14940 @xref{Group Parameters}.
14941
14942 @end table
14943
14944 @table @dfn
14945 @item Common Keywords
14946 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14947
14948 Keywords:
14949
14950 @table @code
14951 @item :plugged
14952 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14953 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14954 example:
14955
14956 @lisp
14957 (setq mail-sources
14958 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14959 :suffix ""
14960 :plugged t)))
14961 @end lisp
14962
14963 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14964 useful when you use local mail and news.
14965
14966 @end table
14967 @end table
14968
14969 @node Mail Source Functions
14970 @subsubsection Function Interface
14971
14972 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14973 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14974 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14975 consider the following mail-source setting:
14976
14977 @lisp
14978 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14979 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14980 @end lisp
14981
14982 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14983 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14984 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14985 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14986 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14987
14988 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14989
14990
14991 @node Mail Source Customization
14992 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14993
14994 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14995 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14996 variables.
14997
14998 @table @code
14999 @item mail-source-crash-box
15000 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
15001 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
15002 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
15003
15004 @cindex Incoming*
15005 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
15006 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
15007 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
15008 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
15009 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
15010 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
15011 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
15012 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
15013 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{10} in alpha Gnusae
15014 and @code{2} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
15015
15016 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15017 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
15018 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
15019 files. This variable only applies when
15020 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
15021
15022 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
15023 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
15024 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
15025
15026 @item mail-source-directory
15027 @vindex mail-source-directory
15028 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
15029 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
15030 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
15031 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
15032
15033 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15034 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
15035 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
15036 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
15037 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
15038 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
15039 number.
15040
15041 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
15042 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
15043 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is @code{#o600}.
15044
15045 @item mail-source-movemail-program
15046 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
15047 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
15048 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
15049
15050 @end table
15051
15052
15053 @node Fetching Mail
15054 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
15055
15056 @vindex mail-sources
15057 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
15058 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
15059 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
15060
15061 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
15062 fetch mail by themselves.
15063
15064 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
15065 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
15066
15067 @lisp
15068 (setq mail-sources
15069 '((file)
15070 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15071 :password "secret")))
15072 @end lisp
15073
15074 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
15075
15076 @lisp
15077 (setq mail-sources
15078 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
15079 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
15080 :user "user-name"
15081 :port "pop3"
15082 :password "secret")))
15083 @end lisp
15084
15085
15086 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
15087 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
15088 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
15089 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
15090 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
15091 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
15092
15093
15094
15095 @node Mail Back End Variables
15096 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
15097
15098 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
15099 mail back ends.
15100
15101 @table @code
15102 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15103 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
15104 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
15105 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
15106
15107 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
15108 @item nnmail-split-hook
15109 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
15110 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
15111 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
15112 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
15113 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
15114 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
15115 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
15116 in the buffer will show up in any files.
15117 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
15118 to this hook.
15119
15120 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15121 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15122 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15123 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15124 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
15125 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
15126 starting to handle the new mail) and
15127 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
15128 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
15129 default file modes the new mail files get:
15130
15131 @lisp
15132 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
15133 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o700)))
15134
15135 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
15136 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes #o775)))
15137 @end lisp
15138
15139 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
15140 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
15141 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
15142 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
15143 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
15144 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
15145 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
15146
15147 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
15148 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
15149 @findex delete-file
15150 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
15151
15152 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15153 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15154 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
15155 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
15156 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
15157
15158 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15159 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
15160 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
15161 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
15162 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
15163
15164 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
15165 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
15166 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
15167
15168 @end table
15169
15170
15171 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
15172 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
15173 @cindex mail splitting
15174 @cindex fancy mail splitting
15175
15176 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
15177 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
15178 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
15179 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
15180 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
15181 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
15182
15183 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
15184
15185 @lisp
15186 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
15187 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
15188 ;; @r{from real errors.}
15189 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
15190 "mail.misc"))
15191 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
15192 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
15193 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
15194 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
15195 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
15196 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
15197 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
15198 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
15199 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
15200 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
15201 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
15202 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
15203 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
15204 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
15205 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
15206 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
15207 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
15208 "misc.misc")
15209 @end lisp
15210
15211 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
15212 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
15213 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
15214
15215 @table @code
15216
15217 @item group
15218 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
15219 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
15220
15221 @c Don't fold this line.
15222 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
15223 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
15224 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
15225 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
15226 @var{split}.
15227
15228 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
15229 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
15230 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
15231 @var{split} is processed.
15232
15233 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
15234 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
15235 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
15236 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15237
15238 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
15239 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
15240 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
15241 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
15242 stored in one or more groups.
15243
15244 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
15245 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
15246 process all @var{split}s in the list.
15247
15248 @item junk
15249 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
15250 this message. Use with extreme caution.
15251
15252 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
15253 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
15254 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
15255 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
15256
15257 @cindex body split
15258 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
15259 body of the messages:
15260
15261 @lisp
15262 (defun split-on-body ()
15263 (save-excursion
15264 (save-restriction
15265 (widen)
15266 (goto-char (point-min))
15267 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
15268 "string.group"))))
15269 @end lisp
15270
15271 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
15272 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
15273 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
15274 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
15275 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
15276 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
15277 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
15278
15279 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
15280 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
15281 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
15282 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
15283 should return a split.
15284
15285 @item nil
15286 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
15287
15288 @end table
15289
15290 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
15291
15292 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
15293 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
15294 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
15295 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
15296 for example,
15297
15298 @example
15299 (any "joe" "joemail")
15300 @end example
15301
15302 @noindent
15303 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
15304 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
15305 of the following three ways:
15306
15307 @enumerate
15308 @item
15309 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
15310 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
15311 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
15312 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
15313 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
15314 @code{nil}.
15315
15316 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
15317
15318 @item
15319 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
15320 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
15321 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
15322 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
15323 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
15324
15325 @item
15326 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
15327 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
15328 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
15329 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15330 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
15331 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
15332 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
15333 @end enumerate
15334
15335 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
15336 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
15337 they are expanded as specified by the variable
15338 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
15339 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
15340 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
15341 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
15342
15343 @table @code
15344 @item from
15345 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
15346 @item to
15347 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
15348 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
15349 @item any
15350 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
15351 @end table
15352
15353 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
15354 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
15355 when all this splitting is performed.
15356
15357 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
15358 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
15359 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
15360
15361 @example
15362 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
15363 @end example
15364
15365 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
15366 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
15367
15368 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
15369 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
15370 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
15371 groupings 1 through 9.
15372
15373 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
15374 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
15375 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
15376 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
15377 groups when users send to an address using different case
15378 (i.e., mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
15379 is @code{t}.
15380
15381 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
15382 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
15383 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
15384 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
15385 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
15386 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
15387 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
15388 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
15389 it once per thread.
15390
15391 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
15392 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
15393 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
15394 using the colon feature, like so:
15395 @lisp
15396 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
15397 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
15398 nnmail-split-fancy
15399 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
15400 ;; @r{other splits go here}
15401 ))
15402 @end lisp
15403
15404 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
15405 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
15406 in the file specified by the variable
15407 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
15408 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
15409 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
15410 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
15411 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
15412 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
15413 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
15414 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
15415 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
15416 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
15417 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
15418 300 kBytes in size.)
15419 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
15420 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
15421 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
15422 messages goes into the new group.
15423
15424 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
15425 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
15426 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
15427 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
15428 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
15429 ``outgoing'' group.
15430
15431
15432 @node Group Mail Splitting
15433 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
15434 @cindex mail splitting
15435 @cindex group mail splitting
15436
15437 @findex gnus-group-split
15438 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
15439 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
15440 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
15441 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
15442 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
15443 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
15444 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
15445 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
15446
15447 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
15448 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
15449 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
15450 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
15451
15452 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
15453 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
15454 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
15455 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
15456 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
15457 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
15458 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
15459
15460 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
15461 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
15462 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
15463 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
15464 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
15465 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
15466 @code{gnus-group-split}.
15467
15468 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
15469 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
15470 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
15471 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
15472 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
15473 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
15474 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
15475 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
15476 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
15477 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
15478 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
15479 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
15480 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
15481
15482 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
15483 been defined:
15484
15485 @example
15486 nnml:mail.bar:
15487 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
15488 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
15489 nnml:mail.foo:
15490 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
15491 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
15492 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
15493 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
15494 nnml:mail.others:
15495 ((split-spec . catch-all))
15496 @end example
15497
15498 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
15499 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
15500 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
15501
15502 @lisp
15503 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
15504 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
15505 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
15506 "mail.others")
15507 @end lisp
15508
15509 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
15510 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
15511 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
15512 splits like this:
15513
15514 @lisp
15515 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
15516 @end lisp
15517
15518 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
15519 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
15520 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
15521 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
15522 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
15523 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
15524 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
15525 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
15526 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
15527
15528 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
15529 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
15530 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
15531 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
15532 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
15533 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
15534 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
15535 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
15536 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
15537
15538 @findex gnus-group-split-update
15539 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
15540 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
15541 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
15542 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
15543 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
15544
15545 @lisp
15546 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
15547 @end lisp
15548
15549 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
15550 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
15551 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
15552 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
15553 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
15554 value.
15555
15556 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
15557 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
15558 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
15559 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
15560
15561 @node Incorporating Old Mail
15562 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
15563 @cindex incorporating old mail
15564 @cindex import old mail
15565
15566 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
15567 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
15568 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
15569 your mail groups.
15570
15571 Doing so can be quite easy.
15572
15573 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
15574 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
15575 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
15576 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
15577 your @code{nnml} groups.
15578
15579 Here's how:
15580
15581 @enumerate
15582 @item
15583 Go to the group buffer.
15584
15585 @item
15586 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
15587 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
15588
15589 @item
15590 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
15591
15592 @item
15593 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
15594 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
15595
15596 @item
15597 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
15598 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
15599 @end enumerate
15600
15601 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
15602 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
15603 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
15604 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
15605 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
15606
15607 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
15608 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
15609 using the new mail back end.
15610
15611
15612 @node Expiring Mail
15613 @subsection Expiring Mail
15614 @cindex article expiry
15615 @cindex expiring mail
15616
15617 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
15618 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
15619 different approach to mail reading.
15620
15621 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
15622 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
15623 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
15624 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
15625 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
15626 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
15627 course.
15628
15629 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
15630 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
15631 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
15632 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
15633 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
15634 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
15635 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
15636 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
15637 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
15638
15639 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-marks
15640 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
15641 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
15642 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
15643 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
15644 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
15645 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
15646 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} (and so on) are considered
15647 expirable. @code{gnus-auto-expirable-marks} has the full list of
15648 these marks.
15649
15650 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
15651 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
15652 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
15653 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
15654 into its own group.)
15655
15656 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
15657 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
15658 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
15659 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
15660 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
15661 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
15662 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
15663 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
15664 scoring.
15665
15666 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15667 Groups that match the regular expression
15668 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
15669 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
15670 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
15671
15672 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
15673 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
15674 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
15675 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
15676 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
15677
15678 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
15679 @lisp
15680 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
15681 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
15682 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
15683 @end lisp
15684
15685 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
15686 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
15687 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
15688 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
15689 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
15690
15691 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
15692 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
15693
15694 @lisp
15695 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
15696 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
15697 @end lisp
15698
15699 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
15700 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
15701
15702 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
15703 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
15704 don't really mix very well.
15705
15706 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
15707 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
15708 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
15709 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
15710 days.
15711
15712 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
15713 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
15714 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
15715 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
15716 everywhere else:
15717
15718 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15719 @lisp
15720 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
15721 (lambda (group)
15722 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
15723 31)
15724 ((string= group "mail.junk")
15725 1)
15726 ((string= group "important")
15727 'never)
15728 (t
15729 6))))
15730 @end lisp
15731
15732 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
15733 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
15734
15735 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
15736 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
15737 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
15738 @code{never}.
15739
15740 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
15741 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
15742
15743 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
15744 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
15745 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
15746 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
15747 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
15748 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
15749 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
15750 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
15751 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
15752 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
15753 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
15754 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
15755 name or @code{delete}.
15756
15757 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
15758 @lisp
15759 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
15760 @end lisp
15761
15762 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15763 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15764 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
15765 expire mail to groups according to the variable
15766 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
15767
15768 @lisp
15769 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
15770 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
15771 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
15772 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
15773 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
15774 @end lisp
15775
15776 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
15777 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
15778 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
15779 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
15780 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
15781 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
15782
15783 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
15784 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
15785 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
15786 easier for procmail users.
15787
15788 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
15789 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
15790 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
15791 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
15792 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
15793 caution. Even more dangerous is the
15794 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
15795 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
15796 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
15797 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
15798 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
15799 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
15800 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
15801 with! So there!
15802
15803 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
15804
15805 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
15806 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
15807 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
15808 auto-expire turned on.
15809
15810 @vindex gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable
15811 The expirable marks of articles will be removed when copying or moving
15812 them to a group in which auto-expire is not turned on. This is for
15813 preventing articles from being expired unintentionally. On the other
15814 hand, to a group that has turned auto-expire on, the expirable marks of
15815 articles that are copied or moved will not be changed by default. I.e.,
15816 when copying or moving to such a group, articles that were expirable
15817 will be left expirable and ones that were not expirable will not be
15818 marked as expirable. So, even though in auto-expire groups, some
15819 articles will never get expired (unless you read them again). If you
15820 don't side with that behavior that unexpirable articles may be mixed
15821 into auto-expire groups, you can set
15822 @code{gnus-mark-copied-or-moved-articles-as-expirable} to a
15823 non-@code{nil} value. In that case, articles that have been read will
15824 be marked as expirable automatically when being copied or moved to a
15825 group that has auto-expire turned on. The default value is @code{nil}.
15826
15827
15828 @node Washing Mail
15829 @subsection Washing Mail
15830 @cindex mail washing
15831 @cindex list server brain damage
15832 @cindex incoming mail treatment
15833
15834 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
15835 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
15836 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
15837 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
15838 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
15839 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
15840
15841 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
15842 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
15843 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
15844 laugh.
15845
15846 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
15847 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
15848 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
15849 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
15850
15851 @table @code
15852 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15853 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
15854 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
15855 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
15856 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
15857
15858 @table @code
15859 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15860 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
15861 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
15862 Emacs running on MS machines.
15863
15864 @end table
15865
15866 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15867 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
15868 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
15869 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
15870
15871 @table @code
15872 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15873 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
15874 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
15875 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
15876
15877 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
15878 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
15879 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
15880 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
15881 into a feature by documenting it.)
15882
15883 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15884 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
15885 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
15886 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
15887 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
15888 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
15889 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
15890 @code{\\(..\\)}.
15891
15892 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
15893 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
15894
15895 @lisp
15896 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
15897 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
15898 @end lisp
15899
15900 This can also be done non-destructively with
15901 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
15902
15903 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
15904 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
15905 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
15906
15907 @item nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15908 @findex nnmail-ignore-broken-references
15909 @c @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
15910 @cindex Eudora
15911 @cindex Pegasus
15912 Some mail user agents (e.g., Eudora and Pegasus) produce broken
15913 @code{References} headers, but correct @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This
15914 function will get rid of the @code{References} header if the headers
15915 contain a line matching the regular expression
15916 @code{nnmail-broken-references-mailers}.
15917
15918 @end table
15919
15920 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15921 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
15922 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
15923 include:
15924
15925 @table @code
15926 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
15927 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
15928 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
15929
15930 @end table
15931 @end table
15932
15933
15934 @node Duplicates
15935 @subsection Duplicates
15936
15937 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15938 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15939 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15940 @cindex duplicate mails
15941 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15942 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15943 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15944 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s:
15945 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15946 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15947 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15948 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15949 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15950 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15951 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15952 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15953 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15954
15955 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15956 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15957 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15958 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15959
15960 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15961 @code{nil}.
15962
15963 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15964 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15965 methods:
15966
15967 @lisp
15968 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15969 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15970 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15971 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15972 (any mail "mail.misc")
15973 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15974 [...] ))
15975 @end lisp
15976 @noindent
15977 Or something like:
15978 @lisp
15979 (setq nnmail-split-methods
15980 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15981 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15982 [...]))
15983 @end lisp
15984
15985 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15986 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15987 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15988 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15989 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15990
15991
15992 @node Not Reading Mail
15993 @subsection Not Reading Mail
15994
15995 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15996 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15997 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15998
15999 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
16000 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
16001 mail, which should help.
16002
16003 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16004 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16005 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16006 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16007 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16008 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
16009 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old (pre-Emacs
16010 23) Rmail file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
16011 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
16012 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
16013 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
16014
16015 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
16016 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
16017 incoming mail.
16018
16019
16020 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
16021 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
16022
16023 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
16024 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
16025 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
16026
16027 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
16028 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
16029 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
16030 Spool}).
16031
16032 @menu
16033 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
16034 * Babyl:: Babyl was used by older versions of Rmail.
16035 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
16036 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
16037 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
16038 * nnmaildir Group Parameters::
16039 * Article Identification::
16040 * NOV Data::
16041 * Article Marks::
16042 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
16043 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
16044 @end menu
16045
16046
16047
16048 @node Unix Mail Box
16049 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
16050 @cindex nnmbox
16051 @cindex unix mail box
16052
16053 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16054 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16055 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
16056 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
16057 which group it belongs in.
16058
16059 Virtual server settings:
16060
16061 @table @code
16062 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
16063 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
16064 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
16065 @file{~/mbox}.
16066
16067 @item nnmbox-active-file
16068 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
16069 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
16070 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
16071
16072 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
16073 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
16074 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
16075 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
16076 @end table
16077
16078
16079 @node Babyl
16080 @subsubsection Babyl
16081 @cindex nnbabyl
16082
16083 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16084 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16085 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box to store mail.
16086 @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each mail article to say which
16087 group it belongs in.
16088
16089 Virtual server settings:
16090
16091 @table @code
16092 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
16093 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
16094 The name of the Babyl file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
16095
16096 @item nnbabyl-active-file
16097 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
16098 The name of the active file for the Babyl file. The default is
16099 @file{~/.rmail-active}
16100
16101 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16102 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
16103 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
16104 @code{t}
16105 @end table
16106
16107
16108 @node Mail Spool
16109 @subsubsection Mail Spool
16110 @cindex nnml
16111 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
16112
16113 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
16114 format. It should be used with some caution.
16115
16116 @vindex nnml-directory
16117 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
16118 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
16119 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
16120 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
16121
16122 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
16123 care of all that.
16124
16125 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
16126 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
16127 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
16128 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
16129 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
16130 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
16131 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
16132 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
16133
16134 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
16135 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
16136 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
16137 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
16138
16139 Virtual server settings:
16140
16141 @table @code
16142 @item nnml-directory
16143 @vindex nnml-directory
16144 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
16145 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
16146 is @file{~/Mail}).
16147
16148 @item nnml-active-file
16149 @vindex nnml-active-file
16150 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
16151 @file{~/Mail/active}.
16152
16153 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
16154 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
16155 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16156 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
16157
16158 @item nnml-get-new-mail
16159 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
16160 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
16161 @code{t}.
16162
16163 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
16164 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
16165 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16166 default is @code{nil}.
16167
16168 @item nnml-nov-file-name
16169 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
16170 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
16171
16172 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16173 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
16174 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
16175
16176 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
16177 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
16178 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
16179 files. This requires @code{auto-compression-mode} to be enabled
16180 (@pxref{Compressed Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
16181 If the value of @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is a string, it is used
16182 as the file extension specifying the compression program. You can set it
16183 to @samp{.bz2} if your Emacs supports it. A value of @code{t} is
16184 equivalent to @samp{.gz}.
16185
16186 @item nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16187 @vindex nnml-compressed-files-size-threshold
16188 Default size threshold for compressed message files. Message files with
16189 bodies larger than that many characters will be automatically compressed
16190 if @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil}.
16191
16192 @end table
16193
16194 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
16195 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
16196 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
16197 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
16198 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
16199 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
16200 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
16201 Commands}).
16202
16203
16204 @node MH Spool
16205 @subsubsection MH Spool
16206 @cindex nnmh
16207 @cindex mh-e mail spool
16208
16209 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
16210 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
16211 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
16212 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
16213 for.
16214
16215 Virtual server settings:
16216
16217 @table @code
16218 @item nnmh-directory
16219 @vindex nnmh-directory
16220 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
16221 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
16222 @file{~/Mail})
16223
16224 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
16225 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
16226 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
16227 @code{t}.
16228
16229 @item nnmh-be-safe
16230 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
16231 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
16232 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
16233 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
16234 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
16235 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
16236 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
16237 @end table
16238
16239
16240 @node Maildir
16241 @subsubsection Maildir
16242 @cindex nnmaildir
16243 @cindex maildir
16244
16245 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
16246 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
16247 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
16248 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
16249 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
16250 within a maildir.
16251
16252 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
16253 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
16254 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
16255 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
16256 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
16257 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
16258 that appear as group in Gnus.
16259
16260 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
16261 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
16262 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
16263
16264 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
16265 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
16266 another, and you will keep your marks.
16267
16268 Virtual server settings:
16269
16270 @table @code
16271 @item directory
16272 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
16273 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
16274 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
16275 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
16276 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
16277 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
16278 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
16279 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
16280 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
16281 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
16282
16283 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
16284 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
16285 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
16286 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
16287 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
16288 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
16289 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
16290 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
16291 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
16292 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
16293 value.
16294
16295 @item target-prefix
16296 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
16297 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
16298 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
16299 closed.
16300
16301 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
16302 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
16303 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
16304 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
16305 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
16306 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
16307 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
16308 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
16309 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
16310
16311 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
16312 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
16313 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
16314 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
16315 symlinks pointing to them will be).
16316
16317 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
16318 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
16319 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
16320 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
16321 @code{force} argument.
16322
16323 @item directory-files
16324 This should be a function with the same interface as
16325 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
16326 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
16327 parameter is optional; the default is
16328 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
16329 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
16330 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
16331 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
16332 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
16333 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
16334
16335 @item get-new-mail
16336 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
16337 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
16338 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
16339 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
16340 value is @code{nil}.
16341
16342 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
16343 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
16344 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
16345 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
16346 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
16347 @end table
16348
16349 @node nnmaildir Group Parameters
16350 @subsubsection Group parameters
16351
16352 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
16353 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
16354 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
16355 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
16356 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
16357 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
16358 another back end.
16359
16360 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
16361 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
16362 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
16363 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
16364 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
16365 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
16366 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
16367 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
16368 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
16369
16370 @table @code
16371 @item expire-age
16372 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
16373 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
16374 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
16375 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
16376 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
16377 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
16378 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
16379 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
16380 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
16381 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
16382 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
16383 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
16384 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
16385
16386 @item expire-group
16387 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
16388 @example
16389 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
16390 @end example
16391 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
16392 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
16393 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
16394 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
16395 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
16396 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
16397 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
16398 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
16399 article. So that form can refer to
16400 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
16401 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
16402 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
16403 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
16404
16405 @item read-only
16406 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
16407 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
16408 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
16409 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
16410 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
16411 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
16412 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
16413 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
16414 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
16415 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
16416 contain extra copies of the articles.
16417
16418 @item directory-files
16419 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
16420 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
16421 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
16422 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
16423
16424 @item distrust-Lines:
16425 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
16426 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
16427 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
16428
16429 @item always-marks
16430 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
16431 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16432 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
16433 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
16434 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
16435 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16436
16437 @item never-marks
16438 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
16439 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
16440 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
16441 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
16442 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
16443 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
16444 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
16445
16446 @item nov-cache-size
16447 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
16448 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
16449 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
16450 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
16451 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
16452 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
16453 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
16454 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
16455 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
16456 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
16457 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
16458 @end table
16459
16460 @node Article Identification
16461 @subsubsection Article identification
16462 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
16463 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
16464 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
16465 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
16466 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
16467 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
16468 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
16469 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
16470 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
16471 request the article in the summary buffer.
16472
16473 @node NOV Data
16474 @subsubsection NOV data
16475 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
16476 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
16477 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
16478 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
16479 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
16480 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
16481 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
16482 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
16483 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
16484 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
16485 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
16486
16487 @node Article Marks
16488 @subsubsection Article marks
16489 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
16490 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
16491 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16492 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
16493 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
16494 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
16495 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
16496 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
16497
16498 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
16499 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
16500 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
16501 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
16502 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
16503 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
16504 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
16505 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
16506 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
16507
16508
16509 @node Mail Folders
16510 @subsubsection Mail Folders
16511 @cindex nnfolder
16512 @cindex mbox folders
16513 @cindex mail folders
16514
16515 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
16516 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
16517 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
16518 numbers and arrival dates.
16519
16520 Virtual server settings:
16521
16522 @table @code
16523 @item nnfolder-directory
16524 @vindex nnfolder-directory
16525 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
16526 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
16527 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
16528
16529 @item nnfolder-active-file
16530 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
16531 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
16532
16533 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16534 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
16535 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
16536 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
16537
16538 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
16539 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
16540 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
16541 default is @code{t}
16542
16543 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16544 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
16545 @cindex backup files
16546 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
16547 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
16548 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
16549 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
16550
16551 @lisp
16552 (defun turn-off-backup ()
16553 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
16554
16555 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
16556 @end lisp
16557
16558 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16559 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
16560 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
16561 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
16562 extract some information from it before removing it.
16563
16564 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16565 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
16566 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
16567 default is @code{nil}.
16568
16569 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16570 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
16571 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
16572
16573 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
16574 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
16575 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
16576 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
16577
16578 @end table
16579
16580
16581 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
16582 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
16583 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
16584 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
16585 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
16586 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
16587 though.
16588
16589 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
16590 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
16591
16592 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
16593 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
16594 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
16595 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
16596 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
16597
16598 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
16599 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
16600 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
16601 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
16602 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
16603 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
16604 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
16605 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
16606 via NFS).
16607
16608 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
16609 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
16610 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
16611 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
16612
16613 @table @code
16614 @item nnmbox
16615
16616 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-defined
16617 format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
16618 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
16619 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
16620 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
16621 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
16622 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
16623 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
16624 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
16625 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
16626 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
16627 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
16628 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
16629 what's where.
16630
16631 @item nnbabyl
16632
16633 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
16634 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
16635 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
16636 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
16637 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
16638 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
16639 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
16640 Rmail was Emacs's first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
16641 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
16642 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
16643 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
16644 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
16645 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
16646 course, and is still maintained within Emacs. Since Emacs 23, it
16647 uses standard mbox format rather than Babyl.
16648
16649 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
16650 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
16651 look at your mail.
16652
16653 @item nnml
16654
16655 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
16656 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
16657 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
16658 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
16659 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
16660 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
16661 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
16662 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
16663 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
16664 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
16665 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
16666 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
16667 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
16668 provided by the active file and overviews.
16669
16670 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
16671 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
16672 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
16673 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
16674 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
16675 wins big.
16676
16677 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
16678 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
16679 tiny files.
16680
16681 @item nnmh
16682
16683 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
16684 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
16685 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
16686 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
16687 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
16688 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
16689 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
16690
16691 @item nnfolder
16692
16693 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
16694 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
16695 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
16696 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
16697 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
16698 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
16699 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
16700 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
16701 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
16702
16703 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
16704 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
16705 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
16706 friendly mail back end all over.
16707
16708 @item nnmaildir
16709
16710 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
16711 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
16712 mail back ends.
16713
16714 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
16715 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
16716 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
16717 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
16718 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}.
16719 (Use @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this
16720 slows you down or takes up very much space, a non-block-structured
16721 file system.
16722
16723 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
16724 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
16725 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
16726 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
16727 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
16728 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
16729 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
16730 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
16731 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
16732 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
16733 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
16734
16735 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
16736 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
16737 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
16738 else, and still have your marks.
16739
16740 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
16741 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
16742 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
16743 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
16744 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
16745 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
16746 removed in the future.
16747
16748 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
16749 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
16750 on your file system.
16751
16752 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
16753 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
16754
16755 @end table
16756
16757
16758 @node Browsing the Web
16759 @section Browsing the Web
16760 @cindex web
16761 @cindex browsing the web
16762 @cindex www
16763 @cindex http
16764
16765 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
16766 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
16767 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
16768 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
16769 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
16770 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
16771 even know what a news group is.
16772
16773 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
16774 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
16775 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
16776 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
16777 you mad in the end.
16778
16779 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
16780 to do it instead?
16781
16782 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
16783 interfaces to these sources.
16784
16785 @menu
16786 * Archiving Mail::
16787 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
16788 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
16789 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
16790 @end menu
16791
16792 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
16793 alternatives to work.
16794
16795 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
16796 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
16797 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
16798 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
16799 though, you should be ok.
16800
16801 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
16802 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
16803 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
16804 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
16805 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
16806
16807 @node Archiving Mail
16808 @subsection Archiving Mail
16809 @cindex archiving mail
16810 @cindex backup of mail
16811
16812 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
16813 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
16814 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
16815 marks is fairly simple.
16816
16817 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
16818 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
16819 though.)
16820
16821 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
16822 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
16823 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
16824 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
16825 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
16826 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
16827 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
16828 before you restore the data.
16829
16830 @node Web Searches
16831 @subsection Web Searches
16832 @cindex nnweb
16833 @cindex Google
16834 @cindex dejanews
16835 @cindex gmane
16836 @cindex Usenet searches
16837 @cindex searching the Usenet
16838
16839 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
16840 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
16841 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
16842 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
16843 searches without having to use a browser.
16844
16845 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
16846 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
16847 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
16848 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
16849 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
16850
16851 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
16852 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
16853 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
16854 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
16855 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
16856 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
16857 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
16858 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
16859 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
16860 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
16861 group as read.
16862
16863 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
16864 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
16865 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'@^etre} is to
16866 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
16867 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
16868 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
16869
16870 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
16871 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
16872 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
16873
16874 Virtual server variables:
16875
16876 @table @code
16877 @item nnweb-type
16878 @vindex nnweb-type
16879 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
16880 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
16881 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
16882
16883 @item nnweb-search
16884 @vindex nnweb-search
16885 The search string to feed to the search engine.
16886
16887 @item nnweb-max-hits
16888 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16889 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16890 999.
16891
16892 @item nnweb-type-definition
16893 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16894 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16895 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16896 present:
16897
16898 @table @code
16899 @item article
16900 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16901 understands.
16902
16903 @item map
16904 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16905
16906 @item search
16907 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16908
16909 @item address
16910 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16911 to.
16912
16913 @item id
16914 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16915 @end table
16916
16917 @end table
16918
16919
16920 @node RSS
16921 @subsection RSS
16922 @cindex nnrss
16923 @cindex RSS
16924
16925 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16926 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16927 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16928 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16929 changes to a wiki (e.g., @url{http://cliki.net/site/recent-changes}).
16930
16931 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16932 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16933
16934 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16935 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16936 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16937 group names.
16938
16939 @kindex G R (Group)
16940 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16941 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16942 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16943 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16944
16945 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16946 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16947 subscribe to groups.
16948
16949 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16950 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16951 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16952 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16953 variable or other. Also @xref{Non-ASCII Group Names}, for more
16954 information.
16955
16956 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16957 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16958 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16959
16960 @cindex OPML
16961 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16962 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16963 Markup Language).
16964
16965 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16966 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16967 file.
16968 @end defun
16969
16970 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16971 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16972 @acronym{OPML} format.
16973 @end defun
16974
16975 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16976
16977 @table @code
16978 @item nnrss-directory
16979 @vindex nnrss-directory
16980 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16981 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16982
16983 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16984 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16985 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16986 data files. The default is the value of
16987 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16988 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16989
16990 @item nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16991 @vindex nnrss-ignore-article-fields
16992 Some feeds update constantly article fields during their publications,
16993 e.g., to indicate the number of comments. However, if there is
16994 a difference between the local article and the distant one, the latter
16995 is considered to be new. To avoid this and discard some fields, set this
16996 variable to the list of fields to be ignored. The default is
16997 @code{'(slash:comments)}.
16998
16999 @item nnrss-use-local
17000 @vindex nnrss-use-local
17001 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
17002 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
17003 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
17004 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
17005 download script using @command{wget}.
17006 @end table
17007
17008 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
17009 the summary buffer.
17010
17011 @lisp
17012 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
17013 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
17014
17015 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
17016 (let ((descr
17017 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
17018 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
17019 @end lisp
17020
17021 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
17022 summary buffer.
17023
17024 @lisp
17025 (require 'browse-url)
17026
17027 (defun browse-nnrss-url (arg)
17028 (interactive "p")
17029 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
17030 (mail-header-extra
17031 (gnus-data-header
17032 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
17033 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
17034 (if url
17035 (progn
17036 (browse-url (cdr url))
17037 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
17038 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
17039
17040 (eval-after-load "gnus"
17041 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
17042 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
17043 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
17044 @end lisp
17045
17046 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
17047 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
17048 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
17049 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
17050 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
17051 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
17052 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
17053 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
17054 @code{nnrss} groups:
17055
17056 @lisp
17057 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
17058 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
17059 '(add-to-list
17060 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
17061 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
17062 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
17063
17064 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
17065 (add-to-list
17066 'gnus-parameters
17067 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
17068 @end lisp
17069
17070
17071 @node Customizing W3
17072 @subsection Customizing W3
17073 @cindex W3
17074 @cindex html
17075 @cindex url
17076 @cindex Netscape
17077
17078 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
17079 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
17080 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
17081 users.
17082
17083 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
17084 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
17085 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
17086
17087 @lisp
17088 (eval-after-load "w3"
17089 '(progn
17090 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
17091 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
17092 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
17093 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
17094 (browse-url url)
17095 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
17096 @end lisp
17097
17098 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
17099 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
17100 follow the link.
17101
17102
17103 @node Other Sources
17104 @section Other Sources
17105
17106 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17107 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17108 newsgroups.
17109
17110 @menu
17111 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17112 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17113 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17114 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17115 * The Empty Backend:: The backend that never has any news.
17116 @end menu
17117
17118
17119 @node Directory Groups
17120 @subsection Directory Groups
17121 @cindex nndir
17122 @cindex directory groups
17123
17124 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17125 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17126 names, of course.
17127
17128 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17129 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17130 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17131 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17132
17133 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17134 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17135 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17136 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17137 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17138
17139 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17140
17141 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17142 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17143 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17144 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17145
17146
17147 @node Anything Groups
17148 @subsection Anything Groups
17149 @cindex nneething
17150
17151 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17152 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17153 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17154 true.
17155
17156 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17157 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17158 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17159 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17160 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17161 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17162 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17163 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g., a C source file),
17164 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17165 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17166 elements.
17167
17168 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17169 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17170 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17171 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17172
17173 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17174 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17175 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17176 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17177
17178 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17179 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17180 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17181 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17182 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17183 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17184 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17185 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17186
17187 Some variables:
17188
17189 @table @code
17190 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17191 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17192 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17193 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17194
17195 @item nneething-exclude-files
17196 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17197 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17198 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17199
17200 @item nneething-include-files
17201 @vindex nneething-include-files
17202 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17203 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17204
17205 @item nneething-map-file
17206 @vindex nneething-map-file
17207 Name of the map files.
17208 @end table
17209
17210
17211 @node Document Groups
17212 @subsection Document Groups
17213 @cindex nndoc
17214 @cindex documentation group
17215 @cindex help group
17216
17217 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17218 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17219
17220 @table @code
17221 @cindex Babyl
17222 @item babyl
17223 The Babyl format.
17224
17225 @cindex mbox
17226 @cindex Unix mbox
17227 @item mbox
17228 The standard Unix mbox file.
17229
17230 @cindex MMDF mail box
17231 @item mmdf
17232 The MMDF mail box format.
17233
17234 @item news
17235 Several news articles appended into a file.
17236
17237 @cindex rnews batch files
17238 @item rnews
17239 The rnews batch transport format.
17240
17241 @item nsmail
17242 Netscape mail boxes.
17243
17244 @item mime-parts
17245 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17246
17247 @item standard-digest
17248 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17249
17250 @item mime-digest
17251 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17252
17253 @item lanl-gov-announce
17254 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17255
17256 @cindex git commit messages
17257 @item git
17258 @code{git} commit messages.
17259
17260 @cindex forwarded messages
17261 @item rfc822-forward
17262 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17263
17264 @item outlook
17265 The Outlook mail box.
17266
17267 @item oe-dbx
17268 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17269
17270 @item exim-bounce
17271 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17272
17273 @item forward
17274 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17275
17276 @item rfc934
17277 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17278
17279 @item mailman
17280 A mailman digest.
17281
17282 @item clari-briefs
17283 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17284
17285 @item slack-digest
17286 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17287
17288 @item mail-in-mail
17289 The last resort.
17290 @end table
17291
17292 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17293 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17294 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17295 file is.
17296
17297 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17298 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17299 group. And that's it.
17300
17301 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17302 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17303 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17304 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17305 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17306 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17307 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17308 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17309 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17310 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17311
17312 Virtual server variables:
17313
17314 @table @code
17315 @item nndoc-article-type
17316 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17317 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17318 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17319 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17320 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17321 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17322
17323 @item nndoc-post-type
17324 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17325 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17326 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17327 and @code{news}.
17328 @end table
17329
17330 @menu
17331 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17332 @end menu
17333
17334
17335 @node Document Server Internals
17336 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17337
17338 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17339 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17340 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17341 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17342
17343 First, here's an example document type definition:
17344
17345 @example
17346 (mmdf
17347 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17348 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17349 @end example
17350
17351 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17352 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17353 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17354 types can be defined with very few settings:
17355
17356 @table @code
17357 @item first-article
17358 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17359 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17360 totally ignored.
17361
17362 @item article-begin
17363 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17364 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17365 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17366 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17367
17368 @item article-begin-function
17369 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17370 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17371
17372 @item head-begin
17373 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17374 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17375 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17376
17377 @item head-begin-function
17378 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17379 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17380
17381 @item head-end
17382 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17383 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17384
17385 @item body-begin
17386 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17387 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17388 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17389
17390 @item body-begin-function
17391 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17392 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17393
17394 @item body-end
17395 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17396 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17397 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17398
17399 @item body-end-function
17400 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17401 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17402
17403 @item file-begin
17404 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17405 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17406
17407 @item file-end
17408 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17409 regexp will be totally ignored.
17410
17411 @end table
17412
17413 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17414 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17415 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17416 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17417 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17418
17419 @table @code
17420 @item prepare-body-function
17421 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17422 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17423 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17424
17425 @item article-transform-function
17426 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17427 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17428 body of the article.
17429
17430 @item generate-head-function
17431 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17432 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17433 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17434 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17435
17436 @item generate-article-function
17437 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17438 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17439 parameter when requesting all articles.
17440
17441 @item dissection-function
17442 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17443 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17444 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17445 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17446 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17447 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17448
17449 @end table
17450
17451 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17452 digests:
17453
17454 @example
17455 (standard-digest
17456 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17457 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17458 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17459 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17460 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17461 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17462 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17463 (subtype digest guess))
17464 @end example
17465
17466 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17467 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17468 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17469 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17470 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17471
17472 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17473 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17474 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17475 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17476 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17477 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17478 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17479 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17480 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17481 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17482 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17483 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17484
17485
17486 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17487 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17488 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17489 @cindex gateways
17490
17491 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17492 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17493 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17494
17495 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17496 used to post with.
17497
17498 Server variables:
17499
17500 @table @code
17501 @item nngateway-address
17502 @vindex nngateway-address
17503 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17504
17505 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17506 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17507 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17508 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17509 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17510 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17511 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17512 gateway address.
17513
17514 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17515 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17516 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17517
17518 @example
17519 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17520 @end example
17521
17522 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17523
17524 @example
17525 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17526 @end example
17527
17528 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17529
17530 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17531 @table @code
17532
17533 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17534 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17535 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17536
17537 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17538
17539 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17540 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17541 @code{nngateway-address}.
17542 @end table
17543
17544 @end table
17545
17546 Here's an example:
17547
17548 @lisp
17549 (setq gnus-post-method
17550 '(nngateway
17551 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17552 (nngateway-header-transformation
17553 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17554 @end lisp
17555
17556 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17557
17558 @lisp
17559 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17560 @end lisp
17561
17562
17563 @node The Empty Backend
17564 @subsection The Empty Backend
17565 @cindex nnnil
17566
17567 @code{nnnil} is a backend that can be used as a placeholder if you
17568 have to specify a backend somewhere, but don't really want to. The
17569 classical example is if you don't want to have a primary select
17570 methods, but want to only use secondary ones:
17571
17572 @lisp
17573 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnnil ""))
17574 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
17575 '((nnimap "foo")
17576 (nnml "")))
17577 @end lisp
17578
17579
17580 @node Combined Groups
17581 @section Combined Groups
17582
17583 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17584 groups.
17585
17586 @menu
17587 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17588 @end menu
17589
17590
17591 @node Virtual Groups
17592 @subsection Virtual Groups
17593 @cindex nnvirtual
17594 @cindex virtual groups
17595 @cindex merging groups
17596
17597 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17598 other groups.
17599
17600 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17601 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17602 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17603
17604 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17605 regexp to match component groups.
17606
17607 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17608 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17609 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17610 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17611 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17612 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17613 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17614 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17615
17616 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17617 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17618
17619 @lisp
17620 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17621 @end lisp
17622
17623 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17624 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17625
17626 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17627 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17628 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17629 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17630
17631 @example
17632 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17633 @end example
17634
17635 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17636 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17637 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17638
17639 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17640 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17641 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17642 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17643 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17644
17645 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17646 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17647 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17648
17649 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17650 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17651 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17652 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17653 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17654 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17655 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17656 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17657 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17658 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17659 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17660
17661 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17662 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17663 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17664 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17665 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17666 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17667 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17668
17669 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17670 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17671
17672 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17673 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17674 inherited.
17675
17676
17677 @node Email Based Diary
17678 @section Email Based Diary
17679 @cindex diary
17680 @cindex email based diary
17681 @cindex calendar
17682
17683 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17684 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17685 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17686 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17687 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17688 namely, as event reminders.
17689
17690 Here is a typical scenario:
17691
17692 @itemize @bullet
17693 @item
17694 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17695 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17696 @item
17697 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17698 @item
17699 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17700 @item
17701 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17702 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17703 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17704 @item
17705 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17706 of the night you're gonna have.
17707 @item
17708 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
17709 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
17710 @end itemize
17711
17712 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
17713 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
17714 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
17715 explained in the sections below.
17716
17717 @menu
17718 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
17719 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
17720 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
17721 @end menu
17722
17723
17724 @node The NNDiary Back End
17725 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
17726 @cindex nndiary
17727 @cindex the nndiary back end
17728
17729 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
17730 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
17731 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
17732 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
17733 directory per group.
17734
17735 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
17736 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
17737 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
17738 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
17739
17740 @menu
17741 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
17742 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
17743 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
17744 @end menu
17745
17746 @node Diary Messages
17747 @subsubsection Diary Messages
17748 @cindex nndiary messages
17749 @cindex nndiary mails
17750
17751 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
17752 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
17753 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
17754 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
17755 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
17756 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
17757 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
17758
17759 @itemize @bullet
17760 @item
17761 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
17762 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
17763 (separated by a comma).
17764 @item
17765 A field is either an integer, or a range.
17766 @item
17767 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
17768 @item
17769 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
17770 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
17771 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
17772 @item
17773 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
17774 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
17775 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
17776 @item
17777 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
17778 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
17779 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
17780 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
17781 list of available time zone values, see the variable
17782 @code{nndiary-headers}.
17783 @end itemize
17784
17785 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
17786 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
17787 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
17788 what to do then):
17789
17790 @example
17791 X-Diary-Minute: 0
17792 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
17793 X-Diary-Dom: 1
17794 X-Diary-Month: *
17795 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
17796 X-Diary-Dow: 1
17797 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
17798 @end example
17799
17800 @node Running NNDiary
17801 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
17802 @cindex running nndiary
17803 @cindex nndiary operation modes
17804
17805 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
17806 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
17807 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
17808 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
17809 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
17810 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
17811
17812 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
17813 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
17814 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
17815 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
17816 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
17817 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
17818 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
17819 mode.
17820
17821 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
17822 things to do:
17823
17824 @itemize @bullet
17825 @item
17826 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
17827 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17828
17829 @lisp
17830 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
17831 @end lisp
17832 @item
17833 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
17834 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
17835 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
17836 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
17837 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
17838
17839 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
17840 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
17841
17842 @example
17843 :0 HD :
17844 * ^X-Diary
17845 .nndiary
17846 @end example
17847 @end itemize
17848
17849 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
17850 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
17851
17852 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
17853 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17854 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
17855 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
17856 @end defvar
17857
17858 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
17859 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
17860 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
17861 @end defvar
17862
17863 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
17864 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
17865 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
17866
17867 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
17868 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
17869 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
17870 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
17871 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
17872
17873 @node Customizing NNDiary
17874 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
17875 @cindex customizing nndiary
17876 @cindex nndiary customization
17877
17878 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
17879 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
17880 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
17881 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
17882
17883 @defvar nndiary-reminders
17884 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
17885 appointments (e.g., 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
17886 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
17887 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
17888 mail.
17889 @end defvar
17890
17891 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
17892 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
17893 default).
17894 @end defvar
17895
17896
17897 @node The Gnus Diary Library
17898 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
17899 @cindex gnus-diary
17900 @cindex the gnus diary library
17901
17902 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
17903 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
17904 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
17905 useful things for you.
17906
17907 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
17908
17909 @lisp
17910 (require 'gnus-diary)
17911 @end lisp
17912
17913 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
17914 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
17915 (sorry if you used them before).
17916
17917
17918 @menu
17919 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
17920 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
17921 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
17922 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
17923 @end menu
17924
17925 @node Diary Summary Line Format
17926 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
17927 @cindex diary summary buffer line
17928 @cindex diary summary line format
17929
17930 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
17931 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
17932 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
17933 see the event's date.
17934
17935 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
17936 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
17937 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
17938 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximate remaining time until the
17939 next occurrence of the event (e.g., ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
17940
17941 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
17942 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
17943 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
17944
17945 @example
17946 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
17947 @end example
17948
17949 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
17950 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
17951
17952 @lisp
17953 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
17954 @end lisp
17955
17956 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
17957 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
17958 with the following user options:
17959
17960 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
17961 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
17962 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
17963 diary groups'parameters.
17964 @end defvar
17965
17966 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
17967 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
17968 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
17969 @end defvar
17970
17971 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
17972 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
17973 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
17974 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
17975 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
17976 @end defvar
17977
17978 @node Diary Articles Sorting
17979 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
17980 @cindex diary articles sorting
17981 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
17982 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
17983 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
17984 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
17985
17986 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
17987 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
17988 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
17989 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
17990 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
17991
17992 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
17993 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
17994 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
17995 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
17996 Parameters}).
17997
17998 @node Diary Headers Generation
17999 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18000 @cindex diary headers generation
18001 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18002
18003 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18004 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18005 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18006 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18007 needed.
18008
18009 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18010 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18011 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18012 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18013 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18014
18015 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18016 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18017 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18018 instance.
18019
18020 @node Diary Group Parameters
18021 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18022 @cindex diary group parameters
18023
18024 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18025 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18026 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18027 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18028 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18029 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18030 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18031 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18032
18033 @node Sending or Not Sending
18034 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18035
18036 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18037 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18038
18039 @itemize @bullet
18040 @item
18041 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18042 messages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18043 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18044 sending the diary message to them as well.
18045 @item
18046 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18047 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18048 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18049 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18050 @end itemize
18051
18052 @node Gnus Unplugged
18053 @section Gnus Unplugged
18054 @cindex offline
18055 @cindex unplugged
18056 @cindex agent
18057 @cindex Gnus agent
18058 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18059
18060 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18061 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18062 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18063 read news. Believe it or not.
18064
18065 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18066 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18067 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18068 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18069 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18070
18071 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18072 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18073 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18074 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18075 reading news on a machine.
18076
18077 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18078 fact, you don't have to configure anything as the agent is now enabled
18079 by default (@pxref{Agent Variables, gnus-agent}).
18080
18081 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18082
18083 @menu
18084 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18085 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18086 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18087 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18088 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18089 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18090 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18091 * Agent and flags:: How the Agent maintains flags.
18092 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18093 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18094 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18095 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18096 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18097 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18098 @end menu
18099
18100
18101 @node Agent Basics
18102 @subsection Agent Basics
18103
18104 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18105
18106 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18107 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18108 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18109 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18110
18111 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18112 connected to the net continuously.
18113
18114 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18115 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18116
18117 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18118 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18119 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18120 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18121 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18122
18123 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18124 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18125 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18126 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18127 they're kinda like plugged always).
18128
18129 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18130 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18131 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18132 the culprit.
18133
18134 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18135 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18136 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18137 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18138 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18139
18140 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18141
18142 @itemize @bullet
18143
18144 @item
18145 @findex gnus-unplugged
18146 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18147 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18148 already fetched while in this mode.
18149
18150 @item
18151 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18152 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18153 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18154 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18155 Source Specifiers}).
18156
18157 @item
18158 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18159 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18160 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18161 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18162 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18163
18164 @item
18165 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18166 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18167 then you read the news offline.
18168
18169 @item
18170 And then you go to step 2.
18171 @end itemize
18172
18173 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18174 the Agent.
18175
18176 @itemize @bullet
18177
18178 @item
18179 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18180 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18181 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18182 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18183 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18184 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18185 no servers are agentized.
18186
18187 @item
18188 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18189 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18190 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18191 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18192
18193 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18194 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18195 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18196 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18197 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18198 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18199 configure them.
18200
18201 @item
18202 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18203 @end itemize
18204
18205
18206 @node Agent Categories
18207 @subsection Agent Categories
18208
18209 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18210 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18211 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18212 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18213 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18214 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18215 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18216
18217 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18218 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18219 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18220 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18221 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18222
18223 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18224 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18225 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18226 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18227 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18228 sink.
18229
18230 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18231 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18232 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18233 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18234 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18235 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18236 your settings.
18237
18238 @menu
18239 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18240 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18241 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18242 @end menu
18243
18244
18245 @node Category Syntax
18246 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18247
18248 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18249 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18250 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18251 listed below.
18252
18253 @cindex Agent Parameters
18254 @table @code
18255 @item agent-groups
18256 The list of groups that are in this category.
18257
18258 @item agent-predicate
18259 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18260 are eligible for downloading; and
18261
18262 @item agent-score
18263 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18264 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18265 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18266
18267 @item agent-enable-expiration
18268 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18269 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18270 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18271 only groups that should not be expired.
18272
18273 @item agent-days-until-old
18274 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18275 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18276
18277 @item agent-low-score
18278 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18279
18280 @item agent-high-score
18281 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18282
18283 @item agent-short-article
18284 an integer that overrides the value of
18285 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18286
18287 @item agent-long-article
18288 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18289
18290 @item agent-enable-undownloaded-faces
18291 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18292 undownloaded articles using the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face}
18293 faces. Any symbol other than @code{nil} will enable the use of
18294 undownloaded faces.
18295 @end table
18296
18297 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18298 created.
18299
18300 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18301 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18302 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18303 category.
18304
18305 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18306 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18307 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18308 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18309
18310 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18311 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18312 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18313
18314 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18315 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18316 operators sprinkled in between.
18317
18318 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18319
18320 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18321 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18322
18323 @lisp
18324 short
18325 @end lisp
18326
18327 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18328 short (for some value of ``short'').
18329
18330 Here's a more complex predicate:
18331
18332 @lisp
18333 (or high
18334 (and
18335 (not low)
18336 (not long)))
18337 @end lisp
18338
18339 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18340 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18341 drift.
18342
18343 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18344 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18345 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18346
18347 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18348 you want to do, you can write your own.
18349
18350 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18351 bound to the value determined by calling
18352 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18353 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18354 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18355 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18356 predicate to individual groups.
18357
18358 @table @code
18359 @item short
18360 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18361 lines; default 100.
18362
18363 @item long
18364 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18365 lines; default 200.
18366
18367 @item low
18368 True if the article has a download score less than
18369 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18370
18371 @item high
18372 True if the article has a download score greater than
18373 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18374
18375 @item spam
18376 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18377 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18378 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18379
18380 @item true
18381 Always true.
18382
18383 @item false
18384 Always false.
18385 @end table
18386
18387 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18388 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18389 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18390 useful values.
18391
18392 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18393 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g., posted
18394 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18395 something along the lines of the following:
18396
18397 @lisp
18398 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18399 "Say whether an article is old."
18400 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18401 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18402 @end lisp
18403
18404 with the predicate then defined as:
18405
18406 @lisp
18407 (not my-article-old-p)
18408 @end lisp
18409
18410 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18411 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18412 wherever.
18413
18414 @lisp
18415 (require 'gnus-agent)
18416 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18417 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18418 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18419 @end lisp
18420
18421 and simply specify your predicate as:
18422
18423 @lisp
18424 (not old)
18425 @end lisp
18426
18427 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18428 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18429 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18430 just don't give a damn.
18431
18432 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18433 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18434 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18435 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18436 parameters like so:
18437
18438 @lisp
18439 (agent-predicate . short)
18440 @end lisp
18441
18442 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18443 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18444 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18445
18446 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18447
18448 @lisp
18449 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18450 @end lisp
18451
18452 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18453 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18454 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18455
18456
18457 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18458 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18459 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18460 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18461 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18462 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18463
18464 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18465 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18466 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18467 if it's to be specific to that group.
18468
18469 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18470 three forms:
18471
18472 @enumerate
18473 @item
18474 Score rule
18475
18476 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18477 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18478
18479 example:
18480
18481 @itemize @bullet
18482 @item
18483 Category specification
18484
18485 @lisp
18486 (("from"
18487 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18488 ("lines"
18489 (500 -100 nil <)))
18490 @end lisp
18491
18492 @item
18493 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18494
18495 @lisp
18496 (agent-score ("from"
18497 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18498 ("lines"
18499 (500 -100 nil <)))
18500 @end lisp
18501
18502 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18503 @end itemize
18504
18505 @item
18506 Agent score file
18507
18508 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18509 keywords stated above.
18510
18511 example:
18512
18513 @itemize @bullet
18514 @item
18515 Category specification
18516
18517 @lisp
18518 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18519 @end lisp
18520
18521 or perhaps
18522
18523 @lisp
18524 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18525 @end lisp
18526
18527 @item
18528 Group Parameter specification
18529
18530 @lisp
18531 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18532 @end lisp
18533
18534 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18535 about parenthesis?
18536 @end itemize
18537
18538 @item
18539 Use @code{normal} score files
18540
18541 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18542 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18543 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18544 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18545
18546 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18547 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18548 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18549 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18550
18551 @itemize @bullet
18552 @item
18553 Category Specification
18554
18555 @lisp
18556 file
18557 @end lisp
18558
18559 @item
18560 Group Parameter specification
18561
18562 @lisp
18563 (agent-score . file)
18564 @end lisp
18565 @end itemize
18566 @end enumerate
18567
18568 @node Category Buffer
18569 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18570
18571 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18572 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18573 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18574
18575 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18576
18577 @table @kbd
18578 @item q
18579 @kindex q (Category)
18580 @findex gnus-category-exit
18581 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18582
18583 @item e
18584 @kindex e (Category)
18585 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18586 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18587 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18588
18589 @item k
18590 @kindex k (Category)
18591 @findex gnus-category-kill
18592 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18593
18594 @item c
18595 @kindex c (Category)
18596 @findex gnus-category-copy
18597 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18598
18599 @item a
18600 @kindex a (Category)
18601 @findex gnus-category-add
18602 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18603
18604 @item p
18605 @kindex p (Category)
18606 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18607 Edit the predicate of the current category
18608 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18609
18610 @item g
18611 @kindex g (Category)
18612 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18613 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18614 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18615
18616 @item s
18617 @kindex s (Category)
18618 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18619 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18620 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18621
18622 @item l
18623 @kindex l (Category)
18624 @findex gnus-category-list
18625 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18626 @end table
18627
18628
18629 @node Category Variables
18630 @subsubsection Category Variables
18631
18632 @table @code
18633 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18634 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18635 Hook run in category buffers.
18636
18637 @item gnus-category-line-format
18638 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18639 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18640 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18641
18642 @table @samp
18643 @item c
18644 The name of the category.
18645
18646 @item g
18647 The number of groups in the category.
18648 @end table
18649
18650 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18651 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18652 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18653
18654 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18655 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18656 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18657
18658 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18659 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18660 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18661
18662 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18663 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18664 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18665 0.
18666
18667 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18668 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18669 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18670 0.
18671
18672 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18673 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18674 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18675 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18676 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18677 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18678 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18679 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18680 read.
18681 Default 7.
18682
18683 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18684 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18685 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18686 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18687 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18688 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18689 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18690
18691 @end table
18692
18693
18694 @node Agent Commands
18695 @subsection Agent Commands
18696 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18697 @kindex J j (Agent)
18698
18699 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18700 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
18701 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
18702
18703
18704 @menu
18705 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
18706 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
18707 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
18708 @end menu
18709
18710
18711
18712
18713 @node Group Agent Commands
18714 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
18715
18716 @table @kbd
18717 @item J u
18718 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
18719 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
18720 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
18721 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
18722
18723 @item J c
18724 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
18725 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
18726 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
18727
18728 @item J s
18729 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
18730 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
18731 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
18732 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
18733
18734 @item J S
18735 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
18736 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
18737 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
18738 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
18739
18740 @item J a
18741 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
18742 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
18743 Add the current group to an Agent category
18744 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
18745 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18746
18747 @item J r
18748 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
18749 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
18750 Remove the current group from its category, if any
18751 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
18752 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
18753
18754 @item J Y
18755 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
18756 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
18757 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
18758
18759
18760 @end table
18761
18762
18763 @node Summary Agent Commands
18764 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
18765
18766 @table @kbd
18767 @item J #
18768 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
18769 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
18770 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
18771
18772 @item J M-#
18773 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
18774 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
18775 Remove the downloading mark from the article
18776 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
18777
18778 @cindex %
18779 @item @@
18780 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
18781 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
18782 Toggle whether to download the article
18783 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
18784 default.
18785
18786 @item J c
18787 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
18788 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
18789 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
18790
18791 @item J S
18792 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
18793 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
18794 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
18795 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
18796
18797 @item J s
18798 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
18799 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series
18800 Download all processable articles in this group.
18801 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-series}).
18802
18803 @item J u
18804 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
18805 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
18806 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
18807 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
18808
18809 @end table
18810
18811
18812 @node Server Agent Commands
18813 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
18814
18815 @table @kbd
18816 @item J a
18817 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
18818 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
18819 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
18820 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
18821
18822 @item J r
18823 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
18824 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
18825 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
18826 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
18827
18828 @end table
18829
18830
18831 @node Agent Visuals
18832 @subsection Agent Visuals
18833
18834 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
18835 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
18836 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
18837 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
18838 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
18839 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
18840 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
18841 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
18842 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
18843 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
18844
18845 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
18846 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
18847 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
18848 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
18849 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
18850 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
18851 the download status of each article so that you always know which
18852 articles will be available when unplugged.
18853
18854 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
18855 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
18856 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
18857 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
18858 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
18859 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
18860 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
18861 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
18862
18863 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
18864 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
18865 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
18866 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
18867 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
18868 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
18869 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
18870 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
18871 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
18872
18873 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
18874 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
18875 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
18876 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
18877 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear. For those
18878 users using the agent to improve online performance by caching the NOV
18879 database (most users since 5.10.2), the undownloaded faces may appear
18880 to be an absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since none
18881 of their articles have been fetched into the Agent, all of the
18882 normal faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces.
18883
18884 If you would like to use the undownloaded faces, you must enable the
18885 undownloaded faces by setting the @code{agent-enable-undownloaded-faces}
18886 group parameter to @code{t}. This parameter, like all other agent
18887 parameters, may be set on an Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}),
18888 a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic Parameters}), or an individual group
18889 (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
18890
18891 The one problem common to all users using the agent is how quickly it
18892 can consume disk space. If you using the agent on many groups, it is
18893 even more difficult to effectively recover disk space. One solution
18894 is the @samp{%F} format available in @code{gnus-group-line-format}.
18895 This format will display the actual disk space used by articles
18896 fetched into both the agent and cache. By knowing which groups use
18897 the most space, users know where to focus their efforts when ``agent
18898 expiring'' articles.
18899
18900 @node Agent as Cache
18901 @subsection Agent as Cache
18902
18903 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
18904 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
18905 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
18906 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
18907 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
18908 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
18909 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
18910 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
18911 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
18912
18913 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
18914 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
18915 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
18916 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
18917 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
18918
18919 @node Agent Expiry
18920 @subsection Agent Expiry
18921
18922 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18923 @findex gnus-agent-expire
18924 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
18925 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
18926 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
18927 @cindex agent expiry
18928 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
18929 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
18930
18931 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
18932 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
18933 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
18934 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
18935 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
18936 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
18937 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
18938 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
18939
18940 Note that other functions might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you
18941 to keep the agent synchronized with the group.
18942
18943 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
18944 prevent expiration in selected groups.
18945
18946 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
18947 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
18948 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
18949 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
18950 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
18951 be kept indefinitely.
18952
18953 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
18954 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
18955 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
18956 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
18957
18958 @node Agent Regeneration
18959 @subsection Agent Regeneration
18960
18961 @cindex agent regeneration
18962 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
18963 @cindex regeneration
18964
18965 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
18966 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
18967 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
18968 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
18969 internal inconsistencies.
18970
18971 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
18972 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
18973 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
18974 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
18975 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
18976 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
18977
18978 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
18979 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
18980 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
18981 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
18982 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
18983 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
18984
18985 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18986 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
18987 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
18988 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
18989 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
18990 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
18991 agent as unread.
18992
18993 @node Agent and flags
18994 @subsection Agent and flags
18995
18996 The Agent works with any Gnus back end including those, such as
18997 nnimap, that store flags (read, ticked, etc.)@: on the server. Sadly,
18998 the Agent does not actually know which backends keep their flags in
18999 the backend server rather than in @file{.newsrc}. This means that the
19000 Agent, while unplugged or disconnected, will always record all changes
19001 to the flags in its own files.
19002
19003 When you plug back in, Gnus will then check to see if you have any
19004 changed any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the
19005 server. This behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19006
19007 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19008 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19009 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19010 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19011 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19012 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19013
19014 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19015 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19016 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19017 in the group buffer.
19018
19019 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19020 all local flags to the server, but rather by incrementally updated the
19021 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19022 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group then
19023 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19024 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19025 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19026 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19027
19028 @node Agent and IMAP
19029 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19030
19031 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19032 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19033 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19034 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19035
19036 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19037 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19038
19039 @itemize @bullet
19040
19041 @item
19042 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19043
19044 @item
19045 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19046
19047 @end itemize
19048
19049 @node Outgoing Messages
19050 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19051
19052 By default, when Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail
19053 and news) are stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}).
19054 You can view them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19055
19056 You can control the circumstances under which outgoing mail is queued
19057 (see @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail}, @pxref{Agent Variables}). Outgoing
19058 news is always queued when Gnus is unplugged, and never otherwise.
19059
19060 You can send the messages either from the draft group with the special
19061 commands available there, or you can use the @kbd{J S} command in the
19062 group buffer to send all the sendable messages in the draft group.
19063 Posting news will only work when Gnus is plugged, but you can send
19064 mail at any time.
19065
19066 If sending mail while unplugged does not work for you and you worry
19067 about hitting @kbd{J S} by accident when unplugged, you can have Gnus
19068 ask you to confirm your action (see
19069 @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue}, @pxref{Agent Variables}).
19070
19071 @node Agent Variables
19072 @subsection Agent Variables
19073
19074 @table @code
19075 @item gnus-agent
19076 @vindex gnus-agent
19077 Is the agent enabled? The default is @code{t}. When first enabled,
19078 the agent will use @code{gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods} to
19079 automatically mark some back ends as agentized. You may change which
19080 back ends are agentized using the agent commands in the server buffer.
19081
19082 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
19083 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
19084
19085
19086 @item gnus-agent-directory
19087 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19088 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19089 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19090
19091 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19092 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19093 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19094 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19095 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19096 by default.
19097
19098 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19099 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19100 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19101
19102 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19103 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19104 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19105
19106 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19107 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19108 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19109
19110 @item gnus-agent-cache
19111 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19112 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19113 articles when plugged, e.g., essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19114 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19115
19116 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19117 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19118 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19119 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19120 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19121 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19122 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19123 online status.
19124
19125 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19126 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19127 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19128 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19129 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19130 read. The default is @code{t}.
19131
19132 @item gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19133 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19134 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19135 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19136 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19137 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19138 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19139
19140 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19141 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19142 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19143 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19144 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19145 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19146 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19147 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19148 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19149 over and over again.
19150
19151 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19152 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19153 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19154 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19155 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19156 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19157 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19158 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19159 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19160 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19161 However, all articles parsed prior to losing the connection will be
19162 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19163 see any cycling.
19164
19165 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19166 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19167 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19168 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19169 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19170 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19171 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19172 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19173 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19174
19175 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19176 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19177 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19178 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19179 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19180 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19181
19182 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19183 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19184 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19185 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19186 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19187
19188 @item gnus-agent-queue-mail
19189 @vindex gnus-agent-queue-mail
19190 When @code{gnus-agent-queue-mail} is @code{always}, Gnus will always
19191 queue mail rather than sending it straight away. When @code{t}, Gnus
19192 will queue mail when unplugged only. When @code{nil}, never queue
19193 mail. The default is @code{t}.
19194
19195 @item gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19196 @vindex gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue
19197 When @code{gnus-agent-prompt-send-queue} is non-@code{nil} Gnus will
19198 prompt you to confirm that you really wish to proceed if you hit
19199 @kbd{J S} while unplugged. The default is @code{nil}.
19200
19201 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19202 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19203 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19204 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19205 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19206 which back ends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19207 to agentize remote back ends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19208 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19209 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19210 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19211 start Gnus. The default is @samp{nil}.
19212
19213 @end table
19214
19215
19216 @node Example Setup
19217 @subsection Example Setup
19218
19219 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19220 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19221 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19222
19223 @lisp
19224 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19225 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19226 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19227
19228 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19229 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19230 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19231
19232 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19233 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19234
19235 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19236 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19237 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19238 @end lisp
19239
19240 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19241 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19242 gnus}.
19243
19244 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19245 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19246 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19247 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19248 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19249 once.
19250
19251 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19252 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19253 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19254 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19255 back all the killed groups.)
19256
19257 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19258 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19259 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19260
19261
19262 @node Batching Agents
19263 @subsection Batching Agents
19264 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19265
19266 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19267 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19268 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19269
19270 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19271 following incantation:
19272
19273 @example
19274 #!/bin/sh
19275 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19276 @end example
19277
19278
19279 @node Agent Caveats
19280 @subsection Agent Caveats
19281
19282 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19283 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19284 may ask:
19285
19286 @table @dfn
19287 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19288
19289 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19290 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19291 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19292
19293 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19294 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19295
19296 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19297
19298 @end table
19299
19300 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19301 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19302 locally stored articles.
19303
19304
19305 @node Scoring
19306 @chapter Scoring
19307 @cindex scoring
19308
19309 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19310 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19311 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19312 attention!
19313
19314 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19315 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19316 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19317 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19318 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19319
19320 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19321 before generating the summary buffer.
19322
19323 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19324 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19325 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19326
19327 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19328 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19329 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19330 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19331
19332 @menu
19333 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19334 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19335 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19336 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19337 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19338 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19339 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19340 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19341 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19342 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19343 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19344 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19345 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19346 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19347 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19348 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19349 @end menu
19350
19351
19352 @node Summary Score Commands
19353 @section Summary Score Commands
19354 @cindex score commands
19355
19356 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19357 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19358 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19359 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19360 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19361
19362 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19363 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19364 some other score file (e.g., @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19365 score file the current one.
19366
19367 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19368
19369 @table @kbd
19370
19371 @item V s
19372 @kindex V s (Summary)
19373 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19374 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19375
19376 @item V S
19377 @kindex V S (Summary)
19378 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19379 Display the score of the current article
19380 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19381
19382 @item V t
19383 @kindex V t (Summary)
19384 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19385 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19386 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19387 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19388 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19389 score file and edit it.
19390
19391 @item V w
19392 @kindex V w (Summary)
19393 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19394 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19395
19396 @item V R
19397 @kindex V R (Summary)
19398 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19399 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19400 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19401 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19402 effect you're having.
19403
19404 @item V c
19405 @kindex V c (Summary)
19406 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19407 Make a different score file the current
19408 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19409
19410 @item V e
19411 @kindex V e (Summary)
19412 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19413 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19414 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19415 File Editing}).
19416
19417 @item V f
19418 @kindex V f (Summary)
19419 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19420 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19421 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19422
19423 @item V F
19424 @kindex V F (Summary)
19425 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19426 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19427 after editing score files.
19428
19429 @item V C
19430 @kindex V C (Summary)
19431 @findex gnus-score-customize
19432 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19433 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19434
19435 @end table
19436
19437 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19438
19439 @table @kbd
19440
19441 @item V m
19442 @kindex V m (Summary)
19443 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19444 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19445 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19446
19447 @item V x
19448 @kindex V x (Summary)
19449 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19450 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19451 expunge all articles below this score
19452 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19453 @end table
19454
19455 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19456 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19457 them.)
19458
19459 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19460 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19461
19462 @enumerate
19463 @item
19464 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19465 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19466 @item
19467 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19468 keys are available:
19469 @table @kbd
19470
19471 @item a
19472 Score on the author name.
19473
19474 @item s
19475 Score on the subject line.
19476
19477 @item x
19478 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19479
19480 @item r
19481 Score on the @code{References} line.
19482
19483 @item d
19484 Score on the date.
19485
19486 @item l
19487 Score on the number of lines.
19488
19489 @item i
19490 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19491
19492 @item e
19493 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19494 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19495
19496 @item f
19497 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19498 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19499 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19500
19501 @item b
19502 Score on the body.
19503
19504 @item h
19505 Score on the head.
19506
19507 @item t
19508 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19509 files.)
19510
19511 @end table
19512
19513 @item
19514 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19515 what headers you are scoring on.
19516
19517 @table @code
19518
19519 @item strings
19520
19521 @table @kbd
19522
19523 @item e
19524 Exact matching.
19525
19526 @item s
19527 Substring matching.
19528
19529 @item f
19530 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19531
19532 @item r
19533 Regexp matching
19534 @end table
19535
19536 @item date
19537 @table @kbd
19538
19539 @item b
19540 Before date.
19541
19542 @item a
19543 After date.
19544
19545 @item n
19546 This date.
19547 @end table
19548
19549 @item number
19550 @table @kbd
19551
19552 @item <
19553 Less than number.
19554
19555 @item =
19556 Equal to number.
19557
19558 @item >
19559 Greater than number.
19560 @end table
19561 @end table
19562
19563 @item
19564 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19565 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19566 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19567 file.
19568 @table @kbd
19569
19570 @item t
19571 Temporary score entry.
19572
19573 @item p
19574 Permanent score entry.
19575
19576 @item i
19577 Immediately scoring.
19578 @end table
19579
19580 @item
19581 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19582 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19583 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19584
19585 @end enumerate
19586
19587 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19588 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19589 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19590 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19591
19592 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19593 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19594 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19595 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19596 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19597
19598 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19599 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19600 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19601 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19602 current score file.
19603
19604 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19605 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19606 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19607
19608
19609 @node Group Score Commands
19610 @section Group Score Commands
19611 @cindex group score commands
19612
19613 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19614
19615 @table @kbd
19616
19617 @item W e
19618 @kindex W e (Group)
19619 @findex gnus-score-edit-all-score
19620 Edit the apply-to-all-groups all.SCORE file. You will be popped into
19621 a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score File Editing}).
19622
19623 @item W f
19624 @kindex W f (Group)
19625 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19626 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19627 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19628 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19629
19630 @end table
19631
19632 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19633
19634 @findex gnus-batch-score
19635 @cindex batch scoring
19636 @example
19637 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19638 @end example
19639
19640
19641 @node Score Variables
19642 @section Score Variables
19643 @cindex score variables
19644
19645 @table @code
19646
19647 @item gnus-use-scoring
19648 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19649 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19650 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19651
19652 @item gnus-kill-killed
19653 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19654 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19655 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19656 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19657 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19658 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19659 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19660
19661 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19662 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19663 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19664 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19665 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19666
19667 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19668 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19669 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19670 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19671
19672 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19673 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19674 @cindex score cache
19675 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19676 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19677 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19678 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19679 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19680 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19681 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19682 be cached.
19683
19684 @item gnus-save-score
19685 @vindex gnus-save-score
19686 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19687 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19688 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19689
19690 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19691 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19692 across group visits.
19693
19694 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19695 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19696 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19697 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19698 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19699 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19700 manually entered data.
19701
19702 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19703 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19704 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19705
19706 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19707 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19708 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19709 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19710 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19711 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19712
19713 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19714 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19715 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19716 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19717
19718 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19719 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19720 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19721 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19722
19723 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19724 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19725 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19726 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19727
19728 Predefined functions available are:
19729 @table @code
19730
19731 @item gnus-score-find-single
19732 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19733 Only apply the group's own score file.
19734
19735 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19736 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19737 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19738 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19739 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19740 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19741 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19742 then a regexp match is done.
19743
19744 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19745 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19746
19747 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19748 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19749 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19750 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19751
19752 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19753 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19754 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
19755 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
19756 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
19757 server.
19758
19759 @end table
19760 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
19761 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
19762 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
19763 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
19764 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
19765 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
19766 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
19767 Phu.
19768
19769 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
19770 overall score file, you could use the value
19771 @example
19772 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
19773 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
19774 @end example
19775
19776 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
19777 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
19778 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
19779 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
19780 are expired. It's 7 by default.
19781
19782 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19783 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
19784 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
19785 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
19786 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
19787 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
19788 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
19789 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
19790
19791 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19792 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
19793 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
19794
19795 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
19796 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
19797 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
19798 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
19799 threading---according to the current value of
19800 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
19801 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
19802 simplified in this manner.
19803
19804 @end table
19805
19806
19807 @node Score File Format
19808 @section Score File Format
19809 @cindex score file format
19810
19811 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
19812 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
19813 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
19814
19815 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
19816
19817 @lisp
19818 (("from"
19819 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
19820 ("Per Abrahamsen")
19821 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
19822 ("subject"
19823 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
19824 ("xref"
19825 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
19826 ("lines"
19827 (2 -100 nil <))
19828 (mark 0)
19829 (expunge -1000)
19830 (mark-and-expunge -10)
19831 (read-only nil)
19832 (orphan -10)
19833 (adapt t)
19834 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
19835 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
19836 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
19837 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
19838 (eval (ding)))
19839 @end lisp
19840
19841 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
19842 Scoring}, for a different approach.
19843
19844 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
19845 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
19846 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
19847
19848 Six keys are supported by this alist:
19849
19850 @table @code
19851
19852 @item STRING
19853 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
19854 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
19855 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
19856 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
19857 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
19858 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
19859 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
19860 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
19861 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
19862 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
19863 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
19864 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
19865 to articles that matches these score entries.
19866
19867 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
19868 score entry has one to four elements.
19869 @enumerate
19870
19871 @item
19872 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
19873 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
19874 integer.
19875
19876 @item
19877 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
19878 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
19879 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
19880 is successful. If this element is not present, the
19881 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
19882 instead. This is 1000 by default.
19883
19884 @item
19885 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
19886 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
19887 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
19888 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
19889 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
19890
19891 @item
19892 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
19893 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
19894 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
19895 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
19896 @table @dfn
19897
19898 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
19899 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
19900 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
19901 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
19902 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
19903 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
19904 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
19905 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
19906 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
19907 instead, if you feel like.
19908
19909 @item Extra
19910 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
19911 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
19912 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
19913 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
19914 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
19915 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
19916 overviews:
19917
19918 @lisp
19919 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
19920 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
19921 @end lisp
19922
19923 @item Lines, Chars
19924 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
19925 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
19926
19927 These predicates are true if
19928
19929 @example
19930 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
19931 @end example
19932
19933 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
19934 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
19935 following form:
19936
19937 @lisp
19938 (< header-value 4)
19939 @end lisp
19940
19941 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
19942 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
19943 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
19944 it's not. I think.)
19945
19946 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
19947 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
19948 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
19949 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
19950
19951 @item Date
19952 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
19953 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
19954 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
19955 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
19956 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
19957 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
19958 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
19959
19960 @cindex ISO8601
19961 @cindex date
19962 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
19963 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
19964 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
19965 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
19966 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
19967 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
19968 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
19969 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
19970 whole family, eh?)
19971
19972 @item Head, Body, All
19973 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc.)@:
19974 header uses.
19975
19976 @item Followup
19977 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
19978 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
19979 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
19980 you to increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
19981 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
19982 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
19983 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
19984 files.)
19985
19986 @item Thread
19987 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
19988 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
19989 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
19990 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
19991 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
19992 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
19993 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
19994 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
19995 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
19996 nondeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
19997 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
19998 @end table
19999 @end enumerate
20000
20001 @cindex score file atoms
20002 @item mark
20003 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20004 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20005
20006 @item expunge
20007 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20008 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20009
20010 @item mark-and-expunge
20011 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20012 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20013 summary buffer.
20014
20015 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20016 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20017 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20018 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20019 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20020
20021 @item files
20022 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20023 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20024 this one was.
20025
20026 @item exclude-files
20027 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20028 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20029 other.
20030
20031 @item eval
20032 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}ed. This element will be
20033 ignored when handling global score files.
20034
20035 @item read-only
20036 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20037 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20038 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20039 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20040
20041 @item orphan
20042 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20043 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20044 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20045 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20046
20047 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20048
20049 @example
20050 (orphan -500)
20051 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20052 @end example
20053
20054 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20055 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20056 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{c y}) the
20057 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20058 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20059
20060 I.e., the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20061 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20062 scoring rules exist.
20063
20064 @item adapt
20065 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20066 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20067 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20068 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20069 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20070 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20071 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20072 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20073 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20074 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20075 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20076 it.
20077
20078 @item adapt-file
20079 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20080 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20081 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20082 file for a number of groups.
20083
20084 @item local
20085 @cindex local variables
20086 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20087 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20088 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20089 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20090 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20091 be evaluated.
20092 @end table
20093
20094
20095 @node Score File Editing
20096 @section Score File Editing
20097
20098 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20099 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20100 with a mode for that.
20101
20102 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20103 additional commands:
20104
20105 @table @kbd
20106
20107 @item C-c C-c
20108 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20109 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20110 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20111 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20112
20113 @item C-c C-d
20114 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20115 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20116 Insert the current date in numerical format
20117 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20118 you were wondering.
20119
20120 @item C-c C-p
20121 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20122 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20123 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20124 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20125 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20126 you.
20127
20128 @end table
20129
20130 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20131
20132 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20133 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20134
20135 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20136 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20137
20138
20139 @node Adaptive Scoring
20140 @section Adaptive Scoring
20141 @cindex adaptive scoring
20142
20143 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20144 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20145 stupidity, to be precise.
20146
20147 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20148 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20149 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20150 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20151 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20152 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20153 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20154 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20155 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20156
20157 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20158 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20159 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20160 might look something like this:
20161
20162 @lisp
20163 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20164 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20165 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20166 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20167 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20168 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20169 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20170 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20171 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20172 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20173 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20174 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20175 @end lisp
20176
20177 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20178 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20179 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20180 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20181 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20182 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20183 entries.
20184
20185 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20186 will be applied to each article.
20187
20188 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20189 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20190 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20191 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20192
20193 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20194 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20195 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20196 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20197
20198 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20199 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20200 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20201 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20202
20203 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20204 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20205 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20206 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20207 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20208 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20209
20210 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20211 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20212 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20213
20214 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20215 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20216 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20217
20218 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20219 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20220 let you use different rules in different groups.
20221
20222 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20223 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20224 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20225 is @file{ADAPT}.
20226
20227 @vindex gnus-adaptive-pretty-print
20228 Adaptive score files can get huge and are not meant to be edited by
20229 human hands. If @code{gnus-adaptive-pretty-print} is @code{nil} (the
20230 default) those files will not be written in a human readable way.
20231
20232 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20233 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20234 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20235 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20236 the length of the match is less than
20237 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20238 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20239 this problem.
20240
20241 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20242 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20243 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20244 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20245 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20246
20247 @lisp
20248 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20249 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20250 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20251 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20252 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20253 @end lisp
20254
20255 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20256 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20257 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20258 score with 30 points.
20259
20260 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20261 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20262 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20263 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20264 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20265
20266 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20267 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20268 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20269 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20270 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20271
20272 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20273 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20274 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20275 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20276
20277 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20278 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20279 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20280 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20281
20282 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20283 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20284 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20285 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20286 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20287
20288 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20289 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20290 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20291
20292 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20293 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20294 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20295 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20296
20297
20298 @node Home Score File
20299 @section Home Score File
20300
20301 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20302 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20303 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20304 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20305
20306 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20307 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20308 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20309
20310 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20311 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20312 be:
20313
20314 @enumerate
20315 @item
20316 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20317 groups.
20318
20319 @item
20320 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20321 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20322 parameter.
20323
20324 @item
20325 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20326
20327 @enumerate
20328 @item
20329 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20330 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20331
20332 @item
20333 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20334 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20335 name of the group as the parameter.
20336
20337 @item
20338 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20339 @end enumerate
20340
20341 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20342 for matches.
20343
20344 @end enumerate
20345
20346 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20347
20348 @lisp
20349 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20350 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20351 @end lisp
20352
20353 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20354 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20355
20356 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20357 @lisp
20358 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20359 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20360 @end lisp
20361
20362 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20363 Other functions include
20364
20365 @table @code
20366 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20367 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20368 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20369 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20370
20371 @end table
20372
20373 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20374 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20375 their own home score files:
20376
20377 @lisp
20378 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20379 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20380 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20381 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20382 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20383 @end lisp
20384
20385 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20386 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20387 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20388 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20389 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20390
20391 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20392 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20393 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20394 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20395 precedence over this variable.
20396
20397
20398 @node Followups To Yourself
20399 @section Followups To Yourself
20400
20401 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20402 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20403 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20404 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20405 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20406 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20407
20408 @table @code
20409
20410 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20411 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20412 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20413 article.
20414
20415 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20416 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20417 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20418 your own article.
20419 @end table
20420
20421 @vindex message-sent-hook
20422 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20423 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20424 @lisp
20425 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20426 @end lisp
20427
20428
20429 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20430 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20431 mine:
20432
20433 @example
20434 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20435 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20436 @end example
20437
20438 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20439 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20440 myself:
20441
20442 @lisp
20443 ("references"
20444 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20445 1000 nil r))
20446 @end lisp
20447
20448 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20449 is system-dependent.
20450
20451
20452 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20453 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20454 @cindex scoring on other headers
20455
20456 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20457 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20458 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20459 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20460 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20461
20462 @vindex gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring
20463 You can inhibit this slow scoring on headers or body by setting the
20464 variable @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring}. If
20465 @code{gnus-inhibit-slow-scoring} is regexp, slow scoring is inhibited if
20466 the group matches the regexp. If it is t, slow scoring on it is
20467 inhibited for all groups.
20468
20469 Now, there's not much you can do about the slowness for news groups, but for
20470 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20471 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20472 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20473 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20474
20475 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20476
20477 @lisp
20478 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20479 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20480 @end lisp
20481
20482 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20483 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20484 time if you have much mail.
20485
20486 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20487 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20488
20489 See? Simple.
20490
20491
20492 @node Scoring Tips
20493 @section Scoring Tips
20494 @cindex scoring tips
20495
20496 @table @dfn
20497
20498 @item Crossposts
20499 @cindex crossposts
20500 @cindex scoring crossposts
20501 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20502 the @code{Xref} header.
20503 @lisp
20504 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20505 @end lisp
20506
20507 @item Multiple crossposts
20508 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20509 more than, say, 3 groups:
20510 @lisp
20511 ("xref"
20512 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20513 -1000 nil r))
20514 @end lisp
20515
20516 @item Matching on the body
20517 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20518 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20519 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20520 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20521 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20522 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20523 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20524 the matches.
20525
20526 @item Marking as read
20527 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20528 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20529 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20530 @lisp
20531 ((mark -100))
20532 @end lisp
20533 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20534
20535 @item Negated character classes
20536 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20537 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20538 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20539 @end table
20540
20541
20542 @node Reverse Scoring
20543 @section Reverse Scoring
20544 @cindex reverse scoring
20545
20546 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20547 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20548 like this in your score file:
20549
20550 @lisp
20551 (("subject"
20552 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20553 (mark 1)
20554 (expunge 1))
20555 @end lisp
20556
20557 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20558 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20559
20560
20561 @node Global Score Files
20562 @section Global Score Files
20563 @cindex global score files
20564
20565 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20566 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20567 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20568
20569 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20570 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20571 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20572
20573 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20574 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20575 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20576 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20577 files are applicable to which group.
20578
20579 To use the score file
20580 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20581 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20582 say this:
20583
20584 @lisp
20585 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20586 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20587 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20588 @end lisp
20589
20590 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20591 @noindent
20592 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20593 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20594 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20595 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20596
20597 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20598 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20599
20600 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20601 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20602 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20603 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20604 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20605 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20606
20607 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20608 head:
20609
20610 @itemize @bullet
20611
20612 @item
20613 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20614 @item
20615 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20616 @item
20617 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20618 @item
20619 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20620 lowered out of existence.
20621 @item
20622 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20623 articles completely.
20624
20625 @item
20626 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20627 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20628 old articles for a long time.
20629 @end itemize
20630
20631 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20632 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20633 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20634 holding our breath yet?
20635
20636
20637 @node Kill Files
20638 @section Kill Files
20639 @cindex kill files
20640
20641 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20642 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20643 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20644
20645 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20646 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20647 files into score files.
20648
20649 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20650 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20651 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20652 that isn't a very good idea.
20653
20654 Normal kill files look like this:
20655
20656 @lisp
20657 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20658 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20659 (gnus-expunge "X")
20660 @end lisp
20661
20662 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20663 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20664
20665 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20666 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20667 interpreting it.
20668
20669 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20670
20671 @table @kbd
20672
20673 @item M-k
20674 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20675 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20676 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20677
20678 @item M-K
20679 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20680 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20681 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20682 @end table
20683
20684 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20685
20686 @table @kbd
20687
20688 @item M-k
20689 @kindex M-k (Group)
20690 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20691 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20692
20693 @item M-K
20694 @kindex M-K (Group)
20695 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20696 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20697 @end table
20698
20699 Kill file variables:
20700
20701 @table @code
20702 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20703 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20704 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20705 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20706 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20707 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20708 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20709
20710 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20711 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20712 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20713 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20714 kills.
20715
20716 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20717 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20718 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20719 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20720 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20721 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20722 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20723 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20724 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20725
20726 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20727 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20728 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20729
20730 @end table
20731
20732
20733 @node Converting Kill Files
20734 @section Converting Kill Files
20735 @cindex kill files
20736 @cindex converting kill files
20737
20738 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20739 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20740 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20741 by hand.
20742
20743 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Emacs by default.
20744 You can fetch it from the contrib directory of the Gnus distribution or
20745 from
20746 @uref{http://heim.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20747
20748 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20749 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20750 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20751 before.
20752
20753
20754 @node Advanced Scoring
20755 @section Advanced Scoring
20756
20757 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
20758 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
20759 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
20760 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
20761 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
20762
20763 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
20764 scoring patterns.
20765
20766 @menu
20767 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
20768 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
20769 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
20770 @end menu
20771
20772
20773 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
20774 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
20775
20776 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
20777 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
20778 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
20779 non-@code{nil} value.
20780
20781 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
20782 operator, and various match operators.
20783
20784 Logical operators:
20785
20786 @table @code
20787 @item &
20788 @itemx and
20789 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20790 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
20791 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
20792 @code{true}.
20793
20794 @item |
20795 @itemx or
20796 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
20797 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
20798 then this operator will return @code{false}.
20799
20800 @item !
20801 @itemx not
20802 @itemx ¬
20803 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
20804 logical negation of the value of its argument.
20805
20806 @end table
20807
20808 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
20809 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
20810 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
20811 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
20812 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
20813 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
20814 the ancestry you want to go.
20815
20816 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
20817 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
20818 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
20819 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
20820 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
20821
20822
20823 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
20824 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
20825
20826 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
20827 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
20828 of parentheses.
20829
20830 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
20831 when he's talking about Gnus:
20832
20833 @example
20834 @group
20835 ((&
20836 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20837 ("subject" "Gnus"))
20838 1000)
20839 @end group
20840 @end example
20841
20842 Quite simple, huh?
20843
20844 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
20845
20846 @example
20847 ((&
20848 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20849 (|
20850 ("subject" "Gnus")
20851 ("lines" 100 >)))
20852 1000)
20853 @end example
20854
20855 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
20856 really don't want to read what he's written:
20857
20858 @example
20859 ((&
20860 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20861 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
20862 -100000)
20863 @end example
20864
20865 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
20866 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
20867 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
20868 very interesting:
20869
20870 @example
20871 ((&
20872 (1-
20873 (&
20874 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
20875 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
20876 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
20877 ("body" "white.*socks"))
20878 1000)
20879 @end example
20880
20881 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
20882 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
20883 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
20884 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
20885
20886 @example
20887 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20888 -200)
20889 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
20890 200)
20891 @end example
20892
20893 The possibilities are endless.
20894
20895 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
20896 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
20897
20898 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
20899 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
20900 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
20901 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
20902 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
20903 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
20904 @samp{subject}) first.
20905
20906 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
20907 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
20908 something like:
20909
20910 @example
20911 ...
20912 (1-
20913 (1-
20914 ("from" "lars")))
20915 ...
20916 @end example
20917
20918 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
20919 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
20920
20921 @example
20922 (1-
20923 (&
20924 ("from" "Lars")
20925 ("subject" "Gnus")))
20926 @end example
20927
20928 than it is to say:
20929
20930 @example
20931 (&
20932 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
20933 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
20934 @end example
20935
20936
20937 @node Score Decays
20938 @section Score Decays
20939 @cindex score decays
20940 @cindex decays
20941
20942 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
20943 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
20944 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
20945 use them in any sensible way.
20946
20947 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
20948 @findex gnus-decay-score
20949 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
20950 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
20951 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
20952 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
20953 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
20954 If @code{gnus-decay-scores} is a regexp, only score files matching this
20955 regexp are treated. E.g., you may set it to @samp{\\.ADAPT\\'} if only
20956 @emph{adaptive} score files should be decayed. The decay itself if
20957 performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function} function, which is
20958 @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the definition of that
20959 function:
20960
20961 @lisp
20962 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
20963 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
20964 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
20965 (let ((n (- score
20966 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
20967 (min (abs score)
20968 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
20969 (* (abs score)
20970 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
20971 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
20972 ;; XEmacs's floor can handle only the floating point
20973 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
20974 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
20975 (string-to-number
20976 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
20977 (floor n))))
20978 @end lisp
20979
20980 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
20981 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
20982 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
20983 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
20984
20985 @enumerate
20986 @item
20987 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
20988
20989 @item
20990 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
20991
20992 @item
20993 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
20994 score.
20995 @end enumerate
20996
20997 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
20998 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
20999 the new score, which should be an integer.
21000
21001 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21002 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21003
21004 @node Searching
21005 @chapter Searching
21006 @cindex searching
21007
21008 FIXME: Add a brief overview of Gnus search capabilities. A brief
21009 comparison of nnir, nnmairix, contrib/gnus-namazu would be nice
21010 as well.
21011
21012 This chapter describes tools for searching groups and servers for
21013 articles matching a query and then retrieving those articles. Gnus
21014 provides a simpler mechanism for searching through articles in a summary buffer
21015 to find those matching a pattern. @xref{Searching for Articles}.
21016
21017 @menu
21018 * nnir:: Searching with various engines.
21019 * nnmairix:: Searching with Mairix.
21020 @end menu
21021
21022 @node nnir
21023 @section nnir
21024 @cindex nnir
21025
21026 This section describes how to use @code{nnir} to search for articles
21027 within gnus.
21028
21029 @menu
21030 * What is nnir?:: What does @code{nnir} do?
21031 * Basic Usage:: How to perform simple searches.
21032 * Setting up nnir:: How to set up @code{nnir}.
21033 @end menu
21034
21035 @node What is nnir?
21036 @subsection What is nnir?
21037
21038 @code{nnir} is a Gnus interface to a number of tools for searching
21039 through mail and news repositories. Different backends (like
21040 @code{nnimap} and @code{nntp}) work with different tools (called
21041 @dfn{engines} in @code{nnir} lingo), but all use the same basic search
21042 interface.
21043
21044 The @code{nnimap} and @code{gmane} search engines should work with no
21045 configuration. Other engines require a local index that needs to be
21046 created and maintained outside of Gnus.
21047
21048
21049 @node Basic Usage
21050 @subsection Basic Usage
21051
21052 In the group buffer typing @kbd{G G} will search the group on the
21053 current line by calling @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. This prompts
21054 for a query string, creates an ephemeral @code{nnir} group containing
21055 the articles that match this query, and takes you to a summary buffer
21056 showing these articles. Articles may then be read, moved and deleted
21057 using the usual commands.
21058
21059 The @code{nnir} group made in this way is an @code{ephemeral} group, and
21060 some changes are not permanent: aside from reading, moving, and
21061 deleting, you can't act on the original article. But there is an
21062 alternative: you can @emph{warp} to the original group for the article
21063 on the current line with @kbd{A W}, aka
21064 @code{gnus-warp-to-article}. Even better, the function
21065 @code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}, bound by default in summary buffers to
21066 @kbd{A T}, will first warp to the original group before it works its
21067 magic and includes all the articles in the thread. From here you can
21068 read, move and delete articles, but also copy them, alter article marks,
21069 whatever. Go nuts.
21070
21071 You say you want to search more than just the group on the current line?
21072 No problem: just process-mark the groups you want to search. You want
21073 even more? Calling for an nnir search with the cursor on a topic heading
21074 will search all the groups under that heading.
21075
21076 Still not enough? OK, in the server buffer
21077 @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group} (now bound to @kbd{G}) will search all
21078 groups from the server on the current line. Too much? Want to ignore
21079 certain groups when searching, like spam groups? Just customize
21080 @code{nnir-ignored-newsgroups}.
21081
21082 One more thing: individual search engines may have special search
21083 features. You can access these special features by giving a prefix-arg
21084 to @code{gnus-group-make-nnir-group}. If you are searching multiple
21085 groups with different search engines you will be prompted for the
21086 special search features for each engine separately.
21087
21088
21089 @node Setting up nnir
21090 @subsection Setting up nnir
21091
21092 To set up nnir you may need to do some prep work. Firstly, you may need
21093 to configure the search engines you plan to use. Some of them, like
21094 @code{imap} and @code{gmane}, need no special configuration. Others,
21095 like @code{namazu} and @code{swish}, require configuration as described
21096 below. Secondly, you need to associate a search engine with a server or
21097 a backend.
21098
21099 If you just want to use the @code{imap} engine to search @code{nnimap}
21100 servers, and the @code{gmane} engine to search @code{gmane} then you
21101 don't have to do anything. But you might want to read the details of the
21102 query language anyway.
21103
21104 @menu
21105 * Associating Engines:: How to associate engines.
21106 * The imap Engine:: Imap configuration and usage.
21107 * The gmane Engine:: Gmane configuration and usage.
21108 * The swish++ Engine:: Swish++ configuration and usage.
21109 * The swish-e Engine:: Swish-e configuration and usage.
21110 * The namazu Engine:: Namazu configuration and usage.
21111 * The hyrex Engine:: Hyrex configuration and usage.
21112 * Customizations:: User customizable settings.
21113 @end menu
21114
21115 @node Associating Engines
21116 @subsubsection Associating Engines
21117
21118
21119 When searching a group, @code{nnir} needs to know which search engine to
21120 use. You can configure a given server to use a particular engine by
21121 setting the server variable @code{nnir-search-engine} to the engine
21122 name. For example to use the @code{namazu} engine to search the server
21123 named @code{home} you can use
21124
21125 @lisp
21126 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
21127 '((nnml "home"
21128 (nnimap-address "localhost")
21129 (nnir-search-engine namazu))))
21130 @end lisp
21131
21132 Alternatively you might want to use a particular engine for all servers
21133 with a given backend. For example, you might want to use the @code{imap}
21134 engine for all servers using the @code{nnimap} backend. In this case you
21135 can customize the variable @code{nnir-method-default-engines}. This is
21136 an alist of pairs of the form @code{(backend . engine)}. By default this
21137 variable is set to use the @code{imap} engine for all servers using the
21138 @code{nnimap} backend, and the @code{gmane} backend for @code{nntp}
21139 servers. (Don't worry, the @code{gmane} search engine won't actually try
21140 to search non-gmane @code{nntp} servers.) But if you wanted to use
21141 @code{namazu} for all your servers with an @code{nnimap} backend you
21142 could change this to
21143
21144 @lisp
21145 '((nnimap . namazu)
21146 (nntp . gmane))
21147 @end lisp
21148
21149 @node The imap Engine
21150 @subsubsection The imap Engine
21151
21152 The @code{imap} engine requires no configuration.
21153
21154 Queries using the @code{imap} engine follow a simple query language.
21155 The search is always case-insensitive and supports the following
21156 features (inspired by the Google search input language):
21157
21158 @table @samp
21159
21160 @item Boolean query operators
21161 AND, OR, and NOT are supported, and parentheses can be used to control
21162 operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux. Note that
21163 operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21164 recognized. Also preceding a term with a @minus{} sign is equivalent to NOT
21165 term.
21166
21167 @item Automatic AND queries
21168 If you specify multiple words then they will be treated as an AND
21169 expression intended to match all components.
21170
21171 @item Phrase searches
21172 If you wrap your query in double-quotes then it will be treated as a
21173 literal string.
21174
21175 @end table
21176
21177 By default the whole message will be searched. The query can be limited
21178 to a specific part of a message by using a prefix-arg. After inputting
21179 the query this will prompt (with completion) for a message part.
21180 Choices include ``Whole message'', ``Subject'', ``From'', and
21181 ``To''. Any unrecognized input is interpreted as a header name. For
21182 example, typing @kbd{Message-ID} in response to this prompt will limit
21183 the query to the Message-ID header.
21184
21185 Finally selecting ``Imap'' will interpret the query as a raw
21186 @acronym{IMAP} search query. The format of such queries can be found in
21187 RFC3501.
21188
21189 If you don't like the default of searching whole messages you can
21190 customize @code{nnir-imap-default-search-key}. For example to use
21191 @acronym{IMAP} queries by default
21192
21193 @lisp
21194 (setq nnir-imap-default-search-key "Imap")
21195 @end lisp
21196
21197 @node The gmane Engine
21198 @subsubsection The gmane Engine
21199
21200 The @code{gmane} engine requires no configuration.
21201
21202 Gmane queries follow a simple query language:
21203
21204 @table @samp
21205 @item Boolean query operators
21206 AND, OR, NOT (or AND NOT), and XOR are supported, and brackets can be
21207 used to control operator precedence, e.g., (emacs OR xemacs) AND linux.
21208 Note that operators must be written with all capital letters to be
21209 recognized.
21210
21211 @item Required and excluded terms
21212 + and @minus{} can be used to require or exclude terms, e.g., football
21213 @minus{}american
21214
21215 @item Unicode handling
21216 The search engine converts all text to utf-8, so searching should work
21217 in any language.
21218
21219 @item Stopwords
21220 Common English words (like 'the' and 'a') are ignored by default. You
21221 can override this by prefixing such words with a + (e.g., +the) or
21222 enclosing the word in quotes (e.g., "the").
21223
21224 @end table
21225
21226 The query can be limited to articles by a specific author using a
21227 prefix-arg. After inputting the query this will prompt for an author
21228 name (or part of a name) to match.
21229
21230 @node The swish++ Engine
21231 @subsubsection The swish++ Engine
21232
21233 FIXME: Say something more here.
21234
21235 Documentation for swish++ may be found at the swish++ sourceforge page:
21236 @uref{http://swishplusplus.sourceforge.net}
21237
21238 @table @code
21239
21240 @item nnir-swish++-program
21241 The name of the swish++ executable. Defaults to @code{search}
21242
21243 @item nnir-swish++-additional-switches
21244 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21245 swish++. @code{nil} by default.
21246
21247 @item nnir-swish++-remove-prefix
21248 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish++ in order
21249 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21250
21251 @end table
21252
21253 @node The swish-e Engine
21254 @subsubsection The swish-e Engine
21255
21256 FIXME: Say something more here.
21257
21258 Documentation for swish-e may be found at the swish-e homepage
21259 @uref{http://swish-e.org}
21260
21261 @table @code
21262
21263 @item nnir-swish-e-program
21264 The name of the swish-e search program. Defaults to @code{swish-e}.
21265
21266 @item nnir-swish-e-additional-switches
21267 A list of strings to be given as additional arguments to
21268 swish-e. @code{nil} by default.
21269
21270 @item nnir-swish-e-remove-prefix
21271 The prefix to remove from each file name returned by swish-e in order
21272 to get a group name. By default this is @code{$HOME/Mail}.
21273
21274 @end table
21275
21276 @node The namazu Engine
21277 @subsubsection The namazu Engine
21278
21279 Using the namazu engine requires creating and maintaining index files.
21280 One directory should contain all the index files, and nnir must be told
21281 where to find them by setting the @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory}
21282 variable.
21283
21284 To work correctly the @code{nnir-namazu-remove-prefix} variable must
21285 also be correct. This is the prefix to remove from each file name
21286 returned by Namazu in order to get a proper group name (albeit with `/'
21287 instead of `.').
21288
21289 For example, suppose that Namazu returns file names such as
21290 @samp{/home/john/Mail/mail/misc/42}. For this example, use the
21291 following setting: @code{(setq nnir-namazu-remove-prefix
21292 "/home/john/Mail/")} Note the trailing slash. Removing this prefix from
21293 the directory gives @samp{mail/misc/42}. @code{nnir} knows to remove
21294 the @samp{/42} and to replace @samp{/} with @samp{.} to arrive at the
21295 correct group name @samp{mail.misc}.
21296
21297 Extra switches may be passed to the namazu search command by setting the
21298 variable @code{nnir-namazu-additional-switches}. It is particularly
21299 important not to pass any any switches to namazu that will change the
21300 output format. Good switches to use include `--sort', `--ascending',
21301 `--early' and `--late'. Refer to the Namazu documentation for further
21302 information on valid switches.
21303
21304 Mail must first be indexed with the `mknmz' program. Read the documentation
21305 for namazu to create a configuration file. Here is an example:
21306
21307 @cartouche
21308 @example
21309 package conf; # Don't remove this line!
21310
21311 # Paths which will not be indexed. Don't use `^' or `$' anchors.
21312 $EXCLUDE_PATH = "spam|sent";
21313
21314 # Header fields which should be searchable. case-insensitive
21315 $REMAIN_HEADER = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21316
21317 # Searchable fields. case-insensitive
21318 $SEARCH_FIELD = "from|date|message-id|subject";
21319
21320 # The max length of a word.
21321 $WORD_LENG_MAX = 128;
21322
21323 # The max length of a field.
21324 $MAX_FIELD_LENGTH = 256;
21325 @end example
21326 @end cartouche
21327
21328 For this example, mail is stored in the directories @samp{~/Mail/mail/},
21329 @samp{~/Mail/lists/} and @samp{~/Mail/archive/}, so to index them go to
21330 the index directory set in @code{nnir-namazu-index-directory} and issue
21331 the following command:
21332
21333 @example
21334 mknmz --mailnews ~/Mail/archive/ ~/Mail/mail/ ~/Mail/lists/
21335 @end example
21336
21337 For maximum searching efficiency you might want to have a cron job run
21338 this command periodically, say every four hours.
21339
21340 @node The hyrex Engine
21341 @subsubsection The hyrex Engine
21342 This engine is obsolete.
21343
21344 @node Customizations
21345 @subsubsection Customizations
21346
21347 @table @code
21348
21349 @item nnir-method-default-engines
21350 Alist of pairs of server backends and search engines. The default associations
21351 are
21352 @example
21353 (nnimap . imap)
21354 (nntp . gmane)
21355 @end example
21356
21357 @item nnir-ignored-newsgroups
21358 A regexp to match newsgroups in the active file that should be skipped
21359 when searching all groups on a server.
21360
21361 @item nnir-summary-line-format
21362 The format specification to be used for lines in an nnir summary buffer.
21363 All the items from `gnus-summary-line-format' are available, along with
21364 three items unique to nnir summary buffers:
21365
21366 @example
21367 %Z Search retrieval score value (integer)
21368 %G Article original full group name (string)
21369 %g Article original short group name (string)
21370 @end example
21371
21372 If nil (the default) this will use @code{gnus-summary-line-format}.
21373
21374 @item nnir-retrieve-headers-override-function
21375 If non-nil, a function that retrieves article headers rather than using
21376 the gnus built-in function. This function takes an article list and
21377 group as arguments and populates the `nntp-server-buffer' with the
21378 retrieved headers. It should then return either 'nov or 'headers
21379 indicating the retrieved header format. Failure to retrieve headers
21380 should return @code{nil}
21381
21382 If this variable is nil, or if the provided function returns nil for a
21383 search result, @code{gnus-retrieve-headers} will be called instead."
21384
21385
21386 @end table
21387
21388
21389 @node nnmairix
21390 @section nnmairix
21391
21392 @cindex mairix
21393 @cindex nnmairix
21394 This paragraph describes how to set up mairix and the back end
21395 @code{nnmairix} for indexing and searching your mail from within
21396 Gnus. Additionally, you can create permanent ``smart'' groups which are
21397 bound to mairix searches and are automatically updated.
21398
21399 @menu
21400 * About mairix:: About the mairix mail search engine
21401 * nnmairix requirements:: What you will need for using nnmairix
21402 * What nnmairix does:: What does nnmairix actually do?
21403 * Setting up mairix:: Set up your mairix installation
21404 * Configuring nnmairix:: Set up the nnmairix back end
21405 * nnmairix keyboard shortcuts:: List of available keyboard shortcuts
21406 * Propagating marks:: How to propagate marks from nnmairix groups
21407 * nnmairix tips and tricks:: Some tips, tricks and examples
21408 * nnmairix caveats:: Some more stuff you might want to know
21409 @end menu
21410
21411 @c FIXME: The markup in this section might need improvement.
21412 @c E.g., adding @samp, @var, @file, @command, etc.
21413 @c Cf. (info "(texinfo)Indicating")
21414
21415 @node About mairix
21416 @subsection About mairix
21417
21418 Mairix is a tool for indexing and searching words in locally stored
21419 mail. It was written by Richard Curnow and is licensed under the
21420 GPL@. Mairix comes with most popular GNU/Linux distributions, but it also
21421 runs under Windows (with cygwin), Mac OS X and Solaris. The homepage can
21422 be found at
21423 @uref{http://www.rpcurnow.force9.co.uk/mairix/index.html}
21424
21425 Though mairix might not be as flexible as other search tools like
21426 swish++ or namazu, which you can use via the @code{nnir} back end, it
21427 has the prime advantage of being incredibly fast. On current systems, it
21428 can easily search through headers and message bodies of thousands and
21429 thousands of mails in well under a second. Building the database
21430 necessary for searching might take a minute or two, but only has to be
21431 done once fully. Afterwards, the updates are done incrementally and
21432 therefore are really fast, too. Additionally, mairix is very easy to set
21433 up.
21434
21435 For maximum speed though, mairix should be used with mails stored in
21436 @code{Maildir} or @code{MH} format (this includes the @code{nnml} back
21437 end), although it also works with mbox. Mairix presents the search
21438 results by populating a @emph{virtual} maildir/MH folder with symlinks
21439 which point to the ``real'' message files (if mbox is used, copies are
21440 made). Since mairix already presents search results in such a virtual
21441 mail folder, it is very well suited for using it as an external program
21442 for creating @emph{smart} mail folders, which represent certain mail
21443 searches.
21444
21445 @node nnmairix requirements
21446 @subsection nnmairix requirements
21447
21448 Mairix searches local mail---that means, mairix absolutely must have
21449 direct access to your mail folders. If your mail resides on another
21450 server (e.g., an @acronym{IMAP} server) and you happen to have shell
21451 access, @code{nnmairix} supports running mairix remotely, e.g., via ssh.
21452
21453 Additionally, @code{nnmairix} only supports the following Gnus back
21454 ends: @code{nnml}, @code{nnmaildir}, and @code{nnimap}. You must use
21455 one of these back ends for using @code{nnmairix}. Other back ends, like
21456 @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnfolder} or @code{nnmh}, won't work.
21457
21458 If you absolutely must use mbox and still want to use @code{nnmairix},
21459 you can set up a local @acronym{IMAP} server, which you then access via
21460 @code{nnimap}. This is a rather massive setup for accessing some mbox
21461 files, so just change to MH or Maildir already... However, if you're
21462 really, really passionate about using mbox, you might want to look into
21463 the package @file{mairix.el}, which comes with Emacs 23.
21464
21465 @node What nnmairix does
21466 @subsection What nnmairix does
21467
21468 The back end @code{nnmairix} enables you to call mairix from within Gnus,
21469 either to query mairix with a search term or to update the
21470 database. While visiting a message in the summary buffer, you can use
21471 several pre-defined shortcuts for calling mairix, e.g., to quickly
21472 search for all mails from the sender of the current message or to
21473 display the whole thread associated with the message, even if the
21474 mails are in different folders.
21475
21476 Additionally, you can create permanent @code{nnmairix} groups which are bound
21477 to certain mairix searches. This way, you can easily create a group
21478 containing mails from a certain sender, with a certain subject line or
21479 even for one specific thread based on the Message-ID@. If you check for
21480 new mail in these folders (e.g., by pressing @kbd{g} or @kbd{M-g}), they
21481 automatically update themselves by calling mairix.
21482
21483 You might ask why you need @code{nnmairix} at all, since mairix already
21484 creates the group, populates it with links to the mails so that you can
21485 then access it with Gnus, right? Well, this @emph{might} work, but often
21486 does not---at least not without problems. Most probably you will get
21487 strange article counts, and sometimes you might see mails which Gnus
21488 claims have already been canceled and are inaccessible. This is due to
21489 the fact that Gnus isn't really amused when things are happening behind
21490 its back. Another problem can be the mail back end itself, e.g., if you
21491 use mairix with an @acronym{IMAP} server (I had Dovecot complaining
21492 about corrupt index files when mairix changed the contents of the search
21493 group). Using @code{nnmairix} should circumvent these problems.
21494
21495 @code{nnmairix} is not really a mail back end---it's actually more like
21496 a wrapper, sitting between a ``real'' mail back end where mairix stores
21497 the searches and the Gnus front end. You can choose between three
21498 different mail back ends for the mairix folders: @code{nnml},
21499 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnimap}. @code{nnmairix} will call the mairix
21500 binary so that the search results are stored in folders named
21501 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>} on this mail back end, but it will
21502 present these folders in the Gnus front end only with @code{<NAME>}.
21503 You can use an existing mail back end where you already store your mail,
21504 but if you're uncomfortable with @code{nnmairix} creating new mail
21505 groups alongside your other mail, you can also create, e.g., a new
21506 @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml} server exclusively for mairix, but then
21507 make sure those servers do not accidentally receive your new mail
21508 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). A special case exists if you want to use
21509 mairix remotely on an IMAP server with @code{nnimap}---here the mairix
21510 folders and your other mail must be on the same @code{nnimap} back end.
21511
21512 @node Setting up mairix
21513 @subsection Setting up mairix
21514
21515 First: create a backup of your mail folders (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}).
21516
21517 Setting up mairix is easy: simply create a @file{.mairixrc} file with
21518 (at least) the following entries:
21519
21520 @example
21521 # Your Maildir/MH base folder
21522 base=~/Maildir
21523 @end example
21524
21525 This is the base folder for your mails. All the following directories
21526 are relative to this base folder. If you want to use @code{nnmairix}
21527 with @code{nnimap}, this base directory has to point to the mail
21528 directory where the @acronym{IMAP} server stores the mail folders!
21529
21530 @example
21531 maildir= ... your maildir folders which should be indexed ...
21532 mh= ... your nnml/mh folders which should be indexed ...
21533 mbox = ... your mbox files which should be indexed ...
21534 @end example
21535
21536 This specifies all your mail folders and mbox files (relative to the
21537 base directory!) you want to index with mairix. Note that the
21538 @code{nnml} back end saves mails in MH format, so you have to put those
21539 directories in the @code{mh} line. See the example at the end of this
21540 section and mairixrc's man-page for further details.
21541
21542 @example
21543 omit=zz_mairix-*
21544 @end example
21545
21546 @vindex nnmairix-group-prefix
21547 This should make sure that you don't accidentally index the mairix
21548 search results. You can change the prefix of these folders with the
21549 variable @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
21550
21551 @example
21552 mformat= ... 'maildir' or 'mh' ...
21553 database= ... location of database file ...
21554 @end example
21555
21556 The @code{format} setting specifies the output format for the mairix
21557 search folder. Set this to @code{mh} if you want to access search results
21558 with @code{nnml}. Otherwise choose @code{maildir}.
21559
21560 To summarize, here is my shortened @file{.mairixrc} file as an example:
21561
21562 @example
21563 base=~/Maildir
21564 maildir=.personal:.work:.logcheck:.sent
21565 mh=../Mail/nnml/*...
21566 mbox=../mboxmail/mailarchive_year*
21567 mformat=maildir
21568 omit=zz_mairix-*
21569 database=~/.mairixdatabase
21570 @end example
21571
21572 In this case, the base directory is @file{~/Maildir}, where all my Maildir
21573 folders are stored. As you can see, the folders are separated by
21574 colons. If you wonder why every folder begins with a dot: this is
21575 because I use Dovecot as @acronym{IMAP} server, which again uses
21576 @code{Maildir++} folders. For testing nnmairix, I also have some
21577 @code{nnml} mail, which is saved in @file{~/Mail/nnml}. Since this has
21578 to be specified relative to the @code{base} directory, the @code{../Mail}
21579 notation is needed. Note that the line ends in @code{*...}, which means
21580 to recursively scan all files under this directory. Without the three
21581 dots, the wildcard @code{*} will not work recursively. I also have some
21582 old mbox files with archived mail lying around in @file{~/mboxmail}.
21583 The other lines should be obvious.
21584
21585 See the man page for @code{mairixrc} for details and further options,
21586 especially regarding wildcard usage, which may be a little different
21587 than you are used to.
21588
21589 Now simply call @code{mairix} to create the index for the first time.
21590 Note that this may take a few minutes, but every following index will do
21591 the updates incrementally and hence is very fast.
21592
21593 @node Configuring nnmairix
21594 @subsection Configuring nnmairix
21595
21596 In group mode, type @kbd{G b c}
21597 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). This will ask you for all
21598 necessary information and create a @code{nnmairix} server as a foreign
21599 server. You will have to specify the following:
21600
21601 @itemize @bullet
21602
21603 @item
21604 The @strong{name} of the @code{nnmairix} server---choose whatever you
21605 want.
21606
21607 @item
21608 The name of the @strong{back end server} where mairix should store its
21609 searches. This must be a full server name, like @code{nnml:mymail}.
21610 Just hit @kbd{TAB} to see the available servers. Currently, servers
21611 which are accessed through @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnimap} and
21612 @code{nnml} are supported. As explained above, for locally stored
21613 mails, this can be an existing server where you store your mails.
21614 However, you can also create, e.g., a new @code{nnmaildir} or @code{nnml}
21615 server exclusively for @code{nnmairix} in your secondary select methods
21616 (@pxref{Finding the News}). If you use a secondary @code{nnml} server
21617 just for mairix, make sure that you explicitly set the server variable
21618 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}, or you might lose mail
21619 (@pxref{nnmairix caveats}). If you want to use mairix remotely on an
21620 @acronym{IMAP} server, you have to choose the corresponding
21621 @code{nnimap} server here.
21622
21623 @item
21624 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-search-options
21625 The @strong{command} to call the mairix binary. This will usually just
21626 be @code{mairix}, but you can also choose something like @code{ssh
21627 SERVER mairix} if you want to call mairix remotely, e.g., on your
21628 @acronym{IMAP} server. If you want to add some default options to
21629 mairix, you could do this here, but better use the variable
21630 @code{nnmairix-mairix-search-options} instead.
21631
21632 @item
21633 The name of the @strong{default search group}. This will be the group
21634 where all temporary mairix searches are stored, i.e., all searches which
21635 are not bound to permanent @code{nnmairix} groups. Choose whatever you
21636 like.
21637
21638 @item
21639 If the mail back end is @code{nnimap} or @code{nnmaildir}, you will be
21640 asked if you work with @strong{Maildir++}, i.e., with hidden maildir
21641 folders (=beginning with a dot). For example, you have to answer
21642 @samp{yes} here if you work with the Dovecot @acronym{IMAP}
21643 server. Otherwise, you should answer @samp{no} here.
21644
21645 @end itemize
21646
21647 @node nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21648 @subsection nnmairix keyboard shortcuts
21649
21650 In group mode:
21651
21652 @table @kbd
21653
21654 @item G b c
21655 @kindex G b c (Group)
21656 @findex nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group
21657 Creates @code{nnmairix} server and default search group for this server
21658 (@code{nnmairix-create-server-and-default-group}). You should have done
21659 this by now (@pxref{Configuring nnmairix}).
21660
21661 @item G b s
21662 @kindex G b s (Group)
21663 @findex nnmairix-search
21664 Prompts for query which is then sent to the mairix binary. Search
21665 results are put into the default search group which is automatically
21666 displayed (@code{nnmairix-search}).
21667
21668 @item G b m
21669 @kindex G b m (Group)
21670 @findex nnmairix-widget-search
21671 Allows you to create a mairix search or a permanent group more
21672 comfortably using graphical widgets, similar to a customization
21673 group. Just try it to see how it works (@code{nnmairix-widget-search}).
21674
21675 @item G b i
21676 @kindex G b i (Group)
21677 @findex nnmairix-search-interactive
21678 Another command for creating a mairix query more comfortably, but uses
21679 only the minibuffer (@code{nnmairix-search-interactive}).
21680
21681 @item G b g
21682 @kindex G b g (Group)
21683 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group
21684 Creates a permanent group which is associated with a search query
21685 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group}). The @code{nnmairix} back end
21686 automatically calls mairix when you update this group with @kbd{g} or
21687 @kbd{M-g}.
21688
21689 @item G b q
21690 @kindex G b q (Group)
21691 @findex nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group
21692 Changes the search query for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor
21693 (@code{nnmairix-group-change-query-this-group}).
21694
21695 @item G b t
21696 @kindex G b t (Group)
21697 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group
21698 Toggles the 'threads' parameter for the @code{nnmairix} group under cursor,
21699 i.e., if you want see the whole threads of the found messages
21700 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-threads-this-group}).
21701
21702 @item G b u
21703 @kindex G b u (Group)
21704 @findex nnmairix-update-database
21705 @vindex nnmairix-mairix-update-options
21706 Calls mairix binary for updating the database
21707 (@code{nnmairix-update-database}). The default parameters are @code{-F}
21708 and @code{-Q} for making this as fast as possible (see variable
21709 @code{nnmairix-mairix-update-options} for defining these default
21710 options).
21711
21712 @item G b r
21713 @kindex G b r (Group)
21714 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group
21715 Keep articles in this @code{nnmairix} group always read or unread, or leave the
21716 marks unchanged (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-readmarks-this-group}).
21717
21718 @item G b d
21719 @kindex G b d (Group)
21720 @findex nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group
21721 Recreate @code{nnmairix} group on the ``real'' mail back end
21722 (@code{nnmairix-group-delete-recreate-this-group}). You can do this if
21723 you always get wrong article counts with a @code{nnmairix} group.
21724
21725 @item G b a
21726 @kindex G b a (Group)
21727 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group
21728 Toggles the @code{allow-fast} parameters for group under cursor
21729 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-allowfast-this-group}). The default
21730 behavior of @code{nnmairix} is to do a mairix search every time you
21731 update or enter the group. With the @code{allow-fast} parameter set,
21732 mairix will only be called when you explicitly update the group, but not
21733 upon entering. This makes entering the group faster, but it may also
21734 lead to dangling symlinks if something changed between updating and
21735 entering the group which is not yet in the mairix database.
21736
21737 @item G b p
21738 @kindex G b p (Group)
21739 @findex nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group
21740 Toggle marks propagation for this group
21741 (@code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group}). (@pxref{Propagating
21742 marks}).
21743
21744 @item G b o
21745 @kindex G b o (Group)
21746 @findex nnmairix-propagate-marks
21747 Manually propagate marks (@code{nnmairix-propagate-marks}); needed only when
21748 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} is set to @code{nil}.
21749
21750 @end table
21751
21752 In summary mode:
21753
21754 @table @kbd
21755
21756 @item $ m
21757 @kindex $ m (Summary)
21758 @findex nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article
21759 Allows you to create a mairix query or group based on the current
21760 message using graphical widgets (same as @code{nnmairix-widget-search})
21761 (@code{nnmairix-widget-search-from-this-article}).
21762
21763 @item $ g
21764 @kindex $ g (Summary)
21765 @findex nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message
21766 Interactively creates a new search group with query based on the current
21767 message, but uses the minibuffer instead of graphical widgets
21768 (@code{nnmairix-create-search-group-from-message}).
21769
21770 @item $ t
21771 @kindex $ t (Summary)
21772 @findex nnmairix-search-thread-this-article
21773 Searches thread for the current article
21774 (@code{nnmairix-search-thread-this-article}). This is effectively a
21775 shortcut for calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{m:msgid} of the
21776 current article and enabled threads.
21777
21778 @item $ f
21779 @kindex $ f (Summary)
21780 @findex nnmairix-search-from-this-article
21781 Searches all messages from sender of the current article
21782 (@code{nnmairix-search-from-this-article}). This is a shortcut for
21783 calling @code{nnmairix-search} with @samp{f:From}.
21784
21785 @item $ o
21786 @kindex $ o (Summary)
21787 @findex nnmairix-goto-original-article
21788 (Only in @code{nnmairix} groups!) Tries determine the group this article
21789 originally came from and displays the article in this group, so that,
21790 e.g., replying to this article the correct posting styles/group
21791 parameters are applied (@code{nnmairix-goto-original-article}). This
21792 function will use the registry if available, but can also parse the
21793 article file name as a fallback method.
21794
21795 @item $ u
21796 @kindex $ u (Summary)
21797 @findex nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article
21798 Remove possibly existing tick mark from original article
21799 (@code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article}). (@pxref{nnmairix
21800 tips and tricks}).
21801
21802 @end table
21803
21804 @node Propagating marks
21805 @subsection Propagating marks
21806
21807 First of: you really need a patched mairix binary for using the marks
21808 propagation feature efficiently. Otherwise, you would have to update
21809 the mairix database all the time. You can get the patch at
21810
21811 @uref{http://www.randomsample.de/mairix-maildir-patch.tar}
21812
21813 You need the mairix v0.21 source code for this patch; everything else
21814 is explained in the accompanied readme file. If you don't want to use
21815 marks propagation, you don't have to apply these patches, but they also
21816 fix some annoyances regarding changing maildir flags, so it might still
21817 be useful to you.
21818
21819 With the patched mairix binary, you can use @code{nnmairix} as an
21820 alternative to mail splitting (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}). For
21821 example, instead of splitting all mails from @samp{david@@foobar.com}
21822 into a group, you can simply create a search group with the query
21823 @samp{f:david@@foobar.com}. This is actually what ``smart folders'' are
21824 all about: simply put everything in one mail folder and dynamically
21825 create searches instead of splitting. This is more flexible, since you
21826 can dynamically change your folders any time you want to. This also
21827 implies that you will usually read your mails in the @code{nnmairix}
21828 groups instead of your ``real'' mail groups.
21829
21830 There is one problem, though: say you got a new mail from
21831 @samp{david@@foobar.com}; it will now show up in two groups, the
21832 ``real'' group (your INBOX, for example) and in the @code{nnmairix}
21833 search group (provided you have updated the mairix database). Now you
21834 enter the @code{nnmairix} group and read the mail. The mail will be
21835 marked as read, but only in the @code{nnmairix} group---in the ``real''
21836 mail group it will be still shown as unread.
21837
21838 You could now catch up the mail group (@pxref{Group Data}), but this is
21839 tedious and error prone, since you may overlook mails you don't have
21840 created @code{nnmairix} groups for. Of course, you could first use
21841 @code{nnmairix-goto-original-article} (@pxref{nnmairix keyboard
21842 shortcuts}) and then read the mail in the original group, but that's
21843 even more cumbersome.
21844
21845 Clearly, the easiest way would be if marks could somehow be
21846 automatically set for the original article. This is exactly what
21847 @emph{marks propagation} is about.
21848
21849 Marks propagation is inactive by default. You can activate it for a
21850 certain @code{nnmairix} group with
21851 @code{nnmairix-group-toggle-propmarks-this-group} (bound to @kbd{G b
21852 p}). This function will warn you if you try to use it with your default
21853 search group; the reason is that the default search group is used for
21854 temporary searches, and it's easy to accidentally propagate marks from
21855 this group. However, you can ignore this warning if you really want to.
21856
21857 With marks propagation enabled, all the marks you set in a @code{nnmairix}
21858 group should now be propagated to the original article. For example,
21859 you can now tick an article (by default with @kbd{!}) and this mark should
21860 magically be set for the original article, too.
21861
21862 A few more remarks which you may or may not want to know:
21863
21864 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close
21865 Marks will not be set immediately, but only upon closing a group. This
21866 not only makes marks propagation faster, it also avoids problems with
21867 dangling symlinks when dealing with maildir files (since changing flags
21868 will change the file name). You can also control when to propagate marks
21869 via @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-upon-close} (see the doc-string for
21870 details).
21871
21872 Obviously, @code{nnmairix} will have to look up the original group for every
21873 article you want to set marks for. If available, @code{nnmairix} will first use
21874 the registry for determining the original group. The registry is very
21875 fast, hence you should really, really enable the registry when using
21876 marks propagation. If you don't have to worry about RAM and disc space,
21877 set @code{gnus-registry-max-entries} to a large enough value; to be on
21878 the safe side, choose roughly the amount of mails you index with mairix.
21879
21880 @vindex nnmairix-only-use-registry
21881 If you don't want to use the registry or the registry hasn't seen the
21882 original article yet, @code{nnmairix} will use an additional mairix
21883 search for determining the file name of the article. This, of course, is
21884 way slower than the registry---if you set hundreds or even thousands of
21885 marks this way, it might take some time. You can avoid this situation by
21886 setting @code{nnmairix-only-use-registry} to t.
21887
21888 Maybe you also want to propagate marks the other way round, i.e., if you
21889 tick an article in a "real" mail group, you'd like to have the same
21890 article in a @code{nnmairix} group ticked, too. For several good
21891 reasons, this can only be done efficiently if you use maildir. To
21892 immediately contradict myself, let me mention that it WON'T work with
21893 @code{nnmaildir}, since @code{nnmaildir} stores the marks externally and
21894 not in the file name. Therefore, propagating marks to @code{nnmairix}
21895 groups will usually only work if you use an IMAP server which uses
21896 maildir as its file format.
21897
21898 @vindex nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups
21899 If you work with this setup, just set
21900 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t} and see what
21901 happens. If you don't like what you see, just set it to @code{nil} again. One
21902 problem might be that you get a wrong number of unread articles; this
21903 usually happens when you delete or expire articles in the original
21904 groups. When this happens, you can recreate the @code{nnmairix} group on the
21905 back end using @kbd{G b d}.
21906
21907 @node nnmairix tips and tricks
21908 @subsection nnmairix tips and tricks
21909
21910 @itemize
21911 @item
21912 Checking Mail
21913
21914 @findex nnmairix-update-groups
21915 I put all my important mail groups at group level 1. The mairix groups
21916 have group level 5, so they do not get checked at start up (@pxref{Group
21917 Levels}).
21918
21919 I use the following to check for mails:
21920
21921 @lisp
21922 (defun my-check-mail-mairix-update (level)
21923 (interactive "P")
21924 ;; if no prefix given, set level=1
21925 (gnus-group-get-new-news (or level 1))
21926 (nnmairix-update-groups "mairixsearch" t t)
21927 (gnus-group-list-groups))
21928
21929 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map "g" 'my-check-mail-mairix-update)
21930 @end lisp
21931
21932 Instead of @samp{"mairixsearch"} use the name of your @code{nnmairix}
21933 server. See the doc string for @code{nnmairix-update-groups} for
21934 details.
21935
21936 @item
21937 Example: search group for ticked articles
21938
21939 For example, you can create a group for all ticked articles, where the
21940 articles always stay unread:
21941
21942 Hit @kbd{G b g}, enter group name (e.g., @samp{important}), use
21943 @samp{F:f} as query and do not include threads.
21944
21945 Now activate marks propagation for this group by using @kbd{G b p}. Then
21946 activate the always-unread feature by using @kbd{G b r} twice.
21947
21948 So far so good---but how do you remove the tick marks in the @code{nnmairix}
21949 group? There are two options: You may simply use
21950 @code{nnmairix-remove-tick-mark-original-article} (bound to @kbd{$ u}) to remove
21951 tick marks from the original article. The other possibility is to set
21952 @code{nnmairix-propagate-marks-to-nnmairix-groups} to @code{t}, but see the above
21953 comments about this option. If it works for you, the tick marks should
21954 also exist in the @code{nnmairix} group and you can remove them as usual,
21955 e.g., by marking an article as read.
21956
21957 When you have removed a tick mark from the original article, this
21958 article should vanish from the @code{nnmairix} group after you have updated the
21959 mairix database and updated the group. Fortunately, there is a function
21960 for doing exactly that: @code{nnmairix-update-groups}. See the previous code
21961 snippet and the doc string for details.
21962
21963 @item
21964 Dealing with auto-subscription of mail groups
21965
21966 As described before, all @code{nnmairix} groups are in fact stored on
21967 the mail back end in the form @samp{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can
21968 see them when you enter the back end server in the server buffer. You
21969 should not subscribe these groups! Unfortunately, these groups will
21970 usually get @emph{auto-subscribed} when you use @code{nnmaildir} or
21971 @code{nnml}, i.e., you will suddenly see groups of the form
21972 @samp{zz_mairix*} pop up in your group buffer. If this happens to you,
21973 simply kill these groups with C-k. For avoiding this, turn off
21974 auto-subscription completely by setting the variable
21975 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups} to @code{nil} (@pxref{Filtering New
21976 Groups}), or if you like to keep this feature use the following kludge
21977 for turning it off for all groups beginning with @samp{zz_}:
21978
21979 @lisp
21980 (setq gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
21981 "^\\(nnml\\|nnfolder\\|nnmbox\\|nnmh\\|nnbabyl\\|nnmaildir\\).*:\\([^z]\\|z$\\|\\z[^z]\\|zz$\\|zz[^_]\\|zz_$\\).*")
21982 @end lisp
21983
21984 @end itemize
21985
21986 @node nnmairix caveats
21987 @subsection nnmairix caveats
21988
21989 @itemize
21990 @item
21991 You can create a secondary @code{nnml} server just for nnmairix, but then
21992 you have to explicitly set the corresponding server variable
21993 @code{nnml-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}. Otherwise, new mail might get
21994 put into this secondary server (and would never show up again). Here's
21995 an example server definition:
21996
21997 @lisp
21998 (nnml "mairix" (nnml-directory "mairix") (nnml-get-new-mail nil))
21999 @end lisp
22000
22001 (The @code{nnmaildir} back end also has a server variable
22002 @code{get-new-mail}, but its default value is @code{nil}, so you don't
22003 have to explicitly set it if you use a @code{nnmaildir} server just for
22004 mairix.)
22005
22006 @item
22007 If you use the Gnus registry: don't use the registry with
22008 @code{nnmairix} groups (put them in
22009 @code{gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups}; this is the default). Be
22010 @emph{extra careful} if you use
22011 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}; mails which are split
22012 into @code{nnmairix} groups are usually gone for good as soon as you
22013 check the group for new mail (yes, it has happened to me...).
22014
22015 @item
22016 Therefore: @emph{Never ever} put ``real'' mails into @code{nnmairix}
22017 groups (you shouldn't be able to, anyway).
22018
22019 @item
22020 If you use the Gnus agent (@pxref{Gnus Unplugged}): don't agentize
22021 @code{nnmairix} groups (though I have no idea what happens if you do).
22022
22023 @item
22024 mairix does only support us-ascii characters.
22025
22026 @item
22027 @code{nnmairix} uses a rather brute force method to force Gnus to
22028 completely reread the group on the mail back end after mairix was
22029 called---it simply deletes and re-creates the group on the mail
22030 back end. So far, this has worked for me without any problems, and I
22031 don't see how @code{nnmairix} could delete other mail groups than its
22032 own, but anyway: you really should have a backup of your mail
22033 folders.
22034
22035 @item
22036 All necessary information is stored in the group parameters
22037 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). This has the advantage that no active file
22038 is needed, but also implies that when you kill a @code{nnmairix} group,
22039 it is gone for good.
22040
22041 @item
22042 @findex nnmairix-purge-old-groups
22043 If you create and kill a lot of @code{nnmairix} groups, the
22044 ``zz_mairix-*'' groups will accumulate on the mail back end server. To
22045 delete old groups which are no longer needed, call
22046 @code{nnmairix-purge-old-groups}. Note that this assumes that you don't
22047 save any ``real'' mail in folders of the form
22048 @code{zz_mairix-<NAME>-<NUMBER>}. You can change the prefix of
22049 @code{nnmairix} groups by changing the variable
22050 @code{nnmairix-group-prefix}.
22051
22052 @item
22053 The following only applies if you @emph{don't} use the mentioned patch
22054 for mairix (@pxref{Propagating marks}):
22055
22056 A problem can occur when using @code{nnmairix} with maildir folders and
22057 comes with the fact that maildir stores mail flags like @samp{Seen} or
22058 @samp{Replied} by appending chars @samp{S} and @samp{R} to the message
22059 file name, respectively. This implies that currently you would have to
22060 update the mairix database not only when new mail arrives, but also when
22061 mail flags are changing. The same applies to new mails which are indexed
22062 while they are still in the @samp{new} folder but then get moved to
22063 @samp{cur} when Gnus has seen the mail. If you don't update the database
22064 after this has happened, a mairix query can lead to symlinks pointing to
22065 non-existing files. In Gnus, these messages will usually appear with
22066 ``(none)'' entries in the header and can't be accessed. If this happens
22067 to you, using @kbd{G b u} and updating the group will usually fix this.
22068
22069 @end itemize
22070
22071 @iftex
22072 @iflatex
22073 @chapter Message
22074 @include message.texi
22075 @chapter Emacs MIME
22076 @include emacs-mime.texi
22077 @chapter Sieve
22078 @include sieve.texi
22079 @chapter EasyPG
22080 @include epa.texi
22081 @chapter SASL
22082 @include sasl.texi
22083 @end iflatex
22084 @end iftex
22085
22086 @node Various
22087 @chapter Various
22088
22089 @menu
22090 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
22091 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
22092 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
22093 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
22094 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
22095 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
22096 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
22097 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
22098 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
22099 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
22100 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
22101 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
22102 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
22103 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
22104 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
22105 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
22106 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
22107 * The Gnus Registry:: A package for tracking messages by Message-ID.
22108 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
22109 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
22110 @end menu
22111
22112
22113 @node Process/Prefix
22114 @section Process/Prefix
22115 @cindex process/prefix convention
22116
22117 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
22118 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
22119
22120 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
22121 command to be performed on.
22122
22123 It goes like this:
22124
22125 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
22126 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
22127 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
22128 with the current one.
22129
22130 @vindex transient-mark-mode
22131 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
22132 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
22133
22134 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
22135 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
22136 the process mark.
22137
22138 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
22139 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
22140
22141 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
22142 are avoided.
22143
22144 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
22145 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
22146 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
22147 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
22148
22149 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
22150 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
22151 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
22152 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
22153 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
22154 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
22155 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
22156 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
22157
22158 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
22159 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
22160 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
22161 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
22162 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
22163
22164
22165 @node Interactive
22166 @section Interactive
22167 @cindex interaction
22168
22169 @table @code
22170
22171 @item gnus-novice-user
22172 @vindex gnus-novice-user
22173 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
22174 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
22175 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
22176 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
22177 default.
22178
22179 @item gnus-expert-user
22180 @vindex gnus-expert-user
22181 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
22182 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing,
22183 no matter how strange. For example, quitting Gnus, exiting a group
22184 without an update, catching up with a group, deleting expired
22185 articles, and replying by mail to a news message will not require
22186 confirmation.
22187
22188 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
22189 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
22190 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
22191 is @code{t} by default.
22192
22193 @item gnus-interactive-exit
22194 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
22195 If non-@code{nil}, require a confirmation when exiting Gnus. If
22196 @code{quiet}, update any active summary buffers automatically without
22197 querying. The default value is @code{t}.
22198 @end table
22199
22200
22201 @node Symbolic Prefixes
22202 @section Symbolic Prefixes
22203 @cindex symbolic prefixes
22204
22205 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
22206 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
22207 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
22208 rule of 900 to the current article.
22209
22210 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
22211 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
22212 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
22213 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
22214 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
22215 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
22216 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
22217
22218 @kindex M-i (Summary)
22219 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
22220 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
22221 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
22222 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
22223 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
22224 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
22225 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
22226 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
22227
22228 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
22229 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
22230 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
22231
22232 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
22233 Interactive}.
22234
22235
22236 @node Formatting Variables
22237 @section Formatting Variables
22238 @cindex formatting variables
22239
22240 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
22241 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
22242 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
22243 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
22244 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
22245 be annoyed by.
22246
22247 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
22248 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
22249 lots of percentages everywhere.
22250
22251 @menu
22252 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
22253 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
22254 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
22255 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
22256 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
22257 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
22258 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
22259 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
22260 @end menu
22261
22262 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
22263 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
22264 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
22265 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
22266 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
22267 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
22268 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
22269 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
22270
22271 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
22272 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
22273
22274 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
22275 @findex gnus-update-format
22276 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
22277 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
22278 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
22279 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
22280
22281
22282
22283 @node Formatting Basics
22284 @subsection Formatting Basics
22285
22286 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
22287 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
22288 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
22289
22290 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
22291 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
22292 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
22293 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
22294 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
22295 the right instead.
22296
22297 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
22298 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
22299 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
22300 less than 4 characters wide.
22301
22302 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
22303 @samp{%&user-date;}.
22304
22305
22306 @node Mode Line Formatting
22307 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
22308
22309 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
22310 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
22311 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
22312 with the following two differences:
22313
22314 @enumerate
22315
22316 @item
22317 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
22318
22319 @item
22320 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
22321 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
22322 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
22323 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
22324 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
22325 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
22326 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
22327
22328 @end enumerate
22329
22330
22331 @node Advanced Formatting
22332 @subsection Advanced Formatting
22333
22334 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
22335 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
22336 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
22337 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
22338
22339 These are the valid modifiers:
22340
22341 @table @code
22342 @item pad
22343 @itemx pad-left
22344 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
22345 length.
22346
22347 @item pad-right
22348 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
22349 length.
22350
22351 @item max
22352 @itemx max-left
22353 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
22354
22355 @item max-right
22356 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
22357 length.
22358
22359 @item cut
22360 @itemx cut-left
22361 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
22362
22363 @item cut-right
22364 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
22365
22366 @item ignore
22367 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
22368
22369 @item form
22370 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
22371 used.
22372
22373 Here's an example:
22374
22375 @lisp
22376 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
22377 @end lisp
22378
22379 @end table
22380
22381 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
22382 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
22383 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
22384 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
22385 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
22386 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
22387 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
22388
22389 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
22390 last operation, padding.
22391
22392
22393 @node User-Defined Specs
22394 @subsection User-Defined Specs
22395
22396 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
22397 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
22398 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
22399 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
22400 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
22401 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
22402 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
22403 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
22404 should protect against that.
22405
22406 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
22407 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
22408
22409 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
22410 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
22411 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
22412 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
22413 inserted.
22414
22415
22416 @node Formatting Fonts
22417 @subsection Formatting Fonts
22418
22419 @cindex %(, %)
22420 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22421 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
22422 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
22423 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
22424 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
22425 over it.
22426
22427 @cindex %@{, %@}
22428 @vindex gnus-face-0
22429 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
22430 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
22431 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
22432 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
22433 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
22434 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
22435
22436 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
22437 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
22438 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
22439 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
22440 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
22441 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
22442 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
22443 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
22444 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
22445 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
22446 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
22447 (in Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
22448 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
22449 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
22450 paragraph.)
22451
22452 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
22453
22454 @lisp
22455 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
22456 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
22457 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
22458
22459 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
22460 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
22461 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
22462 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
22463 ;; @r{Set the color.}
22464 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
22465 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
22466
22467 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
22468 (setq gnus-group-line-format
22469 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
22470 @end lisp
22471
22472 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
22473 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
22474
22475 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
22476 mode-line variables.
22477
22478 @node Positioning Point
22479 @subsection Positioning Point
22480
22481 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
22482 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
22483 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
22484
22485 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
22486
22487 @findex gnus-goto-colon
22488 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
22489 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
22490
22491 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
22492 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
22493 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
22494 place point there.
22495
22496
22497 @node Tabulation
22498 @subsection Tabulation
22499
22500 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
22501 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
22502 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
22503 about lining up the following text afterwards.
22504
22505 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
22506 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
22507
22508 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22509 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
22510 This is the soft tabulator.
22511
22512 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
22513 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
22514 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
22515
22516
22517 @node Wide Characters
22518 @subsection Wide Characters
22519
22520 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
22521 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
22522 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
22523
22524 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
22525 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
22526 these countries, that's not true.
22527
22528 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
22529 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
22530 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
22531 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
22532 for Emacs.
22533
22534
22535 @node Window Layout
22536 @section Window Layout
22537 @cindex window layout
22538
22539 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
22540
22541 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
22542 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
22543 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
22544 @code{t} by default.
22545
22546 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
22547 glitches. Use at your own peril.
22548
22549 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
22550 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
22551 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
22552
22553 @lisp
22554 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)))
22555 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22556 (article 1.0))))
22557 @end lisp
22558
22559 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
22560 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
22561 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
22562 possible names is listed below.
22563
22564 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
22565 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example:
22566
22567 @lisp
22568 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
22569 (article 1.0)))
22570 @end lisp
22571
22572 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
22573 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
22574 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
22575 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
22576 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
22577 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
22578 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
22579 size spec per split.
22580
22581 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
22582 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
22583 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e., is the third or
22584 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
22585 present) gets focus.
22586
22587 Here's a more complicated example:
22588
22589 @lisp
22590 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
22591 (summary 0.25 point)
22592 (article 1.0)))
22593 @end lisp
22594
22595 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
22596 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
22597 occupy, not a percentage.
22598
22599 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
22600 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
22601 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
22602 be used as a split.
22603
22604 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
22605
22606 @lisp
22607 (article (horizontal 1.0
22608 (vertical 0.5
22609 (group 1.0))
22610 (vertical 1.0
22611 (summary 0.25 point)
22612 (article 1.0))))
22613 @end lisp
22614
22615 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
22616 @code{horizontal} thingie?
22617
22618 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
22619 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
22620 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
22621 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
22622 the screen is to be given to this strip.
22623
22624 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
22625 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
22626 lines from the splits.
22627
22628 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
22629 may look like:
22630
22631 @example
22632 @group
22633 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22634 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22635 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22636 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22637 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22638 size = number | frame-params
22639 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22640 @end group
22641 @end example
22642
22643 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22644 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22645 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22646 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22647
22648 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22649 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22650 @cindex window height
22651 @cindex window width
22652 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22653 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22654 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22655 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22656 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22657 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22658
22659 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22660 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22661 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22662 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22663
22664 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22665 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22666 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22667 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22668 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22669 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22670 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22671 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22672 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22673 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22674 configuration list.
22675
22676 @lisp
22677 (gnus-configure-frame
22678 '(horizontal 1.0
22679 (vertical 10
22680 (group 1.0)
22681 (article 0.3 point))
22682 (vertical 1.0
22683 (article 1.0)
22684 (horizontal 4
22685 (group 1.0)
22686 (article 10)))))
22687 @end lisp
22688
22689 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22690 @code{frame} split:
22691
22692 @lisp
22693 (gnus-configure-frame
22694 '(frame 1.0
22695 (vertical 1.0
22696 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22697 (article 1.0))
22698 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22699 (user-position . t)
22700 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22701 (picon 1.0))))
22702
22703 @end lisp
22704
22705 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22706 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22707 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22708 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22709 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22710 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22711 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22712 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22713 is such a plist.
22714 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22715 be found in its default value.
22716
22717 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22718 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22719 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22720 might be used:
22721
22722 @lisp
22723 (message (horizontal 1.0
22724 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22725 (vertical 0.24
22726 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22727 '(summary 0.5))
22728 (group 1.0))))
22729 @end lisp
22730
22731 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22732 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22733 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22734
22735 @lisp
22736 (message
22737 (frame 1.0
22738 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22739 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22740 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22741 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22742 (name . "Message"))
22743 (message 1.0 point))))
22744 @end lisp
22745
22746 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22747 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22748 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22749 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22750 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22751
22752 @lisp
22753 (gnus-add-configuration
22754 '(article (vertical 1.0
22755 (group 4)
22756 (summary .25 point)
22757 (article 1.0))))
22758 @end lisp
22759
22760 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22761 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22762 Gnus has been loaded.
22763
22764 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22765 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22766 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22767 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22768 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22769
22770 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22771 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22772 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22773 windows resized.
22774
22775 @subsection Window Configuration Names
22776
22777 Here's a list of most of the currently known window configurations,
22778 and when they're used:
22779
22780 @table @code
22781 @item group
22782 The group buffer.
22783
22784 @item summary
22785 Entering a group and showing only the summary.
22786
22787 @item article
22788 Selecting an article.
22789
22790 @item server
22791 The server buffer.
22792
22793 @item browse
22794 Browsing groups from the server buffer.
22795
22796 @item message
22797 Composing a (new) message.
22798
22799 @item only-article
22800 Showing only the article buffer.
22801
22802 @item edit-article
22803 Editing an article.
22804
22805 @item edit-form
22806 Editing group parameters and the like.
22807
22808 @item edit-score
22809 Editing a server definition.
22810
22811 @item post
22812 Composing a news message.
22813
22814 @item reply
22815 Replying or following up an article without yanking the text.
22816
22817 @item forward
22818 Forwarding a message.
22819
22820 @item reply-yank
22821 Replying or following up an article with yanking the text.
22822
22823 @item mail-bound
22824 Bouncing a message.
22825
22826 @item pipe
22827 Sending an article to an external process.
22828
22829 @item bug
22830 Sending a bug report.
22831
22832 @item score-trace
22833 Displaying the score trace.
22834
22835 @item score-words
22836 Displaying the score words.
22837
22838 @item split-trace
22839 Displaying the split trace.
22840
22841 @item compose-bounce
22842 Composing a bounce message.
22843
22844 @item mml-preview
22845 Previewing a @acronym{MIME} part.
22846
22847 @end table
22848
22849
22850 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22851
22852 @itemize @bullet
22853 @item
22854 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22855 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22856
22857 @ifinfo
22858 @example
22859 +---+---------+
22860 | G | Summary |
22861 | r +---------+
22862 | o | |
22863 | u | Article |
22864 | p | |
22865 +---+---------+
22866 @end example
22867 @end ifinfo
22868
22869 @lisp
22870 (gnus-add-configuration
22871 '(article
22872 (horizontal 1.0
22873 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22874 (vertical 1.0
22875 (summary 0.16 point)
22876 (article 1.0)))))
22877
22878 (gnus-add-configuration
22879 '(summary
22880 (horizontal 1.0
22881 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22882 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22883 @end lisp
22884
22885 @end itemize
22886
22887
22888 @node Faces and Fonts
22889 @section Faces and Fonts
22890 @cindex faces
22891 @cindex fonts
22892 @cindex colors
22893
22894 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22895 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22896 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22897 interface.
22898
22899
22900 @node Mode Lines
22901 @section Mode Lines
22902 @cindex mode lines
22903
22904 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22905 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22906 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22907 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22908 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22909 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22910 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22911 quicker.
22912
22913 @cindex display-time
22914
22915 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22916 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22917 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22918 to display (e.g., the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22919 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22920 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22921 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22922 additional elements on the mode line (e.g., a clock), you should modify
22923 this variable:
22924
22925 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22926 @lisp
22927 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22928 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22929 (+ 21
22930 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22931 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22932 (length display-time-string)))))
22933 @end lisp
22934
22935 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22936 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22937 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22938 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22939 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22940
22941
22942 @node Highlighting and Menus
22943 @section Highlighting and Menus
22944 @cindex visual
22945 @cindex highlighting
22946 @cindex menus
22947
22948 @vindex gnus-visual
22949 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22950 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22951 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22952 file.
22953
22954 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22955 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22956
22957 @table @code
22958 @item group-highlight
22959 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22960 @item summary-highlight
22961 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22962 @item article-highlight
22963 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22964 @item highlight
22965 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22966 @item group-menu
22967 Create menus in the group buffer.
22968 @item summary-menu
22969 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22970 @item article-menu
22971 Create menus in the article buffer.
22972 @item browse-menu
22973 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22974 @item server-menu
22975 Create menus in the server buffer.
22976 @item score-menu
22977 Create menus in the score buffers.
22978 @item menu
22979 Create menus in all buffers.
22980 @end table
22981
22982 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22983 buffers, you could say something like:
22984
22985 @lisp
22986 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22987 @end lisp
22988
22989 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
22990
22991 @lisp
22992 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
22993 @end lisp
22994
22995 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
22996 in all Gnus buffers.
22997
22998 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
22999
23000 @table @code
23001 @item gnus-mouse-face
23002 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
23003 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
23004 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
23005
23006 @end table
23007
23008 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
23009
23010 @table @code
23011
23012 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
23013 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
23014 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
23015
23016 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
23017 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
23018 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
23019
23020 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
23021 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
23022 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
23023
23024 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
23025 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
23026 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
23027
23028 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
23029 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
23030 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
23031
23032 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
23033 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
23034 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
23035
23036 @end table
23037
23038
23039 @node Daemons
23040 @section Daemons
23041 @cindex demons
23042 @cindex daemons
23043
23044 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
23045 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
23046 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
23047 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
23048 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
23049
23050 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
23051 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
23052 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
23053
23054 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
23055 been idle for thirty minutes:
23056
23057 @lisp
23058 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
23059 @end lisp
23060
23061 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
23062 Emacs is idle:
23063
23064 @lisp
23065 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
23066 @end lisp
23067
23068 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
23069 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
23070 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23071
23072 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
23073 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
23074 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
23075 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
23076
23077 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
23078 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
23079 @var{idle} minutes.
23080
23081 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
23082 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
23083 minutes.
23084
23085 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
23086 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
23087 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
23088
23089 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
23090 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
23091 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
23092 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
23093
23094 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
23095 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23096
23097 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
23098 @lisp
23099 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
23100 @end lisp
23101
23102 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
23103 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
23104 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
23105 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
23106 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
23107 @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
23108 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
23109 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
23110 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
23111 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
23112
23113 @findex gnus-demon-init
23114 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
23115 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
23116 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
23117 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
23118 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
23119
23120 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
23121 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
23122 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
23123 behave.
23124
23125
23126 @node Undo
23127 @section Undo
23128 @cindex undo
23129
23130 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
23131 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
23132 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
23133
23134 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
23135 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
23136 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
23137 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
23138 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
23139 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
23140 @code{undo} function.
23141
23142 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
23143 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
23144 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
23145 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
23146 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
23147 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
23148 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
23149 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
23150 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
23151 never be totally undoable.
23152
23153 @findex gnus-undo-mode
23154 @vindex gnus-use-undo
23155 @findex gnus-undo
23156 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
23157 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
23158 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
23159 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
23160 command.
23161
23162
23163 @node Predicate Specifiers
23164 @section Predicate Specifiers
23165 @cindex predicate specifiers
23166
23167 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
23168 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
23169 to type all that much.
23170
23171 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
23172
23173 Here's an example:
23174
23175 @lisp
23176 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
23177 gnus-article-unread-p)
23178 @end lisp
23179
23180 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
23181 functions all take one parameter.
23182
23183 @findex gnus-make-predicate
23184 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
23185 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
23186 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
23187 specifier.
23188
23189
23190 @node Moderation
23191 @section Moderation
23192 @cindex moderation
23193
23194 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
23195 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
23196 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
23197 get a copy.
23198
23199 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
23200 buffers. Put
23201
23202 @lisp
23203 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
23204 @end lisp
23205
23206 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
23207
23208 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
23209 supposed to work:
23210
23211 @enumerate
23212 @item
23213 You split your incoming mail by matching on
23214 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
23215 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
23216
23217 @item
23218 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
23219 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
23220
23221 @item
23222 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
23223 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
23224 @kbd{c} command.
23225 @end enumerate
23226
23227 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
23228
23229 @lisp
23230 (setq gnus-moderated-list
23231 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
23232 @end lisp
23233
23234
23235 @node Fetching a Group
23236 @section Fetching a Group
23237 @cindex fetching a group
23238
23239 @findex gnus-fetch-group
23240 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
23241 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
23242 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
23243 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
23244 It takes the group name as a parameter.
23245
23246
23247 @node Image Enhancements
23248 @section Image Enhancements
23249
23250 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
23251 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
23252 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
23253
23254 @menu
23255 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
23256 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
23257 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
23258 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
23259 * Gravatars:: Display the avatar of people you read.
23260 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
23261 @end menu
23262
23263
23264 @node X-Face
23265 @subsection X-Face
23266 @cindex x-face
23267
23268 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
23269 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
23270 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
23271 readers.
23272
23273 @cindex x-face
23274 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
23275 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
23276 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
23277 @iftex
23278 @iflatex
23279 \include{xface}
23280 @end iflatex
23281 @end iftex
23282 @c @anchor{X-Face}
23283
23284 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
23285 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
23286 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
23287 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
23288 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
23289 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
23290 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
23291 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
23292 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
23293 @code{display} program.
23294
23295 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
23296 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
23297 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
23298 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
23299 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
23300 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
23301 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
23302 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
23303
23304 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
23305 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
23306 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
23307 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
23308 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
23309 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
23310
23311 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
23312 @code{xface}).
23313
23314 @noindent
23315 Face and variable:
23316
23317 @table @code
23318 @item gnus-x-face
23319 @vindex gnus-x-face
23320 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
23321 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
23322 default colors are black and white.
23323
23324 @item gnus-face-properties-alist
23325 @vindex gnus-face-properties-alist
23326 Alist of image types and properties applied to Face (@pxref{Face}) and
23327 X-Face images. The default value is @code{((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face))
23328 (png . nil))} for Emacs or @code{((xface . (:face gnus-x-face)))} for
23329 XEmacs. Here are examples:
23330
23331 @lisp
23332 ;; Specify the altitude of Face and X-Face images in the From header.
23333 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23334 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :ascent 80))
23335 (png . (:ascent 80))))
23336
23337 ;; Show Face and X-Face images as pressed buttons.
23338 (setq gnus-face-properties-alist
23339 '((pbm . (:face gnus-x-face :relief -2))
23340 (png . (:relief -2))))
23341 @end lisp
23342
23343 @pxref{Image Descriptors, ,Image Descriptors, elisp, The Emacs Lisp
23344 Reference Manual} for the valid properties for various image types.
23345 Currently, @code{pbm} is used for X-Face images and @code{png} is used
23346 for Face images in Emacs. Only the @code{:face} property is effective
23347 on the @code{xface} image type in XEmacs if it is built with the
23348 @samp{libcompface} library.
23349 @end table
23350
23351 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
23352 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
23353 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
23354 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
23355 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
23356 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
23357
23358 @findex gnus-random-x-face
23359 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
23360 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
23361 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
23362 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
23363 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
23364 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
23365 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
23366 header data as a string.
23367
23368 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
23369 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
23370 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
23371 randomly generated data.
23372
23373 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
23374 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
23375 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
23376 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
23377 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
23378
23379 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
23380 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23381
23382 @lisp
23383 (setq message-required-news-headers
23384 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23385 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
23386 @end lisp
23387
23388 Using the last function would be something like this:
23389
23390 @lisp
23391 (setq message-required-news-headers
23392 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23393 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
23394 (gnus-x-face-from-file
23395 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
23396 @end lisp
23397
23398
23399 @node Face
23400 @subsection Face
23401 @cindex face
23402
23403 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
23404
23405 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
23406 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
23407 represent the author of the message.
23408
23409 @cindex face
23410 @findex gnus-article-display-face
23411 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
23412 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
23413 specifications.
23414
23415 The @code{gnus-face-properties-alist} variable affects the appearance of
23416 displayed Face images. @xref{X-Face}.
23417
23418 Viewing a @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
23419 PNG images.
23420 @c Maybe add this:
23421 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
23422 @c (featurep 'png)
23423 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
23424
23425 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
23426 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
23427
23428 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
23429 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
23430 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
23431
23432 @findex gnus-face-from-file
23433 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
23434 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
23435 converts the file to Face format by using the
23436 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
23437
23438 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
23439 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23440
23441 @lisp
23442 (setq message-required-news-headers
23443 (nconc message-required-news-headers
23444 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
23445 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
23446 @end lisp
23447
23448
23449 @node Smileys
23450 @subsection Smileys
23451 @cindex smileys
23452
23453 @iftex
23454 @iflatex
23455 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
23456 \input{smiley}
23457 @end iflatex
23458 @end iftex
23459
23460 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
23461 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
23462
23463 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
23464 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
23465
23466 @lisp
23467 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
23468 @end lisp
23469
23470 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
23471 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
23472 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
23473 text and maps that to file names.
23474
23475 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
23476 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
23477 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
23478 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
23479 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
23480 displayed.
23481
23482 The following variables customize the appearance of the smileys:
23483
23484 @table @code
23485
23486 @item smiley-style
23487 @vindex smiley-style
23488 Specifies the smiley style. Predefined smiley styles include
23489 @code{low-color} (small 13x14 pixel, three-color images), @code{medium}
23490 (more colorful images, 16x16 pixel), and @code{grayscale} (grayscale
23491 images, 14x14 pixel). The default depends on the height of the default
23492 face.
23493
23494 @item smiley-data-directory
23495 @vindex smiley-data-directory
23496 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files. You shouldn't set this
23497 variable anymore. Customize @code{smiley-style} instead.
23498
23499 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
23500 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
23501 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
23502
23503 @end table
23504
23505
23506 @node Picons
23507 @subsection Picons
23508
23509 @iftex
23510 @iflatex
23511 \include{picons}
23512 @end iflatex
23513 @end iftex
23514
23515 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
23516 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
23517 over your shoulder as you read news.
23518
23519 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
23520
23521 @iftex
23522 @iflatex
23523 \margindex{}
23524 @end iflatex
23525 @end iftex
23526
23527 @quotation
23528 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23529 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23530 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23531 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23532 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23533 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23534 @code{GIF} formats.
23535 @end quotation
23536
23537 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23538 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23539 point your Web browser at
23540 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23541
23542 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23543 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23544
23545 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23546 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23547 Picons databases.
23548
23549 @vindex gnus-picon-style
23550 The variable @code{gnus-picon-style} controls how picons are displayed.
23551 If @code{inline}, the textual representation is replaced. If
23552 @code{right}, picons are added right to the textual representation.
23553
23554 @vindex gnus-picon-properties
23555 The value of the variable @code{gnus-picon-properties} is a list of
23556 properties applied to picons.
23557
23558 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23559
23560 @table @code
23561
23562 @item gnus-picon-databases
23563 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23564 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23565 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23566 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23567 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23568
23569 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23570 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23571 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23572 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23573
23574 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23575 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23576 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23577 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23578
23579 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23580 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23581 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23582 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23583 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23584
23585 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23586 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23587 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23588 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23589
23590 @item gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23591 @vindex gnus-picon-inhibit-top-level-domains
23592 If non-@code{nil} (which is the default), don't display picons for
23593 things like @samp{.net} and @samp{.de}, which aren't usually very
23594 interesting.
23595
23596 @end table
23597
23598 @node Gravatars
23599 @subsection Gravatars
23600
23601 @iftex
23602 @iflatex
23603 \include{gravatars}
23604 @end iflatex
23605 @end iftex
23606
23607 A gravatar is an image registered to an e-mail address.
23608
23609 You can submit yours on-line at @uref{http://www.gravatar.com}.
23610
23611 The following variables offer control over how things are displayed.
23612
23613 @table @code
23614
23615 @item gnus-gravatar-size
23616 @vindex gnus-gravatar-size
23617 The size in pixels of gravatars. Gravatars are always square, so one
23618 number for the size is enough.
23619
23620 @item gnus-gravatar-properties
23621 @vindex gnus-gravatar-properties
23622 List of image properties applied to Gravatar images.
23623
23624 @item gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23625 @vindex gnus-gravatar-too-ugly
23626 Regexp that matches mail addresses or names of people of which avatars
23627 should not be displayed, or @code{nil}. It default to the value of
23628 @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (@pxref{X-Face}).
23629
23630 @end table
23631
23632 If you want to see them in the From field, set:
23633 @lisp
23634 (setq gnus-treat-from-gravatar 'head)
23635 @end lisp
23636
23637 If you want to see them in the Cc and To fields, set:
23638
23639 @lisp
23640 (setq gnus-treat-mail-gravatar 'head)
23641 @end lisp
23642
23643
23644 @node XVarious
23645 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23646
23647 @table @code
23648 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23649 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23650 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23651 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23652 unusual directory structure.
23653
23654 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23655 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23656 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23657 default.
23658
23659 @end table
23660
23661 @subsubsection Toolbar
23662
23663 @table @code
23664
23665 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23666 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23667 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23668 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23669 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23670 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23671 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23672 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23673
23674 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23675 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23676 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23677 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23678 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23679 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23680
23681 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23682 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23683 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23684
23685 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23686 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23687 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23688
23689 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23690 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23691 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23692
23693 @end table
23694
23695 @iftex
23696 @iflatex
23697 \margindex{}
23698 @end iflatex
23699 @end iftex
23700
23701
23702 @node Fuzzy Matching
23703 @section Fuzzy Matching
23704 @cindex fuzzy matching
23705
23706 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23707 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23708
23709 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23710 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23711 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23712
23713 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23714 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23715 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23716 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23717 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23718
23719
23720 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23721 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23722 @cindex email spam
23723 @cindex spam
23724 @cindex UCE
23725 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23726
23727 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23728 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23729 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23730 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23731 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23732 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23733 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23734 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23735 in the end.
23736
23737 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23738 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23739 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23740 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23741 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23742 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23743
23744 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23745
23746 @menu
23747 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23748 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23749 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23750 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23751 @end menu
23752
23753 @node The problem of spam
23754 @subsection The problem of spam
23755 @cindex email spam
23756 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23757 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23758 @cindex UCE
23759 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23760
23761 First, some background on spam.
23762
23763 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23764 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23765 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23766 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23767 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23768 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23769 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23770 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23771 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23772
23773 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23774 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23775 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23776 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23777 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23778 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23779 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23780 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23781 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23782 and processing.
23783
23784 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23785 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23786 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23787 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23788 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23789 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23790 from Bulgarian IPs.
23791
23792 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23793 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23794 etc.)@: or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.)@: from contacting
23795 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23796
23797 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23798 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23799 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23800 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23801
23802 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23803 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23804 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23805 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23806 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23807 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23808 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23809 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23810 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23811
23812 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23813 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23814 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23815 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23816 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23817 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23818 down for some time because of the incident.
23819
23820 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23821 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23822 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23823 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23824 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23825 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23826 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23827 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23828 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23829 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23830 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23831
23832 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23833 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23834 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23835 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23836 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23837 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23838 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23839 spam plague.
23840
23841 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23842 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23843 @cindex email spam
23844 @cindex spam
23845 @cindex UCE
23846 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23847
23848 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23849 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23850
23851 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23852 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23853 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23854 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23855 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23856 part of the mail address.)
23857
23858 @lisp
23859 (setq message-default-news-headers
23860 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23861 @end lisp
23862
23863 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23864 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23865
23866 @lisp
23867 (...
23868 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23869 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23870 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23871 "spam"))
23872 ...)
23873 @end lisp
23874
23875 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23876 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23877 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23878 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23879
23880 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23881 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23882 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23883 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23884 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23885 your fancy split rule in this way:
23886
23887 @lisp
23888 (
23889 ...
23890 (to "larsi" "misc")
23891 "spam")
23892 @end lisp
23893
23894 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23895 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23896 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23897 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23898 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23899
23900 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23901 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23902 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23903 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23904
23905 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23906
23907
23908 @node SpamAssassin
23909 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23910 @cindex SpamAssassin
23911 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23912 @cindex DCC
23913
23914 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23915 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23916 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23917 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23918 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23919 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23920 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23921
23922 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23923 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23924 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23925 recipes.
23926
23927 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23928 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23929 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23930 Specifiers}) follow.
23931
23932 @lisp
23933 (setq mail-sources
23934 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23935 (pop :user "jrl"
23936 :server "pophost"
23937 :postscript
23938 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23939 @end lisp
23940
23941 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23942 the mail contain, e.g., a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23943 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23944
23945 @lisp
23946 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23947 ...))
23948 @end lisp
23949
23950 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23951
23952 @lisp
23953 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23954 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23955 ...))
23956 @end lisp
23957
23958 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23959 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23960 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23961 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23962
23963 @lisp
23964 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23965 ...))
23966 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23967 (save-excursion
23968 (save-restriction
23969 (widen)
23970 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23971 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23972 "spam"))))
23973 @end lisp
23974
23975 Note that with the nnimap back end, message bodies will not be
23976 downloaded by default. You need to set
23977 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23978 (@pxref{Client-Side IMAP Splitting}).
23979
23980 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23981 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23982 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23983
23984 @lisp
23985 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23986 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23987 (interactive)
23988 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d" t)
23989 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
23990 @end lisp
23991
23992 @node Hashcash
23993 @subsection Hashcash
23994 @cindex hashcash
23995
23996 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
23997 costly and demonstrably unique for each message they send. This has
23998 the obvious drawback that you cannot rely on everyone in the world
23999 using this technique, since it is not part of the Internet standards,
24000 but it may be useful in smaller communities.
24001
24002 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
24003 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
24004 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
24005 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
24006 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
24007 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
24008 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
24009 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
24010 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
24011 one of them separately.
24012
24013 @cindex X-Hashcash
24014 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
24015 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
24016 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:} header.
24017 For more details, and for the external application @code{hashcash} you
24018 need to install to use this feature, see
24019 @uref{http://www.hashcash.org/}. Even more information can be found
24020 at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
24021
24022 If you wish to generate hashcash for each message you send, you can
24023 customize @code{message-generate-hashcash} (@pxref{Mail Headers, ,Mail
24024 Headers,message, The Message Manual}), as in:
24025
24026 @lisp
24027 (setq message-generate-hashcash t)
24028 @end lisp
24029
24030 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
24031
24032 @table @code
24033
24034 @item hashcash-default-payment
24035 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
24036 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
24037 should consist of. By default this is 20. Suggested useful values
24038 include 17 to 29.
24039
24040 @item hashcash-payment-alist
24041 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
24042 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
24043 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
24044 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
24045 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
24046 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
24047 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
24048 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
24049
24050 @item hashcash-path
24051 @vindex hashcash-path
24052 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed. This variable should
24053 be automatically set by @code{executable-find}, but if it's @code{nil}
24054 (usually because the @code{hashcash} binary is not in your path)
24055 you'll get a warning when you check hashcash payments and an error
24056 when you generate hashcash payments.
24057
24058 @end table
24059
24060 Gnus can verify hashcash cookies, although this can also be done by
24061 hand customized mail filtering scripts. To verify a hashcash cookie
24062 in a message, use the @code{mail-check-payment} function in the
24063 @code{hashcash.el} library. You can also use the @code{spam.el}
24064 package with the @code{spam-use-hashcash} back end to validate hashcash
24065 cookies in incoming mail and filter mail accordingly (@pxref{Anti-spam
24066 Hashcash Payments}).
24067
24068 @node Spam Package
24069 @section Spam Package
24070 @cindex spam filtering
24071 @cindex spam
24072
24073 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
24074 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
24075 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
24076 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
24077
24078 @menu
24079 * Spam Package Introduction::
24080 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
24081 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
24082 * Spam and Ham Processors::
24083 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
24084 * Spam Back Ends::
24085 * Extending the Spam package::
24086 * Spam Statistics Package::
24087 @end menu
24088
24089 @node Spam Package Introduction
24090 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
24091 @cindex spam filtering
24092 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
24093 @cindex spam
24094
24095 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
24096 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
24097
24098 Make sure you read the section on the @code{spam.el} sequence of
24099 events. See @xref{Extending the Spam package}.
24100
24101 @cindex spam-initialize
24102 @vindex spam-use-stat
24103 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
24104 @code{spam-initialize}:
24105
24106 @example
24107 (spam-initialize)
24108 @end example
24109
24110 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
24111 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
24112 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
24113 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
24114 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
24115
24116 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
24117 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
24118
24119 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
24120 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
24121
24122 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
24123 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
24124 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
24125 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
24126 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
24127
24128 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
24129 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
24130 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
24131 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
24132 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
24133 Groups}.
24134
24135 @cindex spam back ends
24136 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
24137 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
24138 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
24139 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
24140 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24141
24142 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
24143 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
24144
24145 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
24146 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
24147 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
24148 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
24149 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
24150 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
24151 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
24152
24153 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
24154 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
24155 point, the Spam package does several things:
24156
24157 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
24158 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
24159 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
24160 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
24161 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
24162 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
24163 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
24164 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
24165 Ham Processors}.
24166
24167 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
24168 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
24169 group:
24170
24171 @table @kbd
24172 @item $
24173 @itemx M-d
24174 @itemx M s x
24175 @itemx S x
24176 @kindex $ (Summary)
24177 @kindex M-d (Summary)
24178 @kindex S x (Summary)
24179 @kindex M s x (Summary)
24180 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24181 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
24182 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
24183 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
24184 @end table
24185
24186 @noindent
24187 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
24188 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
24189
24190 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
24191 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
24192 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
24193 to be processed as ham by setting
24194 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
24195 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
24196
24197 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24198 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24199 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
24200 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
24201 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
24202 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
24203 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
24204 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
24205 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
24206 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
24207 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
24208 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
24209
24210 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
24211 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
24212 want each article to be processed only once, load the
24213 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
24214 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
24215 Configuration Examples}.
24216
24217 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
24218 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
24219 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
24220 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
24221
24222 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
24223 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
24224
24225 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
24226 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
24227 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
24228
24229 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
24230 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
24231 @cindex spam filtering
24232 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
24233 @cindex spam
24234
24235 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
24236 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
24237 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
24238 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
24239 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
24240
24241 @example
24242 (: spam-split)
24243 @end example
24244
24245 @vindex spam-split-group
24246 @noindent
24247 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
24248 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
24249 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
24250 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
24251 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
24252 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
24253 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
24254 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
24255 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
24256
24257 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
24258
24259 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
24260 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
24261 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
24262 you should also set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to
24263 @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can ``scan''
24264 the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only retrieves
24265 the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells it to
24266 retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by default
24267 because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
24268 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Client-Side
24269 IMAP Splitting}.
24270
24271 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
24272 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
24273 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
24274 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
24275 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
24276 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
24277 ends, and the following split rule:
24278
24279 @example
24280 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24281 (any "ding" "ding")
24282 (: spam-split)
24283 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24284 "mail")
24285 @end example
24286
24287 @noindent
24288 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
24289 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
24290 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
24291 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
24292 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
24293 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
24294
24295 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
24296 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
24297 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
24298 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
24299
24300 @example
24301 nnimap-split-fancy
24302 '(|
24303 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
24304 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24305 (any "ding" "ding")
24306 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
24307 (: spam-split)
24308 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24309 "mail")
24310 @end example
24311
24312 @noindent
24313 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
24314 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
24315 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
24316 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
24317 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
24318 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
24319 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
24320
24321 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24322 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24323 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24324 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
24325
24326 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
24327 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
24328 @c don't.}
24329
24330 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
24331 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
24332
24333 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
24334 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
24335 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
24336 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
24337
24338 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
24339 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
24340 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
24341 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
24342
24343 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
24344 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
24345 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
24346
24347 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
24348 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
24349 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
24350 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
24351 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
24352 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
24353 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
24354
24355 @node Spam and Ham Processors
24356 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
24357 @cindex spam filtering
24358 @cindex spam filtering variables
24359 @cindex spam variables
24360 @cindex spam
24361
24362 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
24363 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
24364 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
24365 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
24366 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
24367 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
24368 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
24369
24370 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
24371 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
24372 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
24373 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
24374
24375 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24376 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
24377 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
24378 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
24379 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
24380 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
24381 by customizing the corresponding variable
24382 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
24383 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
24384 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
24385 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
24386 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
24387 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
24388 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
24389 default.
24390
24391 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
24392 @cindex $
24393 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
24394 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
24395 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
24396 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
24397 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
24398 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
24399 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
24400 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
24401 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
24402 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
24403 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
24404 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
24405 processor which will study them as spam samples.
24406
24407 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
24408 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
24409 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
24410 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
24411 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
24412 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
24413 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
24414 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
24415
24416 @defvar ham-marks
24417 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24418 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
24419 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
24420 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
24421 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
24422 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
24423 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
24424 happy for you.
24425 @end defvar
24426
24427 @defvar spam-marks
24428 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
24429 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
24430 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
24431 you really want to.
24432 @end defvar
24433
24434 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
24435 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
24436 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
24437 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
24438 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
24439 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
24440 and nothing else.
24441
24442 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
24443 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
24444 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
24445 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
24446 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
24447 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
24448 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
24449 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
24450 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
24451 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
24452 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
24453 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
24454 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
24455 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
24456 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
24457
24458 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24459 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24460
24461 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24462 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
24463 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
24464
24465 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
24466 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
24467
24468 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
24469 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
24470 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
24471 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
24472 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
24473
24474 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
24475 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
24476 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
24477 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
24478 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
24479 it there.
24480
24481 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
24482 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
24483 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
24484 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
24485 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
24486 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
24487 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
24488 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
24489 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
24490 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
24491 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
24492 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
24493 group buffer then you need it here as well.
24494
24495 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only back end such as
24496 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
24497
24498 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
24499 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
24500 training} groups.
24501
24502 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
24503 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
24504 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
24505 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
24506 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
24507 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
24508 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
24509
24510 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
24511 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
24512 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
24513 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
24514
24515 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
24516 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
24517 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
24518 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
24519 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
24520 from the mail server.
24521
24522 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
24523 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
24524 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
24525 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
24526
24527 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
24528 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
24529 @cindex spam filtering
24530 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
24531 @cindex spam configuration examples
24532 @cindex spam
24533
24534 @subsubheading Ted's setup
24535
24536 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
24537 @example
24538 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
24539 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
24540 (gnus-registry-initialize)
24541 (spam-initialize)
24542
24543 (setq
24544 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
24545 spam-use-BBDB t
24546 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
24547 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
24548 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
24549 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24550 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
24551 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
24552 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
24553 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
24554 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
24555 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
24556 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
24557 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
24558 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
24559 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
24560 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
24561 (any "ding" "ding")
24562 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
24563 (: spam-split)
24564 ;; @r{default mailbox}
24565 "mail"))
24566
24567 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
24568
24569 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
24570 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
24571 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
24572 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
24573
24574 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24575
24576 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
24577 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
24578 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
24579 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
24580 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
24581
24582 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
24583 ((spam-autodetect . t))
24584
24585 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
24586
24587 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
24588 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
24589
24590 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
24591 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
24592 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
24593
24594 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
24595
24596 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24597 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24598
24599 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24600 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24601 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24602 (ham-marks
24603 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24604 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24605 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24606 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24607
24608 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24609 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24610 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24611
24612 @end example
24613
24614 @subsubheading Using @code{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24615 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24616
24617 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24618 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24619 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24620 i.e., to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24621 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24622 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24623 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24624 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24625 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24626
24627 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24628 does most of the job for me:
24629
24630 @lisp
24631 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24632 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24633 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24634 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24635 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24636 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24637 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24638 @end lisp
24639
24640 @itemize
24641
24642 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24643
24644 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24645 (i.e., legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24646 bogofilter or DCC).
24647
24648 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24649 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24650 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24651 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24652 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24653 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24654 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24655
24656 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24657 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24658 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e., chars) makes finding
24659 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24660 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24661 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24662
24663 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24664
24665 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24666 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24667 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24668 @samp{training.spam}.
24669 @end itemize
24670
24671 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24672
24673 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24674
24675 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24676 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24677 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24678
24679 @lisp
24680 ("^gmane\\."
24681 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24682 @end lisp
24683
24684 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24685 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24686 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e., the article numbers are
24687 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24688 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24689
24690 @node Spam Back Ends
24691 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24692 @cindex spam back ends
24693
24694 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24695 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24696 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24697 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24698 Processors}).
24699
24700 @menu
24701 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24702 * BBDB Whitelists::
24703 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24704 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24705 * Blackholes::
24706 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24707 * Bogofilter::
24708 * SpamAssassin back end::
24709 * ifile spam filtering::
24710 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24711 * SpamOracle::
24712 @end menu
24713
24714 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24715 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24716 @cindex spam filtering
24717 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24718 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24719 @cindex spam
24720
24721 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24722
24723 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24724 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24725 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24726 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24727 be spammers.
24728
24729 @end defvar
24730
24731 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24732
24733 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24734 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24735 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24736 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24737 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24738
24739 @end defvar
24740
24741 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24742
24743 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24744 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24745 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24746
24747 @end defvar
24748
24749 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24750
24751 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24752 customizing the group parameters or the
24753 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24754 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24755 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24756
24757 @emph{WARNING}
24758
24759 Instead of the obsolete
24760 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24761 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24762 the same way, we promise.
24763
24764 @end defvar
24765
24766 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24767
24768 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24769 customizing the group parameters or the
24770 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24771 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24772 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24773 whitelist.
24774
24775 @emph{WARNING}
24776
24777 Instead of the obsolete
24778 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24779 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24780 the same way, we promise.
24781
24782 @end defvar
24783
24784 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24785 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24786 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24787 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24788 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24789
24790 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24791 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24792 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24793 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24794
24795 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24796 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24797 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24798 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24799 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24800 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24801
24802 @node BBDB Whitelists
24803 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24804 @cindex spam filtering
24805 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24806 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24807 @cindex spam
24808
24809 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24810
24811 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24812 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24813 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24814 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24815 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24816 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24817 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24818
24819 @end defvar
24820
24821 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24822
24823 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24824 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24825 unless the sender is in the BBDB@. Use with care. Only sender
24826 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24827 classified as spammers.
24828
24829 While @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} @emph{can} be used as an alias
24830 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} as far as @code{spam.el} is concerned, it is
24831 @emph{not} a separate back end. If you set
24832 @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} to t, @emph{all} your BBDB splitting
24833 will be exclusive.
24834
24835 @end defvar
24836
24837 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24838
24839 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24840 customizing the group parameters or the
24841 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24842 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24843 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24844 BBDB.
24845
24846 @emph{WARNING}
24847
24848 Instead of the obsolete
24849 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24850 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24851 the same way, we promise.
24852
24853 @end defvar
24854
24855 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24856 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24857 @cindex spam reporting
24858 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24859 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24860 @cindex spam
24861
24862 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24863
24864 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24865 customizing the group parameters or the
24866 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24867 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24868 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24869 HTTP request.
24870
24871 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24872
24873 @emph{WARNING}
24874
24875 Instead of the obsolete
24876 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24877 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24878 same way, we promise.
24879
24880 @end defvar
24881
24882 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24883
24884 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24885 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24886 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24887 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24888 @code{spam-report.el} will fetch the number from the article headers.
24889
24890 @end defvar
24891
24892 @defvar spam-report-user-mail-address
24893
24894 Mail address exposed in the User-Agent spam reports to Gmane. It allows
24895 the Gmane administrators to contact you in case of misreports. The
24896 default is @code{user-mail-address}.
24897
24898 @end defvar
24899
24900 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24901 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24902 @cindex spam filtering
24903 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24904 @cindex spam
24905
24906 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24907
24908 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24909 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24910 instead of the sender address. Messages without a hashcash payment
24911 token will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an explicit
24912 filter, meaning that unless a hashcash token is found, the messages
24913 are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24914
24915 @end defvar
24916
24917 @node Blackholes
24918 @subsubsection Blackholes
24919 @cindex spam filtering
24920 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24921 @cindex spam
24922
24923 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24924
24925 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24926 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24927 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24928 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24929 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24930 contains outdated servers.
24931
24932 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24933 @code{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24934 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24935 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24936 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24937 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24938
24939 @end defvar
24940
24941 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24942
24943 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24944
24945 @end defvar
24946
24947 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24948
24949 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24950 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24951
24952 @end defvar
24953
24954 @defvar spam-use-dig
24955
24956 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24957 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24958
24959 @end defvar
24960
24961 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24962 ham processor for blackholes.
24963
24964 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24965 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24966 @cindex spam filtering
24967 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24968 @cindex spam
24969
24970 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24971
24972 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24973 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24974 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24975 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24976 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24977 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24978
24979 @end defvar
24980
24981 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24982
24983 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24984 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24985
24986 @end defvar
24987
24988 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
24989
24990 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24991 the message, positively identify it as ham.
24992
24993 @end defvar
24994
24995 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
24996 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
24997
24998 @node Bogofilter
24999 @subsubsection Bogofilter
25000 @cindex spam filtering
25001 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
25002 @cindex spam
25003
25004 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
25005
25006 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25007 speedy Bogofilter.
25008
25009 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
25010 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
25011 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
25012 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
25013 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
25014 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
25015
25016 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
25017 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
25018 documentation.
25019
25020 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
25021 processing will be turned off.
25022
25023 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
25024
25025 @end defvar
25026
25027 @table @kbd
25028 @item M s t
25029 @itemx S t
25030 @kindex M s t
25031 @kindex S t
25032 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
25033 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
25034 @end table
25035
25036 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
25037
25038 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
25039 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
25040 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
25041 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
25042 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
25043 installation documents for details.
25044
25045 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
25046
25047 @end defvar
25048
25049 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
25050 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25051 customizing the group parameters or the
25052 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25053 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
25054 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
25055
25056 @emph{WARNING}
25057
25058 Instead of the obsolete
25059 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25060 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25061 the same way, we promise.
25062 @end defvar
25063
25064 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
25065 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25066 customizing the group parameters or the
25067 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25068 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25069 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
25070 of non-spam messages.
25071
25072 @emph{WARNING}
25073
25074 Instead of the obsolete
25075 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
25076 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
25077 the same way, we promise.
25078 @end defvar
25079
25080 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
25081
25082 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
25083 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
25084 database directory.
25085
25086 @end defvar
25087
25088 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
25089 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25090 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
25091 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
25092 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
25093 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
25094
25095 @node SpamAssassin back end
25096 @subsubsection SpamAssassin back end
25097 @cindex spam filtering
25098 @cindex spamassassin, spam filtering
25099 @cindex spam
25100
25101 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin
25102
25103 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use SpamAssassin.
25104
25105 SpamAssassin assigns a score to each article based on a set of rules
25106 and tests, including a Bayesian filter. The Bayesian filter can be
25107 trained by associating the @samp{$} mark for spam articles. The
25108 spam score can be viewed by using the command @kbd{S t} in summary
25109 mode.
25110
25111 If you set this variable, each article will be processed by
25112 SpamAssassin when @code{spam-split} is called. If your mail is
25113 preprocessed by SpamAssassin, and you want to just use the
25114 SpamAssassin headers, set @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}
25115 instead.
25116
25117 You should not enable this if you use
25118 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers}.
25119
25120 @end defvar
25121
25122 @defvar spam-use-spamassassin-headers
25123
25124 Set this variable if your mail is preprocessed by SpamAssassin and
25125 want @code{spam-split} to split based on the SpamAssassin headers.
25126
25127 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-spamassassin}.
25128
25129 @end defvar
25130
25131 @defvar spam-spamassassin-program
25132
25133 This variable points to the SpamAssassin executable. If you have
25134 @code{spamd} running, you can set this variable to the @code{spamc}
25135 executable for faster processing. See the SpamAssassin documentation
25136 for more information on @code{spamd}/@code{spamc}.
25137
25138 @end defvar
25139
25140 SpamAssassin is a powerful and flexible spam filter that uses a wide
25141 variety of tests to identify spam. A ham and a spam processors are
25142 provided, plus the @code{spam-use-spamassassin} and
25143 @code{spam-use-spamassassin-headers} variables to indicate to
25144 spam-split that SpamAssassin should be either used, or has already
25145 been used on the article. The 2.63 version of SpamAssassin was used
25146 to test this functionality.
25147
25148 @node ifile spam filtering
25149 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
25150 @cindex spam filtering
25151 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
25152 @cindex spam
25153
25154 @defvar spam-use-ifile
25155
25156 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
25157 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
25158
25159 @end defvar
25160
25161 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
25162
25163 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
25164 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
25165 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
25166
25167 @end defvar
25168
25169 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
25170
25171 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
25172 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
25173 the default value of @samp{spam}.
25174 @end defvar
25175
25176 @defvar spam-ifile-database
25177
25178 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
25179 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
25180
25181 @end defvar
25182
25183 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
25184 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
25185 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
25186 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
25187 functionality.
25188
25189 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
25190 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
25191 @cindex spam filtering
25192 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
25193 @cindex spam-stat
25194 @cindex spam
25195
25196 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
25197 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
25198 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
25199 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
25200 spam-stat dictionary}.
25201
25202 @defvar spam-use-stat
25203
25204 @end defvar
25205
25206 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
25207 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25208 customizing the group parameters or the
25209 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25210 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
25211 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
25212
25213 @emph{WARNING}
25214
25215 Instead of the obsolete
25216 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25217 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25218 the same way, we promise.
25219 @end defvar
25220
25221 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
25222 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25223 customizing the group parameters or the
25224 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
25225 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
25226 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
25227 of non-spam messages.
25228
25229 @emph{WARNING}
25230
25231 Instead of the obsolete
25232 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
25233 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
25234 the same way, we promise.
25235 @end defvar
25236
25237 This enables @code{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
25238 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
25239 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
25240 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
25241 @code{spam-split} are provided.
25242
25243 @node SpamOracle
25244 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
25245 @cindex spam filtering
25246 @cindex SpamOracle
25247 @cindex spam
25248
25249 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
25250 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
25251 installed separately.
25252
25253 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
25254 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
25255 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
25256 mail as a spam mail or not.
25257
25258 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
25259 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
25260 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
25261
25262 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
25263 call SpamOracle.
25264
25265 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
25266 To enable SpamOracle usage by @code{spam.el}, set the variable
25267 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
25268 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
25269 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
25270 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
25271 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
25272 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
25273
25274 @example
25275 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
25276 spam-split-group "Junk"
25277 ;; @r{for nnimap you'll probably want to set nnimap-split-methods, see the manual}
25278 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
25279 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
25280 @end example
25281
25282 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
25283 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
25284 SpamOracle.
25285 @end defvar
25286
25287 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
25288 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
25289 user's PATH@. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
25290 can be customized.
25291 @end defvar
25292
25293 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
25294 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
25295 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
25296 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
25297 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
25298 database to live somewhere special, set
25299 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
25300 @end defvar
25301
25302 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
25303 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
25304 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
25305 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
25306 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
25307 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
25308 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
25309 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
25310 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
25311 @xref{Spam Package}.
25312
25313 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
25314 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25315 customizing the group parameter or the
25316 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25317 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
25318 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
25319
25320 @emph{WARNING}
25321
25322 Instead of the obsolete
25323 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25324 that you use @code{(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25325 the same way, we promise.
25326 @end defvar
25327
25328 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
25329 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
25330 customizing the group parameter or the
25331 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
25332 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
25333 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
25334 messages.
25335
25336 @emph{WARNING}
25337
25338 Instead of the obsolete
25339 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
25340 that you use @code{(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
25341 the same way, we promise.
25342 @end defvar
25343
25344 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
25345 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
25346 messages.
25347 @example
25348 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
25349 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
25350 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
25351 @end example
25352 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
25353 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
25354 (e.g., because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
25355 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
25356 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
25357 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
25358
25359 @node Extending the Spam package
25360 @subsection Extending the Spam package
25361 @cindex spam filtering
25362 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
25363 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
25364
25365 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
25366 incoming mail, provide the following:
25367
25368 @enumerate
25369
25370 @item
25371 Code
25372
25373 @lisp
25374 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
25375 "True if blackbox should be used.")
25376 @end lisp
25377
25378 Write @code{spam-check-blackbox} if Blackbox can check incoming mail.
25379
25380 Write @code{spam-blackbox-register-routine} and
25381 @code{spam-blackbox-unregister-routine} using the bogofilter
25382 register/unregister routines as a start, or other register/unregister
25383 routines more appropriate to Blackbox, if Blackbox can
25384 register/unregister spam and ham.
25385
25386 @item
25387 Functionality
25388
25389 The @code{spam-check-blackbox} function should return @samp{nil} or
25390 @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other conventions. See the
25391 existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for examples of what you can
25392 do, and stick to the template unless you fully understand the reasons
25393 why you aren't.
25394
25395 @end enumerate
25396
25397 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
25398
25399 @enumerate
25400
25401 @item
25402 Code
25403
25404 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
25405 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
25406
25407 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
25408 variables. Instead the form @code{(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
25409 @code{(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
25410 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
25411
25412 @lisp
25413 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
25414 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
25415 Only applicable to spam groups.")
25416
25417 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
25418 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
25419 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
25420
25421 @end lisp
25422
25423 @item
25424 Gnus parameters
25425
25426 Add
25427 @lisp
25428 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
25429 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
25430 @end lisp
25431 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
25432 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
25433 variable customization.
25434
25435 Add
25436 @lisp
25437 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
25438 @end lisp
25439 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
25440 @code{gnus.el} if Blackbox can check incoming mail for spam contents.
25441
25442 Finally, use the appropriate @code{spam-install-*-backend} function in
25443 @code{spam.el}. Here are the available functions.
25444
25445
25446 @enumerate
25447
25448 @item
25449 @code{spam-install-backend-alias}
25450
25451 This function will simply install an alias for a back end that does
25452 everything like the original back end. It is currently only used to
25453 make @code{spam-use-BBDB-exclusive} act like @code{spam-use-BBDB}.
25454
25455 @item
25456 @code{spam-install-nocheck-backend}
25457
25458 This function installs a back end that has no check function, but can
25459 register/unregister ham or spam. The @code{spam-use-gmane} back end is
25460 such a back end.
25461
25462 @item
25463 @code{spam-install-checkonly-backend}
25464
25465 This function will install a back end that can only check incoming mail
25466 for spam contents. It can't register or unregister messages.
25467 @code{spam-use-blackholes} and @code{spam-use-hashcash} are such
25468 back ends.
25469
25470 @item
25471 @code{spam-install-statistical-checkonly-backend}
25472
25473 This function installs a statistical back end (one which requires the
25474 full body of a message to check it) that can only check incoming mail
25475 for contents. @code{spam-use-regex-body} is such a filter.
25476
25477 @item
25478 @code{spam-install-statistical-backend}
25479
25480 This function install a statistical back end with incoming checks and
25481 registration/unregistration routines. @code{spam-use-bogofilter} is
25482 set up this way.
25483
25484 @item
25485 @code{spam-install-backend}
25486
25487 This is the most normal back end installation, where a back end that can
25488 check and register/unregister messages is set up without statistical
25489 abilities. The @code{spam-use-BBDB} is such a back end.
25490
25491 @item
25492 @code{spam-install-mover-backend}
25493
25494 Mover back ends are internal to @code{spam.el} and specifically move
25495 articles around when the summary is exited. You will very probably
25496 never install such a back end.
25497 @end enumerate
25498
25499 @end enumerate
25500
25501 @node Spam Statistics Package
25502 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
25503 @cindex Paul Graham
25504 @cindex Graham, Paul
25505 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
25506 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
25507 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
25508
25509 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
25510 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
25511 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
25512 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
25513 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
25514 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
25515 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
25516 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
25517 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
25518 or not.
25519
25520 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
25521 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
25522 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
25523 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
25524 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
25525 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
25526 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
25527 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
25528
25529 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
25530 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
25531 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
25532
25533 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
25534 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
25535 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
25536 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
25537 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
25538
25539 @menu
25540 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
25541 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
25542 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
25543 @end menu
25544
25545 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25546 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
25547
25548 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
25549 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
25550 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
25551 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
25552 need several hundred emails in both collections.
25553
25554 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
25555 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
25556 per mail. Use the following:
25557
25558 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
25559 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
25560 is treated as one spam mail.
25561 @end defun
25562
25563 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
25564 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
25565 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
25566 @end defun
25567
25568 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
25569 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
25570 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
25571 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
25572 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
25573 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
25574
25575 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
25576 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
25577 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
25578 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
25579 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
25580
25581 @defvar spam-stat
25582 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
25583 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
25584 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
25585 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
25586 @end defvar
25587
25588 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
25589 reset the dictionary.
25590
25591 @defun spam-stat-reset
25592 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
25593 @end defun
25594
25595 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
25596 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
25597 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
25598 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
25599 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
25600 only non-spam mails.
25601
25602 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
25603 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
25604 to update the dictionary incrementally.
25605 @end defun
25606
25607 @defun spam-stat-save
25608 Save the dictionary.
25609 @end defun
25610
25611 @defvar spam-stat-file
25612 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
25613 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
25614 @end defvar
25615
25616 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
25617 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
25618
25619 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
25620 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
25621
25622 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25623
25624 @lisp
25625 (require 'spam-stat)
25626 (spam-stat-load)
25627 @end lisp
25628
25629 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
25630 created.
25631
25632 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
25633 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
25634 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
25635 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
25636
25637 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
25638 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
25639 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
25640 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
25641
25642 @lisp
25643 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25644 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25645 "mail.misc"))
25646 @end lisp
25647
25648 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
25649 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
25650 @end defvar
25651
25652 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
25653 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
25654 expression are considered potential spam.
25655
25656 @lisp
25657 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25658 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25659 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25660 "mail.misc"))
25661 @end lisp
25662
25663 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
25664 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
25665 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
25666 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
25667 mails, when creating the dictionary!
25668
25669 @lisp
25670 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25671 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25672 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25673 "mail.misc"))
25674 @end lisp
25675
25676 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
25677 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
25678 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
25679 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
25680 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
25681 dictionary!
25682
25683 @lisp
25684 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
25685 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
25686 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
25687 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
25688 "mail.misc"))
25689 @end lisp
25690
25691
25692 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25693 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25694
25695 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25696
25697 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25698 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25699 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25700 @end defun
25701
25702 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25703 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25704 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25705 @end defun
25706
25707 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25708 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25709 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25710 already been processed as non-spam.
25711 @end defun
25712
25713 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25714 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25715 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25716 been processed as spam.
25717 @end defun
25718
25719 @defun spam-stat-save
25720 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25721 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25722 @end defun
25723
25724 @defun spam-stat-load
25725 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25726 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25727 @end defun
25728
25729 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25730 Return the spam score for a word.
25731 @end defun
25732
25733 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25734 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25735 @end defun
25736
25737 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25738 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25739 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25740 @end defun
25741
25742 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25743 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25744
25745 @lisp
25746 (require 'spam-stat)
25747 (spam-stat-load)
25748 @end lisp
25749
25750 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25751
25752 @smallexample
25753 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25754 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25755 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25756 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25757 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25758 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25759 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25760 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25761 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25762 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25763 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25764 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25765 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25766 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25767 @end smallexample
25768
25769 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25770
25771 @smallexample
25772 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25773 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25774 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25775 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25776 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25777 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25778 @end smallexample
25779
25780 @node The Gnus Registry
25781 @section The Gnus Registry
25782 @cindex registry
25783 @cindex split
25784 @cindex track
25785
25786 The Gnus registry is a package that tracks messages by their
25787 Message-ID across all backends. This allows Gnus users to do several
25788 cool things, be the envy of the locals, get free haircuts, and be
25789 experts on world issues. Well, maybe not all of those, but the
25790 features are pretty cool.
25791
25792 Although they will be explained in detail shortly, here's a quick list
25793 of said features in case your attention span is... never mind.
25794
25795 @enumerate
25796 @item
25797 Split messages to their parent
25798
25799 This keeps discussions in the same group. You can use the subject and
25800 the sender in addition to the Message-ID@. Several strategies are
25801 available.
25802
25803 @item
25804 Refer to messages by ID
25805
25806 Commands like @code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article} can take
25807 advantage of the registry to jump to the referred article, regardless
25808 of the group the message is in.
25809
25810 @item
25811 Store custom flags and keywords
25812
25813 The registry can store custom flags and keywords for a message. For
25814 instance, you can mark a message ``To-Do'' this way and the flag will
25815 persist whether the message is in the nnimap, nnml, nnmaildir,
25816 etc. backends.
25817
25818 @item
25819 Store arbitrary data
25820
25821 Through a simple ELisp API, the registry can remember any data for a
25822 message. A built-in inverse map, when activated, allows quick lookups
25823 of all messages matching a particular set of criteria.
25824 @end enumerate
25825
25826 @menu
25827 * Gnus Registry Setup::
25828 * Registry Article Refer Method::
25829 * Fancy splitting to parent::
25830 * Store custom flags and keywords::
25831 * Store arbitrary data::
25832 @end menu
25833
25834 @node Gnus Registry Setup
25835 @subsection Gnus Registry Setup
25836
25837 Fortunately, setting up the Gnus registry is pretty easy:
25838
25839 @lisp
25840 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25841
25842 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25843 @end lisp
25844
25845 This adds registry saves to Gnus newsrc saves (which happen on exit
25846 and when you press @kbd{s} from the @code{*Group*} buffer. It also
25847 adds registry calls to article actions in Gnus (copy, move, etc.)@: so
25848 it's not easy to undo the initialization. See
25849 @code{gnus-registry-initialize} for the gory details.
25850
25851 Here are other settings used by the author of the registry (understand
25852 what they do before you copy them blindly).
25853
25854 @lisp
25855 (setq
25856 gnus-registry-split-strategy 'majority
25857 gnus-registry-ignored-groups '(("nntp" t)
25858 ("nnrss" t)
25859 ("spam" t)
25860 ("train" t))
25861 gnus-registry-max-entries 500000
25862 ;; this is the default
25863 gnus-registry-track-extra '(sender subject))
25864 @end lisp
25865
25866 They say: keep a lot of messages around, track messages by sender and
25867 subject (not just parent Message-ID), and when the registry splits
25868 incoming mail, use a majority rule to decide where messages should go
25869 if there's more than one possibility. In addition, the registry
25870 should ignore messages in groups that match ``nntp'', ``nnrss'',
25871 ``spam'', or ``train.''
25872
25873 You are doubtless impressed by all this, but you ask: ``I am a Gnus
25874 user, I customize to live. Give me more.'' Here you go, these are
25875 the general settings.
25876
25877 @defvar gnus-registry-unfollowed-groups
25878 The groups that will not be followed by
25879 @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent}. They will still be
25880 remembered by the registry. This is a list of regular expressions.
25881 By default any group name that ends with ``delayed'', ``drafts'',
25882 ``queue'', or ``INBOX'', belongs to the nnmairix backend, or contains
25883 the word ``archive'' is not followed.
25884 @end defvar
25885
25886 @defvar gnus-registry-max-entries
25887 The number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries the
25888 registry will keep.
25889 @end defvar
25890
25891 @defvar gnus-registry-max-pruned-entries
25892 The maximum number (an integer or @code{nil} for unlimited) of entries
25893 the registry will keep after pruning.
25894 @end defvar
25895
25896 @defvar gnus-registry-cache-file
25897 The file where the registry will be stored between Gnus sessions. By
25898 default the file name is @code{.gnus.registry.eioio} in the same
25899 directory as your @code{.newsrc.eld}.
25900 @end defvar
25901
25902 @node Registry Article Refer Method
25903 @subsection Fetching by @code{Message-ID} Using the Registry
25904
25905 The registry knows how to map each @code{Message-ID} to the group it's
25906 in. This can be leveraged to enhance the ``article refer method'',
25907 the thing that tells Gnus how to look up an article given its
25908 Message-ID (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
25909
25910 @vindex nnregistry
25911 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
25912
25913 The @code{nnregistry} refer method does exactly that. It has the
25914 advantage that an article may be found regardless of the group it's
25915 in---provided its @code{Message-ID} is known to the registry. It can
25916 be enabled by augmenting the start-up file with something along these
25917 lines:
25918
25919 @example
25920 ;; Keep enough entries to have a good hit rate when referring to an
25921 ;; article using the registry. Use long group names so that Gnus
25922 ;; knows where the article is.
25923 (setq gnus-registry-max-entries 2500)
25924
25925 (gnus-registry-initialize)
25926
25927 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
25928 '(current
25929 (nnregistry)
25930 (nnweb "gmane" (nnweb-type gmane))))
25931 @end example
25932
25933 The example above instructs Gnus to first look up the article in the
25934 current group, or, alternatively, using the registry, and finally, if
25935 all else fails, using Gmane.
25936
25937 @node Fancy splitting to parent
25938 @subsection Fancy splitting to parent
25939
25940 Simply put, this lets you put followup e-mail where it belongs.
25941
25942 Every message has a Message-ID, which is unique, and the registry
25943 remembers it. When the message is moved or copied, the registry will
25944 notice this and offer the new group as a choice to the splitting
25945 strategy.
25946
25947 When a followup is made, usually it mentions the original message's
25948 Message-ID in the headers. The registry knows this and uses that
25949 mention to find the group where the original message lives. You only
25950 have to put a rule like this:
25951
25952 @lisp
25953 (setq nnimap-my-split-fancy '(|
25954
25955 ;; split to parent: you need this
25956 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
25957
25958 ;; other rules, as an example
25959 (: spam-split)
25960 ;; default mailbox
25961 "mail")
25962 @end lisp
25963
25964 in your fancy split setup. In addition, you may want to customize the
25965 following variables.
25966
25967 @defvar gnus-registry-track-extra
25968 This is a list of symbols, so it's best to change it from the
25969 Customize interface. By default it's @code{(subject sender)}, which
25970 may work for you. It can be annoying if your mail flow is large and
25971 people don't stick to the same groups.
25972 @end defvar
25973
25974 @defvar gnus-registry-split-strategy
25975 This is a symbol, so it's best to change it from the Customize
25976 interface. By default it's @code{nil}, but you may want to set it to
25977 @code{majority} or @code{first} to split by sender or subject based on
25978 the majority of matches or on the first found. I find @code{majority}
25979 works best.
25980 @end defvar
25981
25982 @node Store custom flags and keywords
25983 @subsection Store custom flags and keywords
25984
25985 The registry lets you set custom flags and keywords per message. You
25986 can use the Gnus->Registry Marks menu or the @kbd{M M x} keyboard
25987 shortcuts, where @code{x} is the first letter of the mark's name.
25988
25989 @defvar gnus-registry-marks
25990 The custom marks that the registry can use. You can modify the
25991 default list, if you like. If you do, you'll have to exit Emacs
25992 before they take effect (you can also unload the registry and reload
25993 it or evaluate the specific macros you'll need, but you probably don't
25994 want to bother). Use the Customize interface to modify the list.
25995
25996 By default this list has the @code{Important}, @code{Work},
25997 @code{Personal}, @code{To-Do}, and @code{Later} marks. They all have
25998 keyboard shortcuts like @kbd{M M i} for Important, using the first
25999 letter.
26000 @end defvar
26001
26002 @defun gnus-registry-mark-article
26003 Call this function to mark an article with a custom registry mark. It
26004 will offer the available marks for completion.
26005 @end defun
26006
26007 You can use @code{defalias} to install a summary line formatting
26008 function that will show the registry marks. There are two flavors of
26009 this function, either showing the marks as single characters, using
26010 their @code{:char} property, or showing the marks as full strings.
26011
26012 @lisp
26013 ;; show the marks as single characters (see the :char property in
26014 ;; `gnus-registry-marks'):
26015 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-chars)
26016
26017 ;; show the marks by name (see `gnus-registry-marks'):
26018 ;; (defalias 'gnus-user-format-function-M 'gnus-registry-article-marks-to-names)
26019 @end lisp
26020
26021
26022 @node Store arbitrary data
26023 @subsection Store arbitrary data
26024
26025 The registry has a simple API that uses a Message-ID as the key to
26026 store arbitrary data (as long as it can be converted to a list for
26027 storage).
26028
26029 @defun gnus-registry-set-id-key (id key value)
26030 Store @code{value} under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26031 @end defun
26032
26033 @defun gnus-registry-get-id-key (id key)
26034 Get the data under @code{key} for message @code{id}.
26035 @end defun
26036
26037 @defvar gnus-registry-extra-entries-precious
26038 If any extra entries are precious, their presence will make the
26039 registry keep the whole entry forever, even if there are no groups for
26040 the Message-ID and if the size limit of the registry is reached. By
26041 default this is just @code{(marks)} so the custom registry marks are
26042 precious.
26043 @end defvar
26044
26045 @node Other modes
26046 @section Interaction with other modes
26047
26048 @subsection Dired
26049 @cindex dired
26050
26051 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
26052 buffers. It is enabled with
26053 @lisp
26054 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
26055 @end lisp
26056
26057 @table @kbd
26058 @item C-c C-m C-a
26059 @findex gnus-dired-attach
26060 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
26061 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
26062 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
26063
26064 @item C-c C-m C-l
26065 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
26066 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
26067 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
26068 buffer.
26069
26070 @item C-c C-m C-p
26071 @findex gnus-dired-print
26072 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
26073 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
26074 @end table
26075
26076 @node Various Various
26077 @section Various Various
26078 @cindex mode lines
26079 @cindex highlights
26080
26081 @table @code
26082
26083 @item gnus-home-directory
26084 @vindex gnus-home-directory
26085 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
26086 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
26087
26088 @item gnus-directory
26089 @vindex gnus-directory
26090 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
26091 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
26092 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
26093
26094 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
26095 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
26096 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
26097 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
26098
26099 @item gnus-default-directory
26100 @vindex gnus-default-directory
26101 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
26102 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
26103 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
26104 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
26105 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
26106 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
26107
26108 @item gnus-verbose
26109 @vindex gnus-verbose
26110 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
26111 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
26112 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
26113 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
26114 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
26115
26116 @item gnus-verbose-backends
26117 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
26118 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
26119 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
26120
26121 @item gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26122 @vindex gnus-add-timestamp-to-message
26123 This variable controls whether to add timestamps to messages that are
26124 controlled by @code{gnus-verbose} and @code{gnus-verbose-backends} and
26125 are issued. The default value is @code{nil} which means never to add
26126 timestamp. If it is @code{log}, add timestamps to only the messages
26127 that go into the @samp{*Messages*} buffer (in XEmacs, it is the
26128 @w{@samp{ *Message-Log*}} buffer). If it is neither @code{nil} nor
26129 @code{log}, add timestamps not only to log messages but also to the ones
26130 displayed in the echo area.
26131
26132 @item nnheader-max-head-length
26133 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
26134 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
26135 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
26136 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
26137 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
26138 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
26139 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
26140 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
26141 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
26142
26143 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
26144 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
26145 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
26146 read when doing the operation described above.
26147
26148 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26149 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26150 @cindex file names
26151 @cindex invalid characters in file names
26152 @cindex characters in file names
26153 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
26154 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
26155 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
26156
26157 @lisp
26158 @group
26159 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
26160 '((?: . ?_)))
26161 @end group
26162 @end lisp
26163
26164 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
26165 Windows (phooey) systems.
26166
26167 @item gnus-hidden-properties
26168 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
26169 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
26170 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
26171 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
26172
26173 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
26174 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
26175 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
26176 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
26177 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
26178
26179 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
26180 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
26181 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
26182
26183 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26184 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
26185
26186 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
26187 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
26188 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
26189 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
26190 group).
26191
26192 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
26193
26194 @item gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26195 @vindex gnus-safe-html-newsgroups
26196 Groups in which links in html articles are considered all safe. The
26197 value may be a regexp matching those groups, a list of group names, or
26198 @code{nil}. This overrides @code{mm-w3m-safe-url-regexp}. The default
26199 value is @code{"\\`nnrss[+:]"}. This is effective only when emacs-w3m
26200 renders html articles, i.e., in the case @code{mm-text-html-renderer} is
26201 set to @code{w3m}. @xref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization,
26202 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}.
26203
26204 @end table
26205
26206 @node The End
26207 @chapter The End
26208
26209 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
26210 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
26211
26212 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
26213
26214 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
26215
26216 @quotation
26217 @strong{Te Deum}
26218
26219 @sp 1
26220 Not because of victories @*
26221 I sing,@*
26222 having none,@*
26223 but for the common sunshine,@*
26224 the breeze,@*
26225 the largess of the spring.
26226
26227 @sp 1
26228 Not for victory@*
26229 but for the day's work done@*
26230 as well as I was able;@*
26231 not for a seat upon the dais@*
26232 but at the common table.@*
26233 @end quotation
26234
26235
26236 @node Appendices
26237 @chapter Appendices
26238
26239 @menu
26240 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
26241 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
26242 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
26243 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
26244 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
26245 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
26246 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
26247 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
26248 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
26249 @end menu
26250
26251
26252 @node XEmacs
26253 @section XEmacs
26254 @cindex XEmacs
26255 @cindex installing under XEmacs
26256
26257 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
26258 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
26259 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
26260 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
26261 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
26262 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
26263
26264
26265 @node History
26266 @section History
26267
26268 @cindex history
26269 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
26270 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
26271
26272 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
26273 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
26274 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
26275 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
26276 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
26277
26278 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
26279 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
26280 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
26281 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
26282 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
26283 appropriate name, don't you think?)
26284
26285 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
26286 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
26287 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
26288 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
26289
26290 @menu
26291 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
26292 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
26293 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
26294 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
26295 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
26296 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
26297 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
26298 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
26299 @end menu
26300
26301
26302 @node Gnus Versions
26303 @subsection Gnus Versions
26304 @cindex ding Gnus
26305 @cindex September Gnus
26306 @cindex Red Gnus
26307 @cindex Quassia Gnus
26308 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
26309 @cindex Oort Gnus
26310 @cindex No Gnus
26311 @cindex Ma Gnus
26312 @cindex Gnus versions
26313
26314 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
26315 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
26316 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
26317
26318 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
26319 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
26320
26321 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
26322 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
26323
26324 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
26325 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
26326
26327 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
26328 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
26329 1999.
26330
26331 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
26332 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
26333
26334 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
26335
26336 On April 19, 2010 Gnus development was moved to Git. See
26337 http://git.gnus.org for details (http://www.gnus.org will be updated
26338 with the information when possible).
26339
26340 On the January 31th 2012, Ma Gnus was begun.
26341
26342 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name---``(ding)
26343 Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
26344 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'', ``Ma Gnus''---don't
26345 panic. Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly.
26346 Whatever you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of
26347 its reach. Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to
26348 that instead.
26349
26350
26351 @node Why?
26352 @subsection Why?
26353
26354 What's the point of Gnus?
26355
26356 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
26357 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
26358 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
26359 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
26360 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
26361 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
26362 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
26363 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
26364 keep track of millions of people who post?
26365
26366 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
26367 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
26368 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
26369 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
26370 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
26371 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
26372 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
26373 every one of you to explore and invent.
26374
26375 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
26376 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
26377
26378
26379 @node Compatibility
26380 @subsection Compatibility
26381
26382 @cindex compatibility
26383 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
26384 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
26385 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
26386
26387 Our motto is:
26388 @quotation
26389 @cartouche
26390 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
26391 @end cartouche
26392 @end quotation
26393
26394 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
26395 their names.
26396
26397 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
26398 Articles}.
26399
26400 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
26401 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
26402 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
26403 important variables have their values copied into their global
26404 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
26405 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
26406
26407 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
26408 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
26409 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
26410 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
26411 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
26412 peculiar results.
26413
26414 @cindex hilit19
26415 @cindex highlighting
26416 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
26417 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
26418 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
26419 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
26420 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
26421 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
26422 Away!
26423
26424 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
26425 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
26426 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
26427 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
26428
26429 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
26430 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
26431 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
26432 to stop doing it the old way.
26433
26434 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
26435
26436 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
26437 @findex gnus-bug
26438 @cindex reporting bugs
26439 @cindex bugs
26440 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
26441 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
26442 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
26443
26444 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
26445 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
26446 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
26447 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
26448 up at you.
26449
26450
26451 @node Conformity
26452 @subsection Conformity
26453
26454 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
26455 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
26456 with, of course.
26457
26458 @table @strong
26459
26460 @item RFC (2)822
26461 @cindex RFC 822
26462 @cindex RFC 2822
26463 There are no known breaches of this standard.
26464
26465 @item RFC 1036
26466 @cindex RFC 1036
26467 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
26468
26469 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
26470 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
26471 We do have some breaches to this one.
26472
26473 @table @emph
26474
26475 @item X-Newsreader
26476 @itemx User-Agent
26477 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
26478 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
26479 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
26480 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
26481 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
26482 @end table
26483
26484 @item USEFOR
26485 @cindex USEFOR
26486 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
26487 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
26488 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
26489 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
26490
26491 @item MIME---RFC 2045--2049 etc
26492 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
26493 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
26494
26495 @item Disposition Notifications---RFC 2298
26496 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
26497
26498 @item PGP---RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
26499 @cindex RFC 1991
26500 @cindex RFC 2440
26501 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
26502 published as an informational RFC@. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
26503 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
26504 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
26505 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
26506 decryption).
26507
26508 @item PGP/MIME---RFC 2015/3156
26509 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
26510 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
26511 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
26512
26513 @item S/MIME---RFC 2633
26514 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
26515
26516 @item IMAP---RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
26517 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
26518 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
26519 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
26520 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
26521 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
26522 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
26523 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
26524
26525 @end table
26526
26527 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
26528 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
26529 know.
26530
26531
26532 @node Emacsen
26533 @subsection Emacsen
26534 @cindex Emacsen
26535 @cindex XEmacs
26536 @cindex Mule
26537 @cindex Emacs
26538
26539 This version of Gnus should work on:
26540
26541 @itemize @bullet
26542
26543 @item
26544 Emacs 21.1 and up.
26545
26546 @item
26547 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
26548
26549 @end itemize
26550
26551 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
26552 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
26553 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
26554 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
26555
26556 @c No-merge comment: The paragraph added in v5-10 here must not be
26557 @c synced here!
26558
26559 @node Gnus Development
26560 @subsection Gnus Development
26561
26562 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
26563 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
26564 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
26565 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
26566 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
26567 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
26568 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
26569 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
26570
26571 After futzing around for 10--100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
26572 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
26573 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
26574 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
26575 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
26576 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
26577 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
26578 in Emacs.
26579
26580 @cindex Incoming*
26581 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26582 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26583 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26584 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26585 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26586
26587 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
26588 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
26589 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
26590 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
26591 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
26592 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
26593 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
26594 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
26595 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
26596 can't be assumed to do so.
26597
26598 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
26599 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
26600 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
26601
26602 @cindex Incoming*
26603 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
26604 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
26605 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
26606 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
26607 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
26608
26609 @node Contributors
26610 @subsection Contributors
26611 @cindex contributors
26612
26613 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
26614 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
26615 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
26616 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
26617 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
26618 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
26619 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
26620 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
26621 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
26622 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
26623
26624 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
26625 wrong show.
26626
26627 @itemize @bullet
26628
26629 @item
26630 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
26631
26632 @item
26633 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el,
26634 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
26635 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
26636 functionality and stuff.
26637
26638 @item
26639 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
26640 well as numerous other things).
26641
26642 @item
26643 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
26644
26645 @item
26646 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
26647
26648 @item
26649 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
26650
26651 @item
26652 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
26653
26654 @item
26655 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
26656 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
26657
26658 @item
26659 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
26660
26661 @item
26662 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section.
26663
26664 @item
26665 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
26666
26667 @item
26668 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
26669
26670 @item
26671 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bug detection and fixes.
26672
26673 @item
26674 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
26675
26676 @item
26677 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
26678 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
26679
26680 @item
26681 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
26682
26683 @item
26684 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
26685
26686 @item
26687 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
26688
26689 @item
26690 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
26691 .newsrc files.
26692
26693 @item
26694 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
26695
26696 @item
26697 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
26698
26699 @item
26700 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
26701
26702 @item
26703 Fran@,{c}ois Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
26704 well as autoconf support.
26705
26706 @end itemize
26707
26708 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
26709 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
26710
26711 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
26712
26713 Christopher Davis,
26714 Andrew Eskilsson,
26715 Kai Grossjohann,
26716 Kevin Greiner,
26717 Jesper Harder,
26718 Paul Jarc,
26719 Simon Josefsson,
26720 David K@aa{}gedal,
26721 Richard Pieri,
26722 Fabrice Popineau,
26723 Daniel Quinlan,
26724 Michael Shields,
26725 Reiner Steib,
26726 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
26727 Jack Vinson,
26728 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
26729 and
26730 Teodor Zlatanov.
26731
26732 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
26733
26734 Jari Aalto,
26735 Adrian Aichner,
26736 Vladimir Alexiev,
26737 Russ Allbery,
26738 Peter Arius,
26739 Matt Armstrong,
26740 Marc Auslander,
26741 Miles Bader,
26742 Alexei V. Barantsev,
26743 Frank Bennett,
26744 Robert Bihlmeyer,
26745 Chris Bone,
26746 Mark Borges,
26747 Mark Boyns,
26748 Lance A. Brown,
26749 Rob Browning,
26750 Kees de Bruin,
26751 Martin Buchholz,
26752 Joe Buehler,
26753 Kevin Buhr,
26754 Alastair Burt,
26755 Joao Cachopo,
26756 Zlatko Calusic,
26757 Massimo Campostrini,
26758 Castor,
26759 David Charlap,
26760 Dan Christensen,
26761 Kevin Christian,
26762 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
26763 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
26764 Laura Conrad,
26765 Michael R. Cook,
26766 Glenn Coombs,
26767 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
26768 Neil Crellin,
26769 Frank D. Cringle,
26770 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
26771 Andre Deparade,
26772 Ulrik Dickow,
26773 Dave Disser,
26774 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
26775 Joev Dubach,
26776 Michael Welsh Duggan,
26777 Dave Edmondson,
26778 Paul Eggert,
26779 Mark W. Eichin,
26780 Karl Eichwalder,
26781 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
26782 Michael Ernst,
26783 Luc Van Eycken,
26784 Sam Falkner,
26785 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
26786 Sigbjorn Finne,
26787 Sven Fischer,
26788 Paul Fisher,
26789 Decklin Foster,
26790 Gary D. Foster,
26791 Paul Franklin,
26792 Guy Geens,
26793 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
26794 David S. Goldberg,
26795 Michelangelo Grigni,
26796 Dale Hagglund,
26797 D. Hall,
26798 Magnus Hammerin,
26799 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
26800 Raja R. Harinath,
26801 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
26802 P. E. Jareth Hein,
26803 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
26804 Scott Hofmann,
26805 Tassilo Horn,
26806 Marc Horowitz,
26807 Gunnar Horrigmo,
26808 Richard Hoskins,
26809 Brad Howes,
26810 Miguel de Icaza,
26811 Fran@,{c}ois Felix Ingrand,
26812 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
26813 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
26814 Lee Iverson,
26815 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
26816 Rajappa Iyer,
26817 Andreas Jaeger,
26818 Adam P. Jenkins,
26819 Randell Jesup,
26820 Fred Johansen,
26821 Gareth Jones,
26822 Greg Klanderman,
26823 Karl Kleinpaste,
26824 Michael Klingbeil,
26825 Peter Skov Knudsen,
26826 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
26827 Petr Konecny,
26828 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
26829 Thor Kristoffersen,
26830 Jens Lautenbacher,
26831 Martin Larose,
26832 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
26833 Joerg Lenneis,
26834 Carsten Leonhardt,
26835 James LewisMoss,
26836 Christian Limpach,
26837 Markus Linnala,
26838 Dave Love,
26839 Mike McEwan,
26840 Tonny Madsen,
26841 Shlomo Mahlab,
26842 Nat Makarevitch,
26843 Istvan Marko,
26844 David Martin,
26845 Jason R. Mastaler,
26846 Gordon Matzigkeit,
26847 Timo Metzemakers,
26848 Richard Mlynarik,
26849 Lantz Moore,
26850 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
26851 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
26852 Hrvoje Niksic,
26853 Andy Norman,
26854 Fred Oberhauser,
26855 C. R. Oldham,
26856 Alexandre Oliva,
26857 Ken Olstad,
26858 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
26859 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
26860 Ettore Perazzoli,
26861 William Perry,
26862 Stephen Peters,
26863 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
26864 Ulrich Pfeifer,
26865 Matt Pharr,
26866 Andy Piper,
26867 John McClary Prevost,
26868 Bill Pringlemeir,
26869 Mike Pullen,
26870 Jim Radford,
26871 Colin Rafferty,
26872 Lasse Rasinen,
26873 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
26874 Joe Reiss,
26875 Renaud Rioboo,
26876 Roland B. Roberts,
26877 Bart Robinson,
26878 Christian von Roques,
26879 Markus Rost,
26880 Jason Rumney,
26881 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
26882 Jay Sachs,
26883 Dewey M. Sasser,
26884 Conrad Sauerwald,
26885 Loren Schall,
26886 Dan Schmidt,
26887 Ralph Schleicher,
26888 Philippe Schnoebelen,
26889 Andreas Schwab,
26890 Randal L. Schwartz,
26891 Danny Siu,
26892 Matt Simmons,
26893 Paul D. Smith,
26894 Jeff Sparkes,
26895 Toby Speight,
26896 Michael Sperber,
26897 Darren Stalder,
26898 Richard Stallman,
26899 Greg Stark,
26900 Sam Steingold,
26901 Paul Stevenson,
26902 Jonas Steverud,
26903 Paul Stodghill,
26904 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
26905 Kurt Swanson,
26906 Samuel Tardieu,
26907 Teddy,
26908 Chuck Thompson,
26909 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
26910 Philippe Troin,
26911 James Troup,
26912 Trung Tran-Duc,
26913 Jack Twilley,
26914 Aaron M. Ucko,
26915 Aki Vehtari,
26916 Didier Verna,
26917 Vladimir Volovich,
26918 Jan Vroonhof,
26919 Stefan Waldherr,
26920 Pete Ware,
26921 Barry A. Warsaw,
26922 Christoph Wedler,
26923 Joe Wells,
26924 Lee Willis,
26925 and
26926 Lloyd Zusman.
26927
26928
26929 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
26930 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
26931 (550kB and counting).
26932
26933 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
26934 sure.
26935
26936 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
26937 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
26938
26939
26940 @node New Features
26941 @subsection New Features
26942 @cindex new features
26943
26944 @menu
26945 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
26946 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
26947 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
26948 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
26949 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
26950 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
26951 * No Gnus:: Very punny. Gnus 5.12/5.13.
26952 * Ma Gnus:: Celebrating 25 years of Gnus.
26953 @end menu
26954
26955 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
26956 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
26957 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
26958
26959 @node ding Gnus
26960 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
26961
26962 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
26963
26964 @itemize @bullet
26965
26966 @item
26967 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
26968 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
26969
26970 @item
26971 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
26972 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
26973
26974 @item
26975 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
26976
26977 @item
26978 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
26979 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
26980 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
26981
26982 @item
26983 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
26984 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
26985 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
26986 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26987
26988 @item
26989 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
26990 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26991
26992 @item
26993 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
26994 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
26995 (@pxref{The Active File}).
26996
26997 @item
26998 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
26999 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
27000
27001 @item
27002 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
27003 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
27004 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27005
27006 @item
27007 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
27008 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
27009 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
27010
27011 @item
27012 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
27013 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
27014
27015 @item
27016 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
27017 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
27018
27019 @item
27020 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
27021 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27022
27023 @item
27024 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
27025 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
27026
27027 @item
27028 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
27029 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27030
27031 @item
27032 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
27033
27034 @item
27035 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
27036 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
27037
27038 @item
27039 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
27040 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
27041
27042 @item
27043 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
27044 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
27045
27046 @item
27047 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
27048
27049 @item
27050 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
27051 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27052
27053 @item
27054 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
27055 Articles}).
27056
27057 @item
27058 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
27059 Buttons}).
27060
27061 @item
27062 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
27063 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
27064
27065 @end itemize
27066
27067
27068 @node September Gnus
27069 @subsubsection September Gnus
27070
27071 @iftex
27072 @iflatex
27073 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
27074 @end iflatex
27075 @end iftex
27076
27077 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
27078
27079 @itemize @bullet
27080
27081 @item
27082 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
27083 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
27084 now obsolete.
27085
27086 @item
27087 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
27088 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
27089 Threading}).
27090
27091 @lisp
27092 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
27093 @end lisp
27094
27095 @item
27096 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
27097 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
27098
27099 @item
27100 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
27101 referred.
27102
27103 @item
27104 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions.
27105
27106 @item
27107 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
27108
27109 @item
27110 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
27111
27112 @lisp
27113 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
27114 @end lisp
27115
27116 @item
27117 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
27118 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
27119
27120 @lisp
27121 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
27122 @end lisp
27123
27124 @item
27125 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
27126 Groups}).
27127
27128 @item
27129 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
27130 Topics}).
27131
27132 @lisp
27133 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
27134 @end lisp
27135
27136 @item
27137 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
27138
27139 @item
27140 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
27141 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
27142
27143 @lisp
27144 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
27145 @end lisp
27146
27147 @item
27148 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
27149 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
27150
27151 @item
27152 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
27153
27154 @item
27155 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
27156 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
27157 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
27158
27159 @item
27160 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets.
27161
27162 @item
27163 The Gnus cache is much faster.
27164
27165 @item
27166 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
27167 Groups}).
27168
27169 @item
27170 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
27171 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
27172
27173 @item
27174 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
27175 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
27176
27177 @item
27178 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
27179 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
27180
27181 @item
27182 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
27183 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
27184 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
27185
27186 @item
27187 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
27188 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
27189
27190 @item
27191 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
27192
27193 @item
27194 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27195
27196 @item
27197 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
27198
27199 @item
27200 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
27201
27202 @item
27203 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
27204 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
27205
27206 @item
27207 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
27208 Layout}).
27209
27210 @item
27211 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
27212 @iftex
27213 @iflatex
27214 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
27215 @end iflatex
27216 @end iftex
27217
27218 @item
27219 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
27220
27221 @lisp
27222 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
27223 @end lisp
27224
27225 @item
27226 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
27227
27228 @item
27229 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
27230
27231 @item
27232 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
27233 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
27234
27235 @lisp
27236 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
27237 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
27238 @end lisp
27239
27240 @item
27241 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
27242 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
27243
27244 @lisp
27245 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
27246 @end lisp
27247
27248 @item
27249 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
27250 buffer to allow easier treatment.
27251
27252 @item
27253 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
27254
27255 @item
27256 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
27257 Articles}).
27258
27259 @lisp
27260 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
27261 @end lisp
27262
27263 @item
27264 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
27265 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
27266
27267 @lisp
27268 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
27269 @end lisp
27270
27271 @item
27272 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
27273 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
27274
27275 @item
27276 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
27277 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27278
27279 @lisp
27280 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
27281 @end lisp
27282
27283 @item
27284 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
27285
27286 @item
27287 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
27288
27289 @item
27290 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
27291
27292 @end itemize
27293
27294
27295 @node Red Gnus
27296 @subsubsection Red Gnus
27297
27298 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
27299
27300 @iftex
27301 @iflatex
27302 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
27303 @end iflatex
27304 @end iftex
27305
27306 @itemize @bullet
27307
27308 @item
27309 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
27310
27311 @item
27312 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
27313 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
27314
27315 @item
27316 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
27317 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
27318 Scoring}).
27319
27320 @item
27321 Article washing status can be displayed in the
27322 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
27323
27324 @item
27325 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
27326
27327 @item
27328 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
27329 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
27330
27331 @lisp
27332 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
27333 @end lisp
27334
27335 @item
27336 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
27337 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
27338 been added.
27339
27340 @item
27341 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extensible (@pxref{Document
27342 Server Internals}).
27343
27344 @item
27345 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
27346 Parameters}).
27347
27348 @item
27349 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
27350
27351 @item
27352 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
27353 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
27354
27355 @item
27356 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
27357 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
27358 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
27359
27360 @item
27361 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
27362 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27363
27364 @item
27365 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
27366 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
27367
27368 @item
27369 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
27370 (@pxref{Undo}).
27371
27372 @item
27373 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
27374 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27375
27376 @item
27377 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
27378 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
27379
27380 @lisp
27381 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
27382 @end lisp
27383
27384 @item
27385 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
27386
27387 @lisp
27388 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
27389 @end lisp
27390
27391 @item
27392 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
27393 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
27394
27395 @item
27396 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
27397 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
27398
27399 @item
27400 A new command for reading collections of documents
27401 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
27402 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
27403
27404 @item
27405 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
27406 Marks}).
27407
27408 @item
27409 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
27410 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
27411
27412 @item
27413 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
27414 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
27415 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
27416
27417 @item
27418 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
27419 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
27420 Sorting}).
27421
27422 @item
27423 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
27424 Groups}).
27425
27426 @item
27427 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
27428 Commands}).
27429 @iftex
27430 @iflatex
27431 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
27432 @end iflatex
27433 @end iftex
27434
27435 @item
27436 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
27437 Variables}).
27438
27439 @item
27440 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
27441 Mail}).
27442
27443 @item
27444 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
27445 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
27446
27447 @item
27448 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
27449
27450 @end itemize
27451
27452
27453 @node Quassia Gnus
27454 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
27455
27456 New features in Gnus 5.6:
27457
27458 @itemize @bullet
27459
27460 @item
27461 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
27462 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
27463 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
27464
27465 @item
27466 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
27467 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
27468 group, which is created automatically.
27469
27470 @item
27471 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
27472 values.
27473
27474 @item
27475 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-IDs.
27476
27477 @item
27478 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
27479 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
27480
27481 @item
27482 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
27483 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
27484
27485 @item
27486 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
27487
27488 @item
27489 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
27490 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
27491
27492 @item
27493 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
27494
27495 @item
27496 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
27497 details.
27498
27499 @item
27500 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
27501 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
27502
27503 @item
27504 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
27505 control over simplification.
27506
27507 @item
27508 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
27509
27510 @item
27511 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
27512 limit.
27513
27514 @item
27515 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
27516
27517 @item
27518 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
27519
27520 @item
27521 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
27522 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
27523 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
27524
27525 @item
27526 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
27527 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
27528
27529 @item
27530 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
27531 text---@kbd{W d}.
27532
27533 @item
27534 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
27535 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
27536
27537 @item
27538 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
27539 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
27540
27541 @item
27542 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
27543 has been added.
27544
27545 @item
27546 A history of where mails have been split is available.
27547
27548 @item
27549 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
27550
27551 @item
27552 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
27553 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
27554
27555 @item
27556 A new function for citing in Message has been
27557 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
27558
27559 @item
27560 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
27561
27562 @item
27563 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
27564 been added.
27565
27566 @item
27567 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
27568 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
27569
27570 @item
27571 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
27572 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
27573
27574 @item
27575 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
27576
27577 @item
27578 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
27579
27580 @end itemize
27581
27582 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
27583 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
27584
27585 New features in Gnus 5.8:
27586
27587 @itemize @bullet
27588
27589 @item
27590 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
27591 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
27592
27593 If you used procmail like in
27594
27595 @lisp
27596 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
27597 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
27598 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
27599 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
27600 @end lisp
27601
27602 this now has changed to
27603
27604 @lisp
27605 (setq mail-sources
27606 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
27607 :suffix ".in")))
27608 @end lisp
27609
27610 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
27611
27612 @item
27613 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
27614 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
27615
27616 @item
27617 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
27618 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
27619
27620 @item
27621 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
27622 called to position point.
27623
27624 @item
27625 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
27626 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
27627
27628 @item
27629 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
27630 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
27631
27632 @item
27633 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
27634 subtly different manner.
27635
27636 @item
27637 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
27638 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
27639 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
27640
27641 @item
27642 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
27643
27644 @end itemize
27645
27646 @node Oort Gnus
27647 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
27648 @cindex Oort Gnus
27649
27650 New features in Gnus 5.10:
27651
27652 @itemize @bullet
27653
27654 @item Installation changes
27655 @c ***********************
27656
27657 @itemize @bullet
27658 @item
27659 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
27660
27661 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
27662 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
27663 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
27664 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
27665 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
27666 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
27667 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
27668 isn't save in general.
27669
27670 @item
27671 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
27672 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
27673 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
27674 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
27675 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
27676 remove-installed-shadows}.
27677
27678 @item
27679 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
27680
27681 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
27682 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
27683 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
27684 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
27685 the second parameter.
27686
27687 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
27688 automatic recognition of XEmacs and Emacs, generates
27689 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
27690 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
27691 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
27692 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
27693 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
27694 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
27695 cycle used under Unix systems.
27696
27697 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
27698 superfluous, so they have been removed.
27699
27700 @item
27701 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
27702
27703 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
27704 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
27705 hierarchy.
27706
27707 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
27708 @c the repository. We should find a better place for this item.
27709 @item
27710 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
27711
27712 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
27713 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
27714 lisp directory into load-path.
27715
27716 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
27717 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
27718
27719 @end itemize
27720
27721 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
27722 @c *****************************************
27723
27724 @itemize @bullet
27725
27726 @item
27727 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
27728 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
27729
27730 @item
27731 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
27732
27733 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
27734 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GnuTLS.
27735
27736 @item
27737 Improved anti-spam features.
27738
27739 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
27740 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
27741 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
27742 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
27743 are also new. @ref{Thwarting Email Spam} and @ref{Spam Package}.
27744 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
27745
27746 @item
27747 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
27748
27749 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
27750 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
27751 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
27752 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
27753 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
27754
27755 @end itemize
27756
27757 @item Changes in group mode
27758 @c ************************
27759
27760 @itemize @bullet
27761
27762 @item
27763 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
27764 using @kbd{G M}.
27765
27766 @item
27767 Retrieval of charters and control messages
27768
27769 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
27770 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
27771
27772 @item
27773 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
27774
27775 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
27776 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
27777 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
27778 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
27779 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
27780 parameters, a'la:
27781 @lisp
27782 (setq gnus-parameters
27783 '(("mail\\..*"
27784 (gnus-show-threads nil)
27785 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
27786 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
27787 (to-group . "\\1"))))
27788 @end lisp
27789
27790 @item
27791 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
27792
27793 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
27794 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
27795 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
27796 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
27797 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
27798 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
27799 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
27800 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
27801 when getting new mail, remove the function.
27802
27803 @item
27804 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
27805
27806 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
27807 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
27808 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
27809
27810 @item
27811 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
27812 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
27813
27814 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
27815 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
27816 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
27817 @lisp
27818 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
27819 @end lisp
27820
27821 @item
27822 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
27823 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
27824 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
27825
27826 @end itemize
27827
27828 @item Changes in summary and article mode
27829 @c **************************************
27830
27831 @itemize @bullet
27832
27833 @item
27834 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
27835 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
27836 region if the region is active.
27837
27838 @item
27839 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
27840 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
27841
27842 @item
27843 Article Buttons
27844
27845 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
27846 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
27847 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
27848 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
27849
27850 @item
27851 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
27852
27853 @item
27854 Picons
27855
27856 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
27857 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
27858
27859 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
27860 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
27861 @xref{Picons}.
27862
27863 @item
27864 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
27865 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
27866
27867 @item
27868 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
27869
27870 @item
27871 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
27872 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
27873
27874 @item
27875 Warn about email replies to news
27876
27877 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
27878 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
27879 you.
27880
27881 @item
27882 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
27883 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
27884 built.
27885
27886 @item
27887 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
27888 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
27889
27890 @item
27891 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
27892 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
27893
27894 @item
27895 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
27896 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
27897
27898 @item
27899 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
27900
27901 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
27902 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
27903 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
27904 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
27905 citations.
27906
27907 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
27908 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
27909 Outlook (Express) articles.
27910
27911 @item
27912 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
27913
27914 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
27915 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
27916 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
27917 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
27918
27919 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
27920 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
27921 message cited below.
27922
27923 @item
27924 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc.)@: are now displayed graphically in
27925 Emacs too.
27926
27927 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
27928 disable it.
27929
27930 @item
27931 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
27932
27933 @item
27934 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
27935 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
27936
27937 @item
27938 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
27939
27940 @item
27941 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
27942
27943 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
27944 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
27945 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
27946 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
27947 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
27948 groups.
27949
27950 @item
27951 Deleting of attachments.
27952
27953 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
27954 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27955 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27956 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27957 that support editing.
27958
27959 @item
27960 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27961
27962 The default value is determined from the
27963 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27964 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
27965 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
27966
27967 @item
27968 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
27969
27970 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
27971 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
27972 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
27973
27974 @item
27975 Extended format specs.
27976
27977 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
27978 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
27979 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
27980 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
27981 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
27982 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27983
27984 @item
27985 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27986 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27987
27988 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
27989 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
27990 out other articles.
27991
27992 @item
27993 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
27994
27995 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
27996 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
27997 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
27998 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
27999
28000 @item
28001 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
28002
28003 @end itemize
28004
28005 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28006 @c ****************************************************
28007
28008 @itemize @bullet
28009
28010 @item
28011 Delayed articles
28012
28013 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
28014 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
28015 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
28016
28017 @item
28018 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
28019 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
28020
28021 @item
28022 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
28023 Gcc articles as read.
28024
28025 @item
28026 Externalizing of attachments
28027
28028 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
28029 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
28030 local files as external parts.
28031
28032 @item
28033 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
28034 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
28035
28036 @item
28037 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
28038
28039 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
28040 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
28041 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
28042 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
28043 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
28044 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
28045 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
28046 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
28047 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
28048
28049 @item
28050 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
28051
28052 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
28053 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
28054 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
28055 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
28056 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
28057 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
28058
28059 @item
28060 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
28061 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
28062 @code{nil}.
28063
28064 @item
28065 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
28066
28067 @item
28068 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
28069
28070 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
28071 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
28072 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
28073 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
28074 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
28075 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
28076 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
28077 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
28078 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
28079 was inserted directly.
28080
28081 @item
28082 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
28083
28084 @c FIXME should that not be 'message-user-agent?
28085 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
28086 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
28087 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
28088 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
28089
28090 @item
28091 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
28092
28093 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
28094 @lisp
28095 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
28096 'bbdb-complete-name)
28097 @end lisp
28098
28099 @item
28100 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
28101
28102 Add a new format of match like
28103 @lisp
28104 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
28105 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28106 @end lisp
28107 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
28108 @lisp
28109 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
28110 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
28111 @end lisp
28112
28113 @item
28114 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
28115
28116 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
28117 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
28118 need add those two headers too.
28119
28120 @item
28121 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
28122 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
28123 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
28124 versions.
28125
28126 @item
28127 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
28128 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
28129 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
28130 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
28131 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
28132
28133 @item
28134 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
28135
28136 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
28137
28138 @item
28139 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
28140
28141 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
28142 the valid values.
28143
28144 @item
28145 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
28146
28147 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
28148 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
28149 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
28150 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
28151 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
28152 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
28153 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
28154 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
28155
28156 @item
28157 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
28158 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630--2633).
28159
28160 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
28161 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
28162 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
28163 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
28164
28165 @item
28166 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
28167 C-m}.
28168
28169 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
28170 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
28171
28172 @item
28173 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
28174 @code{best}.
28175
28176 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
28177 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
28178 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
28179 invalidate the digital signature.
28180
28181 @item
28182 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
28183 decompressed when activated.
28184 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
28185
28186 @item
28187 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
28188
28189 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
28190 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
28191 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
28192 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
28193 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
28194 controls this.
28195
28196 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
28197 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
28198 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
28199 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.1)
28200
28201 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
28202 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
28203 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
28204 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
28205
28206 @end itemize
28207
28208 @item Changes in back ends
28209 @c ***********************
28210
28211 @itemize @bullet
28212 @item
28213 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
28214
28215 @item
28216 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
28217
28218 @item
28219 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
28220
28221 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
28222
28223 @item
28224 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
28225
28226 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
28227 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
28228 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
28229 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within, e.g., a department. It
28230 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
28231 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
28232 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
28233 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
28234 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
28235 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
28236 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
28237
28238 @end itemize
28239
28240 @item Appearance
28241 @c *************
28242
28243 @itemize @bullet
28244
28245 @item
28246 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
28247 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
28248
28249 @item
28250 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
28251 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
28252 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
28253 message, Message Manual}).
28254
28255 @item
28256 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
28257 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
28258 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
28259 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
28260
28261 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
28262 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
28263 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
28264 in Gnus 5.10.9.
28265 @end itemize
28266
28267
28268 @item Miscellaneous changes
28269 @c ************************
28270
28271 @itemize @bullet
28272
28273 @item
28274 @code{gnus-agent}
28275
28276 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
28277 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
28278 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
28279 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
28280 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
28281 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
28282 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
28283 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
28284 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
28285 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
28286 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
28287 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
28288 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
28289 is not needed any more.
28290
28291 @item
28292 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
28293
28294 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
28295 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
28296 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
28297
28298 @item
28299 Dired integration
28300
28301 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
28302 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
28303 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
28304 entry.
28305
28306 @item
28307 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
28308
28309 @item
28310 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
28311
28312 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
28313
28314 @end itemize
28315
28316 @end itemize
28317
28318 @node No Gnus
28319 @subsubsection No Gnus
28320 @cindex No Gnus
28321
28322 New features in No Gnus:
28323 @c FIXME: Gnus 5.12?
28324
28325 @include gnus-news.texi
28326
28327 @node Ma Gnus
28328 @subsubsection Ma Gnus
28329 @cindex Ma Gnus
28330
28331 I'm sure there will be lots of text here. It's really spelled 真
28332 Gnus.
28333
28334 New features in Ma Gnus:
28335
28336 @itemize @bullet
28337
28338 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
28339 @c ****************************************************
28340
28341 @itemize @bullet
28342
28343 @item
28344 The new hooks @code{gnus-gcc-pre-body-encode-hook} and
28345 @code{gnus-gcc-post-body-encode-hook} are run before/after encoding
28346 the message body of the Gcc copy of a sent message. See
28347 @xref{Archived Messages}.
28348
28349 @end itemize
28350
28351 @end itemize
28352
28353 @iftex
28354
28355 @page
28356 @node The Manual
28357 @section The Manual
28358 @cindex colophon
28359 @cindex manual
28360
28361 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
28362 either @code{texi2dvi}
28363 @iflatex
28364 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
28365 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
28366 @end iflatex
28367 to get what you hold in your hands now.
28368
28369 The following conventions have been used:
28370
28371 @enumerate
28372
28373 @item
28374 This is a @samp{string}
28375
28376 @item
28377 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
28378
28379 @item
28380 This is a @file{file}
28381
28382 @item
28383 This is a @code{symbol}
28384
28385 @end enumerate
28386
28387 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
28388 mean:
28389
28390 @lisp
28391 (setq flargnoze "yes")
28392 @end lisp
28393
28394 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
28395
28396 @lisp
28397 (setq flumphel 'yes)
28398 @end lisp
28399
28400 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
28401 ever get them confused.
28402
28403 @iflatex
28404 @c @head
28405 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
28406 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
28407 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
28408 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
28409 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
28410 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
28411 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
28412 @end iflatex
28413
28414 @end iftex
28415
28416
28417 @node On Writing Manuals
28418 @section On Writing Manuals
28419
28420 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
28421 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
28422 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
28423 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
28424 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
28425 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
28426 in hand.
28427
28428 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
28429 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
28430 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
28431 started with Gnus.
28432
28433 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
28434 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
28435
28436
28437 @page
28438 @node Terminology
28439 @section Terminology
28440
28441 @cindex terminology
28442 @table @dfn
28443
28444 @item news
28445 @cindex news
28446 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
28447 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
28448 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
28449 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
28450 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
28451
28452 @item mail
28453 @cindex mail
28454 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
28455 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
28456 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
28457 not posting, and replying is not following up.
28458
28459 @item reply
28460 @cindex reply
28461 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
28462
28463 @item follow up
28464 @cindex follow up
28465 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
28466 are reading.
28467
28468 @item back end
28469 @cindex back end
28470 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
28471 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
28472 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
28473 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
28474 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
28475 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
28476 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
28477 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
28478 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
28479 number 4711''.
28480
28481 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
28482 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
28483 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
28484 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
28485 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
28486 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
28487
28488 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
28489 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
28490 access the articles.
28491
28492 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
28493 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
28494 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
28495 confusing.
28496
28497 @item native
28498 @cindex native
28499 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
28500 default, way of getting news. Groups from the native select method
28501 have names like @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}.
28502
28503 @item foreign
28504 @cindex foreign
28505 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same
28506 time. These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends
28507 for getting news. Foreign groups have names like
28508 @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28509
28510 @item secondary
28511 @cindex secondary
28512 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and
28513 being foreign, but they mostly act like they are native, but they, too
28514 have names like @samp{nntp+news.gmane.org:gmane.emacs.gnus.devel}.
28515
28516 @item article
28517 @cindex article
28518 A message that has been posted as news.
28519
28520 @item mail message
28521 @cindex mail message
28522 A message that has been mailed.
28523
28524 @item message
28525 @cindex message
28526 A mail message or news article
28527
28528 @item head
28529 @cindex head
28530 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.)@: is
28531 put.
28532
28533 @item body
28534 @cindex body
28535 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
28536 body.
28537
28538 @item header
28539 @cindex header
28540 A line from the head of an article.
28541
28542 @item headers
28543 @cindex headers
28544 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
28545 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
28546
28547 @item @acronym{NOV}
28548 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
28549 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
28550 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
28551 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
28552 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
28553 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
28554
28555 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
28556 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
28557 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
28558 normal @sc{head} format.
28559
28560 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
28561 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
28562 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
28563 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
28564 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
28565 references, etc.
28566
28567 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
28568 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
28569 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
28570 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
28571 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
28572 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
28573 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
28574
28575 @item level
28576 @cindex levels
28577 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1--9). The ones
28578 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
28579 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1--5 are considered
28580 @dfn{subscribed}; 6--7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
28581 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
28582 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
28583
28584 @item killed groups
28585 @cindex killed groups
28586 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
28587 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
28588
28589 @item zombie groups
28590 @cindex zombie groups
28591 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
28592
28593 @item active file
28594 @cindex active file
28595 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
28596 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
28597 is rather large, as you might surmise.
28598
28599 @item bogus groups
28600 @cindex bogus groups
28601 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
28602 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
28603 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
28604
28605 @item activating
28606 @cindex activating groups
28607 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
28608 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
28609 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
28610
28611 @item spool
28612 @cindex spool
28613 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
28614 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
28615 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
28616
28617 @item server
28618 @cindex server
28619 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
28620
28621 @item select method
28622 @cindex select method
28623 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
28624 server settings.
28625
28626 @item virtual server
28627 @cindex virtual server
28628 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
28629 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
28630 whole is a virtual server.
28631
28632 @item washing
28633 @cindex washing
28634 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
28635 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
28636 original.
28637
28638 @item ephemeral groups
28639 @cindex ephemeral groups
28640 @cindex temporary groups
28641 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
28642 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
28643 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
28644
28645 @item solid groups
28646 @cindex solid groups
28647 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
28648 group buffer are solid groups.
28649
28650 @item sparse articles
28651 @cindex sparse articles
28652 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
28653 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
28654
28655 @item threading
28656 @cindex threading
28657 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
28658 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
28659
28660 @item root
28661 @cindex root
28662 @cindex thread root
28663 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
28664 articles in the thread.
28665
28666 @item parent
28667 @cindex parent
28668 An article that has responses.
28669
28670 @item child
28671 @cindex child
28672 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
28673
28674 @item digest
28675 @cindex digest
28676 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
28677 specified by RFC 1153.
28678
28679 @item splitting
28680 @cindex splitting, terminology
28681 @cindex mail sorting
28682 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
28683 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
28684 incorrectly called mail filtering.
28685
28686 @end table
28687
28688
28689 @page
28690 @node Customization
28691 @section Customization
28692 @cindex general customization
28693
28694 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
28695 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
28696 for some quite common situations.
28697
28698 @menu
28699 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
28700 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
28701 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
28702 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
28703 @end menu
28704
28705
28706 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
28707 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
28708
28709 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
28710 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
28711 Gnus has to get from the server.
28712
28713 @table @code
28714
28715 @item gnus-read-active-file
28716 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
28717 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
28718 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28719 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
28720 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
28721
28722 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
28723 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
28724 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
28725 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
28726 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
28727 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
28728 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
28729 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
28730 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
28731 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
28732 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
28733
28734 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
28735 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
28736 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
28737 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, and @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}. Note that a
28738 non-@code{nil} value for @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those
28739 variables.
28740 @end table
28741
28742
28743 @node Slow Terminal Connection
28744 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
28745
28746 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
28747 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
28748 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
28749
28750 @table @code
28751
28752 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
28753 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
28754 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
28755 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
28756 horizontal and vertical recentering.
28757
28758 @item gnus-visible-headers
28759 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
28760 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
28761 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
28762 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
28763
28764 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
28765 @lisp
28766 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
28767 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
28768 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
28769 @end lisp
28770
28771 @item gnus-use-full-window
28772 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
28773 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
28774 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
28775 want to read them anyway.
28776
28777 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
28778 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
28779 hidden initially.
28780
28781
28782 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
28783 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
28784 lines, which might save some time.
28785 @end table
28786
28787
28788 @node Little Disk Space
28789 @subsection Little Disk Space
28790 @cindex disk space
28791
28792 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
28793 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
28794
28795 @table @code
28796
28797 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
28798 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
28799 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28800 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28801 default.
28802
28803 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
28804 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
28805 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
28806 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
28807 default.
28808
28809 @item gnus-save-killed-list
28810 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
28811 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
28812 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
28813 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
28814
28815 @end table
28816
28817
28818 @node Slow Machine
28819 @subsection Slow Machine
28820 @cindex slow machine
28821
28822 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
28823 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
28824
28825 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
28826 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
28827
28828 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
28829 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
28830 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
28831
28832
28833 @page
28834 @node Troubleshooting
28835 @section Troubleshooting
28836 @cindex troubleshooting
28837
28838 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
28839 problems, really.
28840
28841 Ahem.
28842
28843 @enumerate
28844
28845 @item
28846 Make sure your computer is switched on.
28847
28848 @item
28849 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
28850 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
28851 Gnus will work.
28852
28853 @item
28854 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
28855 like @c
28856 @samp{Gnus v5.13} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
28857 @c
28858 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
28859 files lying around. Delete these.
28860
28861 @item
28862 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
28863 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
28864
28865 @item
28866 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
28867 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
28868 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
28869 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
28870 something like that.
28871 @end enumerate
28872
28873 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
28874
28875 @cindex bugs
28876 @cindex reporting bugs
28877
28878 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
28879 @findex gnus-bug
28880 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
28881 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
28882 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
28883 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
28884
28885 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
28886 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
28887 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
28888 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
28889 time.
28890
28891 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
28892 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
28893 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
28894 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
28895 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
28896 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
28897
28898 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
28899 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
28900 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
28901 the bug report.
28902
28903 @cindex patches
28904 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
28905 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
28906
28907 @cindex edebug
28908 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
28909 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
28910 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
28911 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
28912 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
28913 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
28914 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
28915 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
28916 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
28917 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
28918 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
28919 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
28920 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
28921 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
28922
28923 @cindex elp
28924 @cindex profile
28925 @cindex slow
28926 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
28927 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
28928 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
28929 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
28930 helps isolating the real problem areas).
28931
28932 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP@. The profiler is
28933 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
28934 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
28935 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g., @kbd{M-x
28936 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
28937 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
28938 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
28939 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
28940 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
28941 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
28942 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
28943 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
28944 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
28945 work perfectly.
28946
28947 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
28948 @cindex ding mailing list
28949 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
28950 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
28951 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
28952 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
28953
28954
28955 @page
28956 @node Gnus Reference Guide
28957 @section Gnus Reference Guide
28958
28959 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
28960 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
28961 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
28962 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
28963 it.
28964
28965 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
28966 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
28967 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
28968 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
28969 and general methods of operation.
28970
28971 @menu
28972 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
28973 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
28974 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
28975 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
28976 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
28977 * Group Info:: The group info format.
28978 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
28979 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
28980 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
28981 @end menu
28982
28983
28984 @node Gnus Utility Functions
28985 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
28986 @cindex Gnus utility functions
28987 @cindex utility functions
28988 @cindex functions
28989 @cindex internal variables
28990
28991 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
28992 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
28993 Below is a list of the most common ones.
28994
28995 @table @code
28996
28997 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
28998 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
28999 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
29000
29001 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
29002 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
29003 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
29004
29005 @item gnus-group-real-name
29006 @findex gnus-group-real-name
29007 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
29008 name.
29009
29010 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
29011 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
29012 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
29013 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
29014
29015 @item gnus-get-info
29016 @findex gnus-get-info
29017 Returns the group info list for @var{group} (@pxref{Group Info}).
29018
29019 @item gnus-group-unread
29020 @findex gnus-group-unread
29021 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
29022 unknown.
29023
29024 @item gnus-active
29025 @findex gnus-active
29026 The active entry (i.e., a cons cell containing the lowest and highest
29027 article numbers) for @var{group}.
29028
29029 @item gnus-set-active
29030 @findex gnus-set-active
29031 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
29032
29033 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29034 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
29035 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
29036 exit.
29037
29038 @item gnus-continuum-version
29039 @findex gnus-continuum-version
29040 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
29041 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
29042 versions.
29043
29044 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
29045 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
29046 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
29047
29048 @item gnus-news-group-p
29049 @findex gnus-news-group-p
29050 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
29051
29052 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29053 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
29054 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
29055
29056 @item gnus-server-to-method
29057 @findex gnus-server-to-method
29058 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
29059
29060 @item gnus-server-equal
29061 @findex gnus-server-equal
29062 Says whether two virtual servers are essentially equal. For instance,
29063 two virtual servers may have server parameters in different order, but
29064 this function will consider them equal.
29065
29066 @item gnus-group-native-p
29067 @findex gnus-group-native-p
29068 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
29069
29070 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
29071 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
29072 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
29073
29074 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
29075 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
29076 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
29077
29078 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
29079 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
29080 Returns the parameter list of @var{group} (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
29081 If given a second parameter, returns the value of that parameter for
29082 @var{group}.
29083
29084 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
29085 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
29086 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
29087
29088 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
29089 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
29090 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
29091
29092 @item gnus-check-backend-function
29093 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
29094 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
29095 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
29096
29097 @lisp
29098 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
29099 @result{} t
29100 @end lisp
29101
29102 @item gnus-read-method
29103 @findex gnus-read-method
29104 Prompts the user for a select method.
29105
29106 @end table
29107
29108
29109 @node Back End Interface
29110 @subsection Back End Interface
29111
29112 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
29113 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
29114 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
29115 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
29116 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
29117 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
29118
29119 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
29120 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
29121 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
29122 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
29123 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
29124 been opened, the function should fail.
29125
29126 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
29127 name. Take this example:
29128
29129 @lisp
29130 (nntp "odd-one"
29131 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
29132 (nntp-port-number 4324))
29133 @end lisp
29134
29135 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
29136 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
29137
29138 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
29139 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
29140 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
29141
29142 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
29143 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
29144 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
29145
29146 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
29147 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
29148 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
29149 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
29150 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
29151 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
29152 return value.
29153
29154 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
29155 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
29156 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server'';
29157 they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
29158 more.
29159
29160 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
29161 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
29162 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
29163 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
29164 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
29165 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
29166 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
29167 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
29168 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
29169 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
29170
29171 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
29172 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
29173 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
29174 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
29175 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
29176 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
29177 of numbers as long as possible.
29178
29179 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
29180 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
29181 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
29182
29183 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
29184 @code{nnchoke}.
29185
29186 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
29187
29188 @menu
29189 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
29190 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
29191 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
29192 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
29193 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
29194 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
29195 @end menu
29196
29197
29198 @node Required Back End Functions
29199 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
29200
29201 @table @code
29202
29203 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
29204
29205 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
29206 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
29207 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
29208 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
29209
29210 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
29211 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
29212 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
29213 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
29214
29215 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
29216 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
29217 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
29218 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
29219 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
29220 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
29221 number, do maximum fetches.
29222
29223 Here's an example HEAD:
29224
29225 @example
29226 221 1056 Article retrieved.
29227 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
29228 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
29229 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
29230 Subject: Re: Something very droll
29231 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
29232 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
29233 Lines: 26
29234 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
29235 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
29236 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
29237 .
29238 @end example
29239
29240 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
29241 these in the data buffer.
29242
29243 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
29244
29245 @example
29246 headers = *head
29247 head = error / valid-head
29248 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
29249 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
29250 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
29251 header = <text> eol
29252 @end example
29253
29254 @cindex BNF
29255 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
29256
29257 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
29258 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
29259 separated by tabs.
29260
29261 @example
29262 nov-buffer = *nov-line
29263 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
29264 field = <text except TAB>
29265 @end example
29266
29267 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
29268 @pxref{Headers}.
29269
29270
29271 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
29272
29273 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
29274 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
29275
29276 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
29277 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
29278 server. In fact, it should do so.
29279
29280 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
29281 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
29282
29283
29284 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
29285
29286 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
29287 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
29288 reason.
29289
29290 There should be no data returned.
29291
29292
29293 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
29294
29295 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
29296 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
29297 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
29298 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
29299
29300 There should be no data returned.
29301
29302
29303 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
29304
29305 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
29306 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
29307 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
29308 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
29309
29310 There should be no data returned.
29311
29312
29313 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
29314
29315 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
29316
29317 There should be no data returned.
29318
29319
29320 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
29321
29322 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
29323 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
29324 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
29325 it would be nice if that were possible.
29326
29327 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
29328 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
29329 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
29330 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
29331 into its article buffer.
29332
29333 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
29334 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
29335 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
29336 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
29337 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
29338 on successful article retrieval.
29339
29340
29341 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST INFO)
29342
29343 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
29344 making @var{group} the current group.
29345
29346 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
29347 the current group.
29348
29349 If @var{info}, it allows the backend to update the group info
29350 structure.
29351
29352 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
29353
29354 @example
29355 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
29356 @end example
29357
29358 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
29359 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
29360 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
29361 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
29362 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
29363 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
29364 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
29365 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
29366 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
29367 highest as 0.
29368
29369 @example
29370 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
29371 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
29372 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
29373 @end example
29374
29375
29376 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29377
29378 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
29379 a no-op on most back ends.
29380
29381 There should be no data returned.
29382
29383
29384 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
29385
29386 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
29387 @emph{all}.
29388
29389 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
29390
29391 @example
29392 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
29393 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
29394 @end example
29395
29396 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
29397 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
29398 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
29399 and the highest as 0.
29400
29401 @example
29402 active-file = *active-line
29403 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
29404 name = <string>
29405 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
29406 @end example
29407
29408 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
29409 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
29410 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
29411
29412
29413 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
29414
29415 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
29416 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
29417 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
29418 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
29419 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
29420 clear if the posting could not be completed.
29421
29422 There should be no result data from this function.
29423
29424 @end table
29425
29426
29427 @node Optional Back End Functions
29428 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
29429
29430 @table @code
29431
29432 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
29433
29434 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
29435 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
29436 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
29437
29438 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
29439 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
29440 former is in the same format as the data from
29441 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
29442 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
29443
29444 @example
29445 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
29446 @end example
29447
29448
29449 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
29450
29451 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
29452 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
29453 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
29454 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
29455 should return a non-@code{nil} value (exceptionally,
29456 @code{nntp-request-update-info} always returns @code{nil} not to waste
29457 the network resources).
29458
29459 There should be no result data from this function.
29460
29461
29462 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
29463
29464 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
29465 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
29466 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
29467 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
29468 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
29469 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
29470 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
29471 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
29472
29473 There should be no result data from this function.
29474
29475
29476 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
29477
29478 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
29479 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc.)@: internally, and store them in
29480 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
29481 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
29482 propagate the mark information to the server.
29483
29484 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
29485
29486 @example
29487 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
29488 @end example
29489
29490 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
29491 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
29492 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
29493 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
29494 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
29495 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend}, and
29496 @code{forward}, but your back end should, if possible, not limit
29497 itself to these.
29498
29499 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
29500 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
29501 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
29502 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
29503
29504 An example action list:
29505
29506 @example
29507 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
29508 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
29509 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
29510 @end example
29511
29512 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
29513 mark on (currently not used for anything).
29514
29515 There should be no result data from this function.
29516
29517 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
29518
29519 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
29520 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
29521 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
29522 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
29523 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
29524
29525 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
29526 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
29527 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
29528 expirable.
29529
29530 There should be no result data from this function.
29531
29532
29533 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
29534
29535 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
29536 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
29537 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
29538 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
29539 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
29540 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
29541 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
29542 local if that's practical.
29543
29544 There should be no result data from this function.
29545
29546
29547 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
29548
29549 The result data from this function should be a description of
29550 @var{group}.
29551
29552 @example
29553 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
29554 name = <string>
29555 description = <text>
29556 @end example
29557
29558 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
29559
29560 The result data from this function should be the description of all
29561 groups available on the server.
29562
29563 @example
29564 description-buffer = *description-line
29565 @end example
29566
29567
29568 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
29569
29570 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
29571 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
29572 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
29573 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
29574 in the active buffer format.
29575
29576 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
29577 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
29578 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
29579 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
29580 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
29581 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
29582 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
29583
29584
29585 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
29586
29587 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
29588
29589 There should be no return data.
29590
29591
29592 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
29593
29594 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
29595 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
29596 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
29597 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
29598 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
29599 they are.
29600
29601 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
29602 able to delete.
29603
29604 There should be no result data returned.
29605
29606
29607 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
29608
29609 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
29610 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
29611
29612 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
29613 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
29614 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
29615 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
29616 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
29617 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
29618
29619 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
29620 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
29621 optimizations.
29622
29623 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29624 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29625
29626 There should be no data returned.
29627
29628
29629 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
29630
29631 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
29632 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
29633 this function in short order.
29634
29635 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
29636 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
29637
29638 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
29639 article for that group.
29640
29641 There should be no data returned.
29642
29643
29644 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
29645
29646 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
29647 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
29648
29649 There should be no data returned.
29650
29651
29652 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
29653
29654 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
29655 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
29656 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
29657
29658 There should be no data returned.
29659
29660
29661 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
29662
29663 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
29664 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
29665
29666 There should be no data returned.
29667
29668 @end table
29669
29670
29671 @node Error Messaging
29672 @subsubsection Error Messaging
29673
29674 @findex nnheader-report
29675 @findex nnheader-get-report
29676 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
29677 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
29678 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
29679 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
29680 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
29681 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
29682
29683 @lisp
29684 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
29685
29686 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
29687 @end lisp
29688
29689 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
29690 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
29691 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
29692 takes one argument---the server symbol.
29693
29694 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
29695 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
29696 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
29697
29698
29699 @node Writing New Back Ends
29700 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
29701
29702 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
29703 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
29704 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
29705 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
29706 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
29707 editing articles.
29708
29709 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
29710 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
29711 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
29712
29713 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
29714 package called @code{nnoo}.
29715
29716 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
29717 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
29718 following macros:
29719
29720 @table @code
29721
29722 @item nnoo-declare
29723 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
29724 parameters. For instance:
29725
29726 @lisp
29727 (nnoo-declare nndir
29728 nnml nnmh)
29729 @end lisp
29730
29731 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
29732 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
29733
29734 @item defvoo
29735 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
29736 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
29737 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
29738
29739 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
29740 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
29741 a function in those back ends.
29742
29743 @lisp
29744 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29745 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29746 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29747 @end lisp
29748
29749 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
29750 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
29751 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
29752
29753 @item nnoo-define-basics
29754 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
29755 have.
29756
29757 @lisp
29758 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29759 @end lisp
29760
29761 @item deffoo
29762 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
29763 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
29764 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
29765
29766 @item nnoo-map-functions
29767 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
29768 functions from the parent back ends.
29769
29770 @lisp
29771 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29772 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29773 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
29774 @end lisp
29775
29776 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
29777 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
29778 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
29779 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
29780
29781 @item nnoo-import
29782 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
29783 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
29784 haven't already been defined.
29785
29786 @lisp
29787 (nnoo-import nndir
29788 (nnmh
29789 nnmh-request-list
29790 nnmh-request-newgroups)
29791 (nnml))
29792 @end lisp
29793
29794 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
29795 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
29796 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
29797 defined now.
29798
29799 @end table
29800
29801 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
29802
29803 @lisp
29804 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
29805 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,1996 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
29806
29807 ;;; @r{Code:}
29808
29809 (require 'nnheader)
29810 (require 'nnmh)
29811 (require 'nnml)
29812 (require 'nnoo)
29813 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
29814
29815 (nnoo-declare nndir
29816 nnml nnmh)
29817
29818 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
29819 "Where nndir will look for groups."
29820 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
29821
29822 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
29823 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
29824 nnml-nov-is-evil)
29825
29826 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
29827 nil
29828 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
29829 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
29830 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
29831
29832 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
29833 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
29834
29835 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
29836
29837 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
29838
29839 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
29840 (setq nndir-directory
29841 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
29842 server))
29843 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
29844 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
29845 (push `(nndir-current-group
29846 ,(file-name-nondirectory
29847 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29848 defs)
29849 (push `(nndir-top-directory
29850 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
29851 defs)
29852 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
29853
29854 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
29855 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29856 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
29857 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
29858 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
29859
29860 (nnoo-import nndir
29861 (nnmh
29862 nnmh-status-message
29863 nnmh-request-list
29864 nnmh-request-newgroups))
29865
29866 (provide 'nndir)
29867 @end lisp
29868
29869
29870 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29871 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
29872
29873 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
29874 @findex gnus-declare-backend
29875 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
29876 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
29877 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
29878
29879 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
29880 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
29881
29882 Here's an example:
29883
29884 @lisp
29885 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
29886 @end lisp
29887
29888 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
29889
29890 The abilities can be:
29891
29892 @table @code
29893 @item mail
29894 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
29895 @item post
29896 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
29897 @item post-mail
29898 This back end supports both mail and news.
29899 @item none
29900 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
29901 different.
29902 @item respool
29903 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
29904 articles and groups.
29905 @item address
29906 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
29907 true for almost all back ends.
29908 @item prompt-address
29909 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
29910 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
29911 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
29912 @end table
29913
29914
29915 @node Mail-like Back Ends
29916 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
29917
29918 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
29919 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
29920 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
29921 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
29922
29923 @lisp
29924 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
29925 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
29926 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
29927 @end lisp
29928
29929 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
29930 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
29931 mail.
29932
29933 This function takes four parameters.
29934
29935 @table @var
29936 @item method
29937 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
29938 the call.
29939
29940 @item exit-function
29941 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
29942
29943 @item temp-directory
29944 Where the temporary files should be stored.
29945
29946 @item group
29947 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
29948 performed for one group only.
29949 @end table
29950
29951 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
29952 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
29953 find the article number assigned to this article.
29954
29955 The function also uses the following variables:
29956 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
29957 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
29958 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
29959 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
29960 this:
29961
29962 @example
29963 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
29964 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
29965 @end example
29966
29967
29968 @node Score File Syntax
29969 @subsection Score File Syntax
29970
29971 Score files are meant to be easily parsable, but yet extremely
29972 malleable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
29973 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
29974
29975 Here's a typical score file:
29976
29977 @lisp
29978 (("summary"
29979 ("Windows 95" -10000 nil s)
29980 ("Gnus"))
29981 ("from"
29982 ("Lars" -1000))
29983 (mark -100))
29984 @end lisp
29985
29986 BNF definition of a score file:
29987
29988 @example
29989 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
29990 element = rule / atom
29991 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
29992 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
29993 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
29994 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
29995 quote = <ascii 34>
29996 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
29997 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
29998 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
29999 date-header = "date"
30000 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30001 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30002 score = "nil" / <integer>
30003 date = "nil" / <natural number>
30004 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
30005 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
30006 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
30007 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
30008 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30009 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30010 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
30011 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
30012 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
30013 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
30014 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
30015 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
30016 exclude-files / read-only / touched
30017 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
30018 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
30019 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
30020 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
30021 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
30022 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
30023 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
30024 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
30025 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
30026 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
30027 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
30028 eval = "eval" space <form>
30029 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
30030 @end example
30031
30032 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
30033 discarded.
30034
30035 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
30036 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
30037 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
30038 one looong line, then that's ok.
30039
30040 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
30041 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
30042
30043
30044 @node Headers
30045 @subsection Headers
30046
30047 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
30048 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
30049 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
30050 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
30051
30052 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
30053 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
30054 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
30055 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
30056 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
30057 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
30058 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
30059
30060 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
30061 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
30062 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
30063 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
30064 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
30065
30066 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
30067 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
30068
30069
30070 @node Ranges
30071 @subsection Ranges
30072
30073 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
30074 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
30075
30076 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
30077 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
30078 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
30079 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
30080
30081 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
30082 sequence.
30083
30084 @example
30085 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
30086 @end example
30087
30088 is transformed into
30089
30090 @example
30091 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
30092 @end example
30093
30094 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
30095 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
30096
30097 @example
30098 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
30099 @end example
30100
30101 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
30102 is slightly tricky:
30103
30104 @example
30105 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
30106 @end example
30107
30108 and
30109
30110 @example
30111 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
30112 @end example
30113
30114 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
30115
30116 @example
30117 (1 2 3 4 5)
30118 @end example
30119
30120 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
30121 also valid:
30122
30123 @example
30124 (1 . 5)
30125 @end example
30126
30127 and is equal to the previous range.
30128
30129 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
30130 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
30131 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
30132 range handling.)
30133
30134 @example
30135 range = simple-range / normal-range
30136 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
30137 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
30138 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
30139 number *[ " " contents ]
30140 @end example
30141
30142 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
30143 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
30144 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
30145 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
30146 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
30147 sequences.)
30148
30149
30150 @node Group Info
30151 @subsection Group Info
30152
30153 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
30154 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
30155 describes the group.
30156
30157 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
30158 second is a more complex one:
30159
30160 @example
30161 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
30162
30163 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
30164 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
30165 (nnml "")
30166 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
30167 @end example
30168
30169 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
30170 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
30171 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
30172 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
30173 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
30174 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
30175 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
30176 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
30177 this section is about.
30178
30179 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
30180 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
30181 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
30182
30183 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
30184
30185 @example
30186 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
30187 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
30188 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
30189 group = quote <string> quote
30190 ralevel = rank / level
30191 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30192 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
30193 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
30194 read = range
30195 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
30196 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
30197 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
30198 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
30199 @end example
30200
30201 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
30202 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
30203 in pseudo-BNF.
30204
30205 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
30206 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
30207
30208 @table @code
30209 @item gnus-info-group
30210 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
30211 @findex gnus-info-group
30212 @findex gnus-info-set-group
30213 Get/set the group name.
30214
30215 @item gnus-info-rank
30216 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
30217 @findex gnus-info-rank
30218 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
30219 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
30220
30221 @item gnus-info-level
30222 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
30223 @findex gnus-info-level
30224 @findex gnus-info-set-level
30225 Get/set the group level.
30226
30227 @item gnus-info-score
30228 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
30229 @findex gnus-info-score
30230 @findex gnus-info-set-score
30231 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
30232
30233 @item gnus-info-read
30234 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
30235 @findex gnus-info-read
30236 @findex gnus-info-set-read
30237 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
30238
30239 @item gnus-info-marks
30240 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
30241 @findex gnus-info-marks
30242 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
30243 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
30244
30245 @item gnus-info-method
30246 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
30247 @findex gnus-info-method
30248 @findex gnus-info-set-method
30249 Get/set the group select method.
30250
30251 @item gnus-info-params
30252 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
30253 @findex gnus-info-params
30254 @findex gnus-info-set-params
30255 Get/set the group parameters.
30256 @end table
30257
30258 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
30259 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
30260
30261 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
30262 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
30263 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
30264 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
30265
30266
30267 @node Extended Interactive
30268 @subsection Extended Interactive
30269 @cindex interactive
30270 @findex gnus-interactive
30271
30272 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
30273 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
30274 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
30275
30276 @lisp
30277 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
30278 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
30279 ...
30280 )
30281 @end lisp
30282
30283 The best thing to do would have been to implement
30284 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
30285 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
30286 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
30287 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
30288 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
30289 @code{interactive}.
30290
30291 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
30292 adds a few more.
30293
30294 @table @samp
30295 @item y
30296 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
30297 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
30298 variable.
30299
30300 @item Y
30301 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
30302 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
30303 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
30304
30305 @item A
30306 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
30307 function.
30308
30309 @item H
30310 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
30311 function.
30312
30313 @item g
30314 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
30315 function.
30316
30317 @end table
30318
30319
30320 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
30321 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
30322 @cindex XEmacs
30323 @cindex Emacsen
30324
30325 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
30326 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
30327 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
30328
30329 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
30330 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
30331 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
30332 Gnus, that's very useful.
30333
30334 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
30335 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
30336 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
30337 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
30338 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
30339 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
30340 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
30341 following function:
30342
30343 @lisp
30344 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
30345 (start-itimer
30346 "gnus-run-at-time"
30347 `(lambda ()
30348 (,function ,@@args))
30349 time repeat))
30350 @end lisp
30351
30352 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
30353 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
30354 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
30355 all over.
30356
30357 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
30358 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
30359 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
30360
30361 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
30362 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
30363 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
30364
30365
30366 @node Various File Formats
30367 @subsection Various File Formats
30368
30369 @menu
30370 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
30371 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
30372 @end menu
30373
30374
30375 @node Active File Format
30376 @subsubsection Active File Format
30377
30378 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
30379 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
30380 in each group.
30381
30382 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
30383
30384 @example
30385 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
30386 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
30387 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
30388 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
30389 no.general 1000 900 y
30390 @end example
30391
30392 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
30393
30394 @example
30395 active = *group-line
30396 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
30397 group = <non-white-space string>
30398 spc = " "
30399 high-number = <non-negative integer>
30400 low-number = <positive integer>
30401 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
30402 @end example
30403
30404 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
30405 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
30406
30407
30408 @node Newsgroups File Format
30409 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
30410
30411 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
30412 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
30413 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
30414 the user.
30415
30416 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
30417 Here's the definition:
30418
30419 @example
30420 newsgroups = *line
30421 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
30422 group = <non-white-space string>
30423 tab = <TAB>
30424 description = <string>
30425 @end example
30426
30427
30428 @page
30429 @node Emacs for Heathens
30430 @section Emacs for Heathens
30431
30432 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
30433 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
30434 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
30435 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
30436 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
30437 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
30438 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
30439 cat instead.
30440
30441 @menu
30442 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
30443 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
30444 @end menu
30445
30446
30447 @node Keystrokes
30448 @subsection Keystrokes
30449
30450 @itemize @bullet
30451 @item
30452 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
30453
30454 @item
30455 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
30456 @end itemize
30457
30458 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
30459 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
30460 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
30461 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
30462 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
30463 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
30464
30465 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
30466 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
30467 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
30468 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
30469 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
30470 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
30471 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
30472
30473 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
30474 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
30475 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
30476 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
30477 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
30478 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
30479 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
30480
30481 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
30482 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
30483 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
30484 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
30485 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
30486 it.
30487
30488
30489
30490 @node Emacs Lisp
30491 @subsection Emacs Lisp
30492
30493 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
30494 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
30495 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
30496 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
30497
30498 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
30499 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
30500 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
30501 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
30502 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
30503 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
30504 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
30505 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
30506 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
30507 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
30508
30509 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
30510 write the following:
30511
30512 @lisp
30513 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
30514 @end lisp
30515
30516 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
30517 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
30518 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
30519 change how Gnus works.
30520
30521 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
30522 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
30523 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
30524 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
30525 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
30526
30527 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
30528 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
30529 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
30530
30531 Some pitfalls:
30532
30533 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
30534 that means:
30535
30536 @lisp
30537 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
30538 @end lisp
30539
30540 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server-file} to
30541 @samp{/etc/nntpserver}'', that means:
30542
30543 @lisp
30544 (setq gnus-nntp-server-file "/etc/nntpserver")
30545 @end lisp
30546
30547 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
30548 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
30549
30550 @page
30551 @include gnus-faq.texi
30552
30553 @node GNU Free Documentation License
30554 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
30555 @include doclicense.texi
30556
30557 @node Index
30558 @chapter Index
30559 @printindex cp
30560
30561 @node Key Index
30562 @chapter Key Index
30563 @printindex ky
30564
30565 @bye
30566
30567 @iftex
30568 @iflatex
30569 \end{document}
30570 @end iflatex
30571 @end iftex
30572
30573 @c Local Variables:
30574 @c mode: texinfo
30575 @c coding: utf-8
30576 @c End: